BAC Product and Application Handbook
BAC Product and Application Handbook
BAC Product and Application Handbook
E U - VO LU M E I - 2 0 0 6
Welcome...
to the first European edition of the BAC Product and Application Handbook. In an era of information transfer, we are excited to make available to you a unique compilation of industry knowledge and product application details. This handbook reflects our commitment to facilitate the application of our products, services and technical resources for higher system efficiency, environmental responsibility and safe operation. BAC has a rich history in the design and development of the world's largest range of evaporative cooling and ice thermal storage products. A specialised hygiene services initiative is also presented in support of these products. I hope you will find this publication to be a valuable resource and a service to the industry because temperature matters.
Sincerely,
A1
Contents
Table of Contents
Table of Contents
Baltimore Aircoil Company . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A1 Introduction to Heat Transfer Products . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A4 Open Cooling Towers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .B Overview & Engineering Considerations . . . . . . . . . .CT - B1 Series 3000D Open Cooling Towers . . . . . . . . . .S3000D - B9 TXV Open Cooling Towers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .TXV - B29 FXT Open Cooling Towers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .FXT - B45 RCT Open Cooling Towers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .RCT - B57 IMT Open Cooling Towers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .IMT - B77 VTL Open Cooling Towers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .VTL - B97 VXT Open Cooling Towers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .VXT -B115 Closed Circuit Cooling Towers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .C Overview & Engineering Considerations . . . . . .CCCT - C1 VXI Closed Circuit Cooling Towers . . . . . . . . . . . . .VXI - C13 VFL Closed Circuit Cooling Towers . . . . . . . . . . . .VFL - C35 FXV Closed Circuit Cooling Towers . . . . . . . . . . . .FXV - C53 Water Saving Hybrid Wet-Dry Products . . . . . . . . . .D Overview & Engineering Considerations . . . . . . . . .WS - D1 HXI Hybrid Closed Circuit Cooling Tower . . . . . .HXI - D11 HFL Hybrid Closed Circuit Cooling Tower . . . . .HFL - D35 DFC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .DFC - D59 HXC Hybrid Condenser . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .HXC - D85 Evaporative Condensers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .E Overview & Engineering Considerations . . . . . . . . . .EC - E1 VXC Evaporative Condensers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .VXC - E13 VCL Evaporative Condensers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .VCL - E35 CXV Evaporative Condensers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .CXV - E51 TSU ICE CHILLER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F Thermal Storage Products . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .TSU - F1 TSU - M (Internal Melt Application) . . . . . . . . . . . . .TSU - F9 TSU - C/D (External Melt Application) . . . . . . . . .TSU - F19
Technical Resources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .G Connection Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .TR - G2 Materials of Construction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .TR - G4 Selection Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .TR - G5 The Value of Standards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .TR - G6 Selection of Remote Sump Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .TR - G7 Filtration Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .TR - G13 Sound Reduction Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .TR - G14 Fundamentals of Sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .TR - G22 Motor Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .TR - G47 Plume Abatement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .TR - G49 Formulas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .TR - G51 Replacement Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .TR - G52 Application Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .TR - G53 Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .TR - G61
Handbook Resources
Colour Coded Sections Vertical Identification Bars Sectional Icons
Open Cooling Towers Closed Circuit Cooling Towers Water Saving Hybrid Wet-Dry Products Evaporative Condensers ICE CHILLER Thermal Storage Products
Technical Resources
A2
For nearly seven decades Baltimore Aircoil Company has been dedicated to the development of innovative, cost effective heat transfer solutions for its customers. This has established BAC as the global leader of factory assembled evaporative heat rejection and thermal storage equipment.
Design
Ongoing investment in research and development, combined with sophisticated R&D laboratory facilities enables BAC to consistently offer technology and products in advance of new industry demands.
Selection
BAC offers the widest array of factory assembled evaporative heat rejection and thermal storage equipment in the industry. Breadth of product enables BAC to provide its customers optimized solutions with regard to their specific needs. Whether an application calls for open or closed cooling circuits, axial or centrifugal fans, special materials of construction or unique dimensional considerations, BAC has the solution.
Performance
All BAC products are engineered to minimize lifecycle costs through a combination of low energy consumption and low maintenance. An extensive array of options addresses such issues as low sound or low water consumption requirements.
A3
www. BaltimoreAircoil.com
A proprietary online tool that allows access to resources and education to assist product evaluation, comparison and selection.
Product Information Selections Equipment Specifications Technical Information Rigging and Installation Manuals
A4
Evaporative Condensers
When applied to HVAC and light industrial systems, evaporative condensers provide lower condensing temperatures and compressor kW savings of up to 15 percent compared with traditional systems. In an evaporative condenser, refrigerant vapor is condensed in a coil, which is continually wetted on the outside by a recirculating water system. Air is circulated over the coil, causing a small portion of the recirculating water to evaporate. The evaporation removes heat from the vapor in the coil, causing it to condense.
Baltimore Aircoil
CT - B 1
CT - B 2
General Information
Open cooling towers provide evaporative cooling for many types of systems, and the specific application will largely determine which BAC Cooling Tower is best suited for a project. The Product Line Overview Table is intended as a general guide. Specialised assistance is available through your local BAC Balticare Representative.
Principle of Operation
Overview
Open cooling towers reject heat from water-cooled systems to the atmosphere. Hot water from the system enters the cooling tower and is distributed over the wet deck (heat transfer surface). Air is pulled or pushed through the wet deck, causing a small portion of the water to evaporate. Evaporation removes heat from the remaining water, which is collected in the cold water basin and returned to the system to absorb more heat. Each open cooling tower line, although operating under the same basic principle of operation, is arranged a little differently. See the schematics on the Product Line Overview Table for product specific details.
Configuration
There are two main configurations of factory assembled open cooling towers: crossflow and counterflow. In crossflow cooling towers, the water flows vertically down the wet deck as the air flows horizontally across it. In counterflow cooling towers, the water flows vertically down the wet deck as the air flows vertically up it.
Crossflow Configuration
Counterflow Configuration
Baltimore Aircoil
CT - B 3
Fan System
The flow of air through most factory assembled evaporative cooling equipment is provided by one or more mechanically driven fans. The fan(s) may be axial or centrifugal, each type having its own distinct advantages. Axial fan units require approximately half the fan motor kilowatt of comparably sized centrifugal fan units, offering significant life-cycle cost savings. Centrifugal fan units are capable of overcoming reasonable amounts of external static pressure ( 125 Pa), making them suitable for both indoor and outdoor installations. Centrifugal fans are also inherently quieter than axial fans, although the difference is minimal and can often be overcome through the application of optional low sound fans and/or sound attenuation on axial fan units. Fans can be applied in an induced draft or a forced draft configuration.
Centrifugal Fans
Axial Fans
Induced Draft The rotating air handling components of induced draft equipment are mounted in the top deck of the unit, minimizing the impact of fan noise on near-by neighbors and providing maximum protection from fan icing with units operating in sub-freezing conditions. The air being drawn through the unit hereby discharges over the inducing fan. The use of corrosion resistant materials ensures long life and minimizes maintenance requirements for the air handling components. Forced Draft Rotating air-handling components are located on the air inlet face at the base of forced draft towers whereby fresh air is blown through the unit. This base fan position facilitates easy access for routine maintenance and service. Additionally, location of these components in the dry entering air stream extends component life by isolating them from the corrosive saturated discharge air.
Capacity Range
In the following Product Line Overview Table, product capacity range is called out in terms of water flow capability at 35C/30C/21C. A nominal cooling tower capacity is defined at 35C entering water temperature to a 30C leaving water temperature at a 21C entering wet-bulb temperature.
CT - B 4
Nominal conditions are typical of conventional HVAC designs but will not apply to all projects. All water flow capacities shown are for a single cell; multiple cell units can be applied to achieve larger capacities.
Overview
Typical Applications
A list of typical applications is provided in the Product Line Overview Table for your reference.
Principle of Operation
Configuration Water Distribution Fan System Capacity Range (Single Cell) Maximum Entering Water Temperature
Crossflow Gravity Axial Fan, Induced Draft 40 to 260 l/s 50 C standard wet deck 55C Alternative wet deck material
Crossflow Gravity Axial Fan, Induced Draft 10 tot 128 l/s 50 C standard wet deck 55C Alternative wet deck material
Crossflow Gravity Axial Fan, Forced Draft 3 tot 145 l/s 50 C standard wet deck 55C Alternative wet deck material
Typical Applications
Medium to large HVAC & industrial applications Replacement of field erected towers
Medium HVAC & industrial applications Counterflow unit replacements Crossflow unit replacements Tight enclosures & installations requiring a single air inlet
1. Air in, 2. Air Out, 3. Hot Water In, 4. Cooled Water out, 5. Water; 6. Wet Deck Surface, 7. Cold Water Basin; 8. Water Distribution System; 9. Eliminators.
Note: For projects requiring water conservation and/or plume sensitive location, VXT and VTL cooling towers can be equipped with plume abatement coils (PAC) in combination with 3-way valve arrangement. Refer to your BAC Balticare representative for more details and selections.
Baltimore Aircoil
CT - B 5
Note : BAC offers heat exchanger skids in combination with most of his open cooling tower products. These skids are available for both new installations or to retrofit on existing installations. The heat exchanger skid consists of a plate heat exchanger with pump and interconnecting piping and appendages. The skids are delivered on a heavy duty frame and with steel panel enclosure. Refer to your BAC Balticare representative for more details and selections.
RCT
IMT
VTL
VXT
Counterflow Pressurised Axial Fan, Induced Draft 40 to 145 l/s 55C Standard Wet Deck 65C w/Alternate Wet Deck Materials Small to medium industrial applications Dirty Water applications
Counterflow Pressurised Axial Fan, Induced Draft 45 to 560 l/s 55C Standard Wet Deck 65C w/Alternate Wet Deck Materials Large industrial applications Replacement of field erected towers with basinless units Dirty water applications.
Counterflow Pressurised Centrifugal Fan, Forced Draft 4 tot 90 l/s 55C Standard Wet Deck 65 C w/Alternate Wet Deck Materials Small to medium HVAC & Industrial applications Installations w/extremely low height requirements Indoor Installations High temperature industrial applications Tight enclosures & installations requiring a single air inlet
Counterflow Pressurised Centrifugal Fan, Forced Draft 1,6 to 1230 l/s 55C Standard Wet Deck 65C w/Alternate Wet Deck Materials Small to medium HVAC & industrial applications Indoor installations High temperature industrial applications Tight enclosures & installations requiring a single air inlet
CT - B 6
Engineering Considerations
Location
Units must have an adequate supply of fresh air to the air inlet(s). When units are located adjacent to building walls or in enclosures, care must be taken to ensure that the warm, saturated discharge air is not deflected off surrounding walls or enclosures and drawn back to the air inlet(s).
Warning: Each unit should be located and positioned to prevent the introduction of the warm discharge air and the associated drift, which may contain chemical or biological contaminants including Legionella, into the ventilation systems of the building on which the unit is located or those of adjacent buildings.
Overview
Note: For detailed recommendations on layout, please consult your local BAC Balticare Representative.
For VL and VX products, bottom screens or solid bottom panels may be desirable or necessary for safety, depending on the location and conditions at the installation site.
Capacity Control
Variable Frequency Drives (VFD) Installations which are to be controlled by Variable Frequency Drives (VFD) require the use of an inverter duty motor as designed IEC 34.1, which recognizes the increased stresses placed on motors by these drive systems. Inverter duty motors must be furnished on VFD applications in order to maintain the motor warranty. Fan motors must be furnished with thermal protection (either PTC sensors or coil thermostats normally open, or normally closed). The motor protection consists of temperature sensitive cutout devices embedded in the motor windings (minimum 3 per motor). BAC offers factory installed motor control packages including VFD drives. Refer to the section "Technical Resources, Motor Controls". Check with your local BAC Balticare representative for availability.
Warning: When the fan speed is to be changed from the factory-set speed, including through the use of a variable speed control device, steps must be taken to avoid operating at or near fan speeds that cause a resonance with the unit or its supporting structure. At start-up, the variable frequency drive should be cycled slowly between zero and full speed and any speeds that cause a noticeable resonance in the unit should be locked out by the variable speed drive.
Fan Cycling Fan cycling is the simplest method of capacity control. The number of steps of capacity control can be increased using the Baltiguard Fan System, the independent fan motor option, or two-speed fan motors in conjunction with fan cycling (see the Custom Features & Options section of the
Baltimore Aircoil
CT - B 7
appropriate product line to determine whether the Baltiguard Fan System or the independent fan motor option are available; two-speed motors are available for all products). These options provide substantial energy savings when compared to simple fan cycling.
Warning: Rapid on-off cycling can cause the fan motor to overheat. It is recommended that controls be set to allow a maximum of 6 on-off cycles per hour.
Capacity Control Dampers (VTL and VXT Models Only) On centrifugal fan models, modulating capacity control dampers are available to provide close control of the leaving temperature. See Section "Accessories" or contact your local BAC Balticare representative.
Water Treatment
As water evaporates in the unit, the dissolved solids originally present in the water remain in the system. The concentration of these dissolved solids increases rapidly and can cause scale and corrosion. In addition, airborne impurities and biological contaminants, including Legionella, may be introduced into the circulating water. To control all potential contaminants, a water treatment program must be employed. In many cases, a simple bleed-off may be adequate for control of scale and corrosion. However, biological contamination, including Legionella, can be controlled only through the use of biocides. Such treatment should be initiated at system startup, after periods of equipment shutdown, and continued regularly thereafter. Accordingly, it is strongly recommended a biocide treatment be initiated when the unit is first filled with water and continued regularly thereafter. For more information, consult the appropriate Operating and Maintenance Manual. When a water treatment program is employed, it must be compatible with construction materials. Batch feeding of chemicals into the unit is not recommended. If units are constructed with optional corrosion resistant materials, acid treatment may be considered; however, the water quality must be maintained within the guidelines set forth in the Operating and Maintenance Instructions.
Note: Unless a common remote sump is utilised, each cell of a multi-cell installation must be treated as a separate entity, even if the cold water basins are equalised.
For complete Water Quality Guidelines, see the appropriate Operating and Maintenance Instruction Manual, available at www.baltimoreaircoil.com. For specific recommendations on water treatment, contact a competent water treatment supplier.
Sound Levels
Sound rating data are available for all BAC models. When calculating the sound levels generated by a unit, the designer must take into account the effects of the geometry of the tower as well as the distance and direction from the unit to noise-sensitive areas. Whisper Quiet fans and intake and discharge sound attenuation can be supplied on certain models to provide reduced sound characteristics (see the Custom Features and Options section of the appropriate product line for details). The Baltiguard Fan System, two-speed motors, or variable frequency drives can also be used to reduce sound during periods of non-peak thermal loads. For more information on sound and how it relates to evaporative cooling equipment, see Section "Technical Resources, Fundamentals of Sound". For detailed low sound selections, please consult your local BAC Balticare Representative.
CT - B 8
Winterization
When a unit is shut down in freezing weather, the basin water must be protected by draining to an indoor auxiliary remote sump tank or by providing supplementary heat to the cold water basin. Supplementary heat can be provided by electric immersion heaters or in some cases, hot water, steam coils, or steam injectors. All exposed water piping, make-up lines, and spray pumps (if applicable) that do not drain at shutdown should be traced with electric heater tape and insulated. For remote sump applications, the spray water pump must be selected for the required flow at a total head which includes the vertical lift, pipe friction (in supply and suction lines) plus the required pressure at the inlet header of the water distribution system (14 kPa). A valve should always be installed in the discharge line from the pump to permit adjusting flow to the unit requirement. Inlet water pressure should be measured by a pressure gauge installed in the water supply riser at the spray water inlet, and adjusted to the specified inlet pressure.
Overview
Note: Axial fan units are not suitable for indoor installations.
Safety
Adequate precautions, appropriate for the installation and location of these products, should be taken to safeguard the public from possible injury and the equipment and the premises from damage. Operation, maintenance and repair of this equipment should be undertaken only by personnel qualified to do so. Proper care, procedures and tools must be used in handling, lifting, installing, operating, maintaining, and repairing this equipment to prevent personal injury and/or property damage.
For applications where the entering water temperature exceeds the limits shown above, contact your local BAC Balticare Representative for assistance.
Baltimore Aircoil
S3000D
-B9
S3000D
Product Detail
S3000D Open Cooling Towers ................................................................ B10 Benefits ...................................................................................................... B11 Construction Details ................................................................................ B13 Custom Features and Options ................................................................ B14 Accessories ............................................................................................... B16 Engineering Data ..................................................................................... B19 Structural Support .................................................................................. B24 Engineering Specifications ..................................................................... B27
S3000D
- B 10
S3000D
General Description
Series 3000D Cooling Towers deliver independently verified, fully rated thermal performance over a wide range of flow and temperature requirements. Standard design features satisfy todays environmental concerns, minimize installation costs, maximize year-round operating reliability, and simplify maintenance requirements.
Key Features
z
Low energy consumption Low installed cost Easy maintenance Reliable year-round operation Long service life Easy removable high efficient fill as standard Cold water basin is to be free draining
Baltimore Aircoil
S3000D
- B 11
Benefits
Low Energy Consumption
z
Evaporative cooling equipment minimises the energy consumption of the entire system because it provides lower operating temperatures. The owner saves money while conserving natural resources and reducing environmental impact. The cooling towers provide the heat rejection required at the lowest possible energy input via:
- High efficiency, low kW axial fans - High efficiency easy removable heat exchange surface, which provides maximum air/water contact time at low air pressure drops - Variable Frequency Drives
Support All models mount directly on two parallel I-beams and ship complete with motors and drives factory-installed and aligned. Modular Design Models S3-D728L through S3-D1056L and S3-D1132L through S3-D1301L ship in two sections to minimise the size and weight of the heaviest lift, allowing for the use of smaller, less costly cranes.
Modular Design
Belt Drive System utilizes special corrosion-resistant materials of construction and state-ofthe-art technology to ensure ease of maintenance and reliable year-round performance. Combined Inlet Shields prevent biological growth from sunlight, act as a filter for air borne impurities and debris and eliminate water splash out.
S3000D
- B 12
S3000D
Spacer Rod
Frame Construction Enables casing panels, critical links for long service life, to be constructed of corrosion-resistant, fiberglass reinforced polyester (FRP). Materials of Construction Various materials are available to meet the corrosion resistance, unit operating life, and budgetary requirements of any project (see section: Custom Features and Options for more details).
Easy Maintenance
z
Easy Cleaning The wet deck surface is elevated above the sloped cold water basin floor to facilitate flushing of dirt and debris from this critical area. Hinged Access Doors Provide easy entry to the spacious plenum for routine drive maintenance.
Baltimore Aircoil
S3000D
- B 13
Construction Details
1. Heavy-Duty Construction
z
z z
6. BACross II Wet Deck Surface with Integral Drift Eliminators (Not Shown)
z z z
Plastic material Impervious to rot, decay and biological attack Designed and manufactured by BAC
Premium quality belts Corrosion resistant sheaves Heavy-duty bearings Adapted fan motor for operation in saturated conditions.
Sloped cold water basin for easy cleaning Suction strainer with anti-vortex hood Adjustable water make-up assembly from inside the unit
S3000D
- B 14
Standard Construction: Steel panels and structural elements are constructed of Z600 heavy-gauge hot-dip galvanized steel. All external steel panels are protected with the Baltiplus Corrosion Protection. Casing panels are constructed of UV resistant fiberglass reinforced polyester. Optional BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System: The BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System, a hybrid polymer coating used to extend equipment life, is applied to all hot-dip galvanized steel components of the unit. Optional Stainless Steel Cold Water Basin: A type 304 or 316 stainless steel cold water basin is provided.
S3000D
Note: See section Technical Resources, Material Options for more details on the materials described above.
Baltimore Aircoil
S3000D
- B 15
S3000D
- B 16
Accessories
External Service Platform
For external service, platforms can be added to the unit.
S3000D
In the event the owner requires easy access to the top of the unit, the unit can be furnished with a platform and ladders extending from the base of the unit to the platform, as well as safety cages, and handrail packages.
Internal Walkway
Baltimore Aircoil
S3000D
- B 17
Basin Heaters
Units exposed to below freezing ambient temperatures require protection to prevent freezing of the water in the cold water basin when the unit is idle. Factory-installed heaters, which maintain the water temperature at 4C, are a simple and inexpensive way of providing such protection. The heater package includes the heaters, a thermostat and a low level cut out switch to protect the heaters if the water level is too low. Standard electric heaters are selected for -18C ambient temperature.
Model No. S3000D S3-D240 L S3-D379 L S3-D412 L S3-D527 L S3-D473 L S3-D672 L S3-D728 L S3-D1056 L S3-D583 L S3-D725 L S3-D1132 L S3-D1301 L
S3000D
- B 18
S3000D
Baltimore Aircoil
S3000D
- B 19
Engineering Data
REMARK: Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
1. Water In; 2. Overflow ND80; 3. Make-up; 4. Water Out; 5. Drain ND50; 6. Access Door; 7. S3-D728 L thru S3-D1056 L and S3-D1132 L thru S3-D1301 L ship in two sections per cell. The top section is the heaviest and tallest. Top section heights are: S3-D728 L thru S3-D970 L: 3125 mm; S3-D1132 L: 3330 mm; S3-D985 L thru S3-D1056 L: 3533 mm; S3-D1213 L: 3736 mm; S3-D1301 L: 3822mm.
Model
Airflow (m/s)
S3-D240 L S3-D272 L S3-D299 L S3-D333 L S3-D358 L S3-D379 L S3-D412 L S3-D436 L S3-D455 L S3-D482 L S3-D527 L S3-D473 L S3-D501 L S3-D552 L S3-D604 L S3-D648 L S3-D672 L S3-D728 L S3-D781 L S3-D828 L S3-D872 L S3-D923 L S3-D970 L S3-D985 L S3-D1056 L
28,6 32,5 35,6 39,1 41,9 44,4 47,2 50,1 51,2 54,2 59,4 54,2 57,4 62,1 68,0 72,9 75,7 81,6 87,5 92,6 94,2 99,8 104,9 104,9 112,4
6706 6765 6792 7151 7164 7187 8435 8458 8844 8867 8939 10483 10506 11663 11736 11740 12285 14555 14560 14660 15904 16004 16585 18269 18310
3083 3142 3169 3296 3310 3332 3823 3845 3968 3991 4063 4626 4649 4903 4976 4980 5530 6251 6256 6351 6583 6678 7264 7064 7105
3083 3142 3169 3296 3310 3332 3823 3845 3968 3991 4063 4626 4649 4903 4976 4980 5530 3959 3963 4059 3995 4091 4676 4295 4336
2584 2584 2584 2584 2584 2584 2978 2978 2978 2978 2978 3600 3600 3600 3600 3600 3600 3600 3600 3600 3600 3600 3600 3600 3600
5500 5500 5500 5500 5500 5500 6110 6110 6110 6110 6110 6566 6566 6566 6566 6566 6566 6566 6566 6566 6566 6566 6566 6566 6566
2915 2915 2915 3321 3321 3321 3321 3321 3727 3727 3727 3423 3423 3829 3829 3829 3829 4915 4915 5042 5728 5728 5804 6540 6616
2635 2635 2635 3040 3040 3040 3040 3040 3450 3450 3450 3040 3040 3450 3450 3450 3450 4710 4710 4710 5525 5525 5525 6335 6335
S3000D
- B 20
Model
Airflow (m/s)
18,5 22 30 37 55 55 75
S3000D
S3-D1213 L S3-D1301 L
1. Water In; 2. Overflow; 3. Make-up; 4. Water Out; 5. Drain ND50; 6. Access Door; 7. S3-D728 L thru S3-D1056 L and S3-D1132 L thru S3D1301 L ship in two sections per cell. The top section is the heaviest and tallest. Top section heights are: S3-D728 L thru S3-D970 L: 3125 mm; S3-D1132 L: 3330 mm; S3-D985 L thru S3-D1056 L: 3533 mm; S3-D1213 L: 3736 mm; S3-D1301 L: 3822mm.
Model
Airflow (m/s)
S3-D240-2 L S3-D272-2 L S3-D299-2 L S3-D333-2 L S3-D358-2 L S3-D379-2 L S3-D412-2 L S3-D436-2 L S3-D455-2 L S3-D482-2 L S3-D527-2 L S3-D473-2 L S3-D501-2 L S3-D552-2 L S3-D604-2 L S3-D648-2 L S3-D672-2 L
(2) 7,5 (2) 11 (2) 15 (2) 15 (2) 18,5 (2) 22 (2) 18,5 (2) 22 (2) 18,5 (2) 22 (2) 30 (2) 18,5 (2) 22 (2) 22 (2) 30 (2) 37 (2) 45
57,2 65,0 71,2 78,2 83,8 88,8 94,4 100,2 52,4 108,4 118,8 108,4 114,8 124,2 136,0 145,8 151,4
13412 13530 13584 14302 14328 14374 16870 16916 17688 17734 17878 20966 21012 23326 23472 23480 24570
6166 6284 6338 6592 6620 6664 7646 7690 7936 7982 8126 9252 9298 9806 9952 9960 11060
3083 3142 3169 3296 3310 3332 3823 3845 3968 3991 4063 4626 4649 4903 4976 4980 5530
5232 5232 5232 5232 5232 5232 6020 6020 6020 6020 6020 7264 7264 7264 7264 7264 7264
5500 5500 5500 5500 5500 5500 6110 6110 6110 6110 6110 6566 6566 6566 6566 6566 6566
2915 2915 2915 3321 3321 3321 3321 3321 3727 3727 3727 3423 3423 3829 3829 3829 3829
2635 2635 2635 3040 3040 3040 3040 3040 3450 3450 3450 3040 3040 3450 3450 3450 3450
Baltimore Aircoil
S3000D
- B 21
Model
Airflow (m/s)
S3-D728-2 L S3-D781-2 L S3-D828-2 L S3-D872-2 L S3-D923-2 L S3-D970-2 L S3-D985-2 L S3-D1056-2 L S3-D583-2 L S3-D618-2 L S3-D676-2 L S3-D725-2 L S3-D1132-2 L S3-D1213-2 L S3-D1301-2 L
(2) 30 (2) 37 (2) 45 (2) 37 (2) 45 (2) 55 (2) 45 (2) 55 (2) 18,5 (2) 22 (2) 30 (2) 37 (2) 55 (2) 55 (2) 75
163,2 175,0 185,2 198,4 199,6 209,8 209,8 224,8 131,4 139,0 152,2 163,4 244,2 257,0 276,0
29110 29120 29320 31808 32008 33170 36538 36620 27512 27558 27704 27712 37492 40224 42302
12502 12512 12702 13166 13356 14528 14128 14210 10960 11004 11150 11160 15080 15936 18014
3959 3963 4059 3995 4091 4676 4295 4336 5480 5502 5575 5580 4644 4867 5906
7264 7264 7264 7264 7264 7264 7264 7264 8555 8555 8555 8555 8555 8555 8555
6566 6566 6566 6566 6566 6566 6566 6566 7328 7328 7328 7328 7328 7328 7328
4915 4915 5042 5728 5728 5804 6540 6540 3651 3651 3651 3651 5864 6769 6769
4710 4710 4710 5525 5525 5525 6335 6335 3450 3450 3450 3450 5525 6335 6335
General Notes
1. Operating weight is for tower with the water level in the cold water basin at overflow. If a lower operating wieght is needed to meet design requirements, your local BAC Balticare Sales Representative can provide additional assistance. 2. Models S3-D970 L, S3-D1056 L, S3-D1132 L, S3-D1213 L and S3D-1301 L are supplied with a gear fan drive system as standard. 3. Models shipped with aan optional gear drive or low sound fan may have heights up to 265 mm greater than shown. 4. Heights are for units with belt drive except models with motors of 55 kW and larger where gear box is standard.
Connection Sizes
Model S3000 S3-D240 L S3-D272 L S3-D299 L S3-D333 L S3-D358 L S3-D379 L S3-D412 L S3-D436 L S3-D455 L S3-D482 L S3-D527 L S3-D473 L S3-D501 L S3-D552 L S3-D604 L S3-D648 L S3-D672 L S3-D728 L S3-D781 L S3-D828 L S3-D872 L S3-D923 L S3-D970 L S3-D985 L S3-D1056 L Top Inlet (mm) (2x) ND 150 (2x) ND 150 (2x) ND 150 (2x) ND 150 (2x) ND 150 (2x) ND 150 (2x) ND 150 (2x) ND 150 (2x) ND 150 (2x) ND 150 (2x) ND 150 (2x) ND 200 (2x) ND 200 (2x) ND 200 (2x) ND 200 (2x) ND 200 (2x) ND 200 (2x) ND 200 (2x) ND 200 (2x) ND 200 (2x) ND 200 (2x) ND 200 (2x) ND 200 (2x) ND 200 (2x) ND 200 Water Outlet (mm) (1x) ND 200 (1x) ND 200 (1x) ND 200 (1x) ND 200 (1x) ND 200 (1x) ND 200 (1x) ND 200 (1x) ND 200 (1x) ND 250 (1x) ND 250 (1x) ND 250 (1x) ND 250 (1x) ND 250 (1x) ND 250 (1x) ND 250 (1x) ND 250 (1x) ND 250 (1x) ND 300 (1x) ND 300 (1x) ND 300 (1x) ND 300 (1x) ND 300 (1x) ND 300 (1x) ND 300 (1x) ND 300 Make-Up (mm) ND 25 ND 25 ND 25 ND 25 ND 25 ND 25 ND 50 ND 50 ND 50 ND 50 ND 50 ND 50 ND 50 ND 50 ND 50 ND 50 ND 50 ND 50 ND 50 ND 50 ND 50 ND 50 ND 50 ND 50 ND 50 F (mm) 6 6 6 6 6 6 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 G (mm) 1292 1292 1292 1292 1292 1292 1489 1489 1489 1489 1489 1800 1800 1800 1800 1800 1800 1800 1800 1800 1800 1800 1800 1800 1800 J (mm) 2648 2648 2648 2648 2648 2648 3042 3042 3042 3042 3042 3664 3664 3664 3664 3664 3664 3664 3664 3664 3664 3664 3664 3664 3664
S3000D
- B 22
Top Inlet (mm) (2x) ND 200 (2x) ND 200 (2x) ND 200 (2x) ND 200 (2x) ND 250 (2x) ND 250 (2x) ND 250
Water Outlet (mm) (1x) ND 250 (1x) ND 300 (1x) ND 300 (1x) ND 300 (1x) ND 350 (1x) ND 350 (1x) ND 350
Make-Up (mm) ND 50 ND 50 ND 50 ND 50 ND 50 ND 50 ND 50
F (mm) 15 15 15 15 15 15 15
S3000D
Notes:
1. Unless otherwise indicated, all connections DN150 and smaller are MPT, and connections DN200 and larger are beveled for welding. 2. On double cell units, connections are the same size but are located on both ends of the unit.
Model No. S3-D240 L S3-D272 L S3-D299 L S3-D333 L S3-D358 L S3-D379 L S3-D412 L S3-D436 L S3-D455 L S3-D482 L S3-D527 L S3-D473 L S3-D501 L S3-D552 L S3-D604 L S3-D648 L S3-D672 L S3-D583 L S3-D618 L S3-D676 L S3-D725 L
A (mm) 2578 2578 2578 2578 2578 2578 3035 3035 3035 3035 3035 3340 3340 3340 3340 3340 3340 3645 3645 3645 3645
B (mm) 1715 1715 1715 2121 2121 2121 2121 2121 2527 2527 2527 2121 2121 2527 2527 2527 2527 2527 2527 2527 2527
Weight Discharge Attenuator (kg) (1) 350 350 350 350 350 350 400 400 400 400 400 460 460 460 460 460 460 550 550 550 550
Weight Intake Attenuator (kg) (2) (3) 340 340 340 420 420 420 480 480 570 570 570 580 580 690 690 690 690 810 810 810 810
Baltimore Aircoil
S3000D
- B 23
Model No.
A (mm) 3645 3645 3645 3645 3645 3645 3645 3645 4255 4255 4255
B1 (mm) 994 994 994 1807 1807 1807 2213 2213 1807 2213 2213
B2 (mm) 2353 2353 2353 2353 2353 2353 2353 2353 2353 2759 2759
Weight Discharge Attenuator (1) (kg) 480 480 480 480 480 480 480 480 570 570 570
Weight Lower Intake Attenuator (both) (2) (3) (kg) 270 270 270 500 500 500 500 500 580 710 710
Weight Upper Intake Attenuator(both) (2) (3) (kg) 640 640 640 640 640 640 750 750 750 880 880
S3-D728 L S3-D781 L S3-D828 L S3-D872 L S3-D923 L S3-D970 L S3-D985 L S3-D1056 L S3-D1132L S3-D1213L S3-D1301L
S3000D
- B 24
Structural Support
REMARK: Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
The recommended support arrangement for the Series 3000D Cooling Tower, consists of parallel I-beams positioned as shown in the drawings. Besides providing adequate support, the steel also serves to raise the unit above any solid foundation to assure access to the bottom of the tower. The Series 3000D may also be supported on columns at the anchor bolt locations as shown the following Plan. A minimum bearing surface of 100 cm must be provided under each of the concentrated load points (See Note 6 following page). To support a Series 3000D Cooling Tower on columns, or in an alternate steel support arrangement, consult your BAC Balticare Representative.
S3000D
1. Outline of unit; 2. Air Inlet Side; 3. Mounting Holes (see Note 7); 4. Additional Anchor Bolts (see note 8).
1. Outline of unit; 2. Air Inlet Side; 3. Mounting Holes (see Note 7).
Baltimore Aircoil
S3000D
- B 25
1. Outline of unit; 2. Air Inlet Side; 3. Mounting Holes (see Note 7); 4. Additional Anchor Bolts (see note 8).
Model No.
Operating Weight (1) (kg) 6706 6765 6792 7151 7164 7187 8435 8458 8844 8867 8939 10483 10506 11663 11736 11740 12285 14555 14560 14660 15904 16004 16585 18269 18310 13756 13779 13852 13856 18746 20112 21151
Shipping Weight (1)(2) (kg) 3083 3142 3169 3296 3310 3332 3823 3845 3968 3991 4063 4626 4649 4903 4976 4980 5530 6251 6256 6351 6583 6678 7264 7064 7105 5480 5502 5575 5580 7540 7968 9007
Weight at bolt hole location (1)(2) (kg) 1677 1691 1698 1788 1791 1797 2109 2115 2211 2217 2235 2621 2627 2916 2934 2935 3071 3639 3640 3665 3976 4001 4146 4567 4578 3439 3445 3463 3464 4687 5028 5288
Length (L1) (mm) 2584 2584 2584 2584 2584 2584 2978 2978 2978 2978 2978 3600 3600 3600 3600 3600 3600 3600 3600 3600 3600 3600 3600 3600 3600 4245 4245 4245 4245 4245 4245 4245
Length (L2) (mm) 5232 5232 5232 5232 5232 5232 6020 6020 6020 6020 6020 7264 7264 7264 7264 7264 7264 7264 7264 7264 7264 7264 7264 7264 7264 8555 8555 8555 8555 8555 8555 8555
Width (W) (mm) 5500 5500 5500 5500 5500 5500 6110 6110 6110 6110 6110 6566 6566 6566 6566 6566 6566 6566 6566 6566 6566 6566 6566 6566 6566 7328 7328 7328 7328 7328 7328 7328
A (mm) 2845 2845 2845 2845 2845 2845 3454 3454 3454 3454 3454 3912 3912 3912 3912 3912 3912 3912 3912 3912 3912 3912 3912 3912 3912 4674 4674 4674 4674 4674 4674 4674
B (mm) 4991 4991 4991 4991 4991 4991 5600 5600 5600 5600 5600 6058 6058 6058 6058 6058 6058 6058 6058 6058 6058 6058 6058 6058 6058 6820 6820 6820 6820 6820 6820 6820
C (mm) 29 29 29 29 29 29 29 29 29 29 29 29 29 29 29 29 29 29 29 29 29 29 29 29 29 37 37 37 37 37 37 37
D (mm) 2527 2527 2527 2527 2527 2527 2921 2921 2921 2921 2921 3543 3543 3543 3543 3543 3543 3543 3543 3543 3543 3543 3543 3543 3543 4172 4172 4172 4172 4172 4172 4172
E (mm) 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 137 137 137 137 137 137 137
S3-D240 L S3-D272 L S3-D299 L S3-D333 L S3-D358 L S3-D379 L S3-D412 L S3-D436 L S3-D455 L S3-D482 L S3-D527 L S3-D473 L S3-D501 L S3-D552 L S3-D604 L S3-D648 L S3-D672 L S3-D728 L S3-D781 L S3-D828 L S3-D872 L S3-D923 L S3-D970 L S3-D985 L S3-D1056 L S3-D583 L S3-D618 L S3-D676 L S3-D725 L S3-D1132 L S3-D1213 L S3-D1301 L
S3000D
- B 26
Notes:
1. Weights are for a single cell. To obtain weights for multi-cell units, multiply by the number of cells. 2. Operating weight and weight loading are for a single cell tower with water at overflow level in the cold water basin. 3. Support beams and anchor bolts to be selected and installed by parties other than BAC. 4. All support steel must be level at the top. 6. If point vibration isolation is used with multi-cell towers, the isolators must be located under the support steel, not between the support steel and the cooling towers. 7. 19 mm mounting holes. 4 holes required for models S3-D240 L through S3-D725 L. 8 holes required for models S3-D728 L through S3-D1301 L. 8. Detail for additional anchor bolt models S3-D725 L through S3D1301 L.
S3000D
5. Beams must be selected in accordance with accepted structural practice. Maximum deflection of beam under unit to be 1/360 of span, not to exceed 12 mm.
Baltimore Aircoil
S3000D
- B 27
Engineering Specifications
1.0 Cooling Tower
1.1 General: Furnish and install _____ factory-assembled, induceddraft, axial fan, crossflow cooling tower(s) with vertical air discharge, conforming in all aspects to the specifications, schedules and as shown on the plans. Overall dimensions shall not exceed approximately _____ mm long x ______ mm wide x _____ mm high. The total connected fan kW shall not exceed _____ kW. The cooling tower(s) shall be Baltimore Aircoil Model ____________. 1.2 Thermal Capacity: The cooling tower(s) shall be warranted by the manufacturer to cool _____ l/s of water from ______ C to _____C at _____C entering wet-bulb temperature. 1.3 Corrosion Resistant Construction (standard): Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all structural members shall be constructed of heavy-gauge Z600 metric hot-dip galvanised steel with all edges given a protective coating of zinc-rich compound. All external surfaces are protected with the BALTIPLUS Corrosion Protection. Casing panels shall be constructed of corrosion and UV-resistant fibreglass reinforced polyester (FRP) to minimise maintenance requirements and prolong equipment life. (Alternate 1.3) Corrosion Resistant Construction (optional): Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all structural members shall be protected with the BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System. The system shall consist of Z600 metric hot-dip galvanised steel prepared in a four-step (clean, pre-treat, rinse, dry) process with an electrostatically sprayed, thermosetting, hybrid polymer fusebonded to the substrate during a thermally activated curing stage and monitored by a 23-step quality assurance program. Casing panels shall be constructed of corrosion and UV-resistant fibreglass reinforced polyester (FRP) to minimise maintenance requirements and prolong equipment life.
(Alternate 1.3) Type 304 or 316 Stainless Steel Construction: All structural members, including the structural frame, hot and cold water basins, distribution covers and fan deck shall be constructed of Type 304 or 316 stainless steel and assembled with stainless steel nut and bolt fasteners. Fan cylinder shall be galvanised steel protected with the Baltibond Corrosion Protection System. Casing panels shall be constructed of corrosion and UV-resistant fibreglass reinforced polyester (FRP) to minimise maintenance requirements and prolong equipment life. 1.4 Quality Assurance: The cooling tower manufacturer shall have a Management System certified by an accredited registrar as complying with the requirements of ISO-9001:2000 to ensure consistent quality of products and services. 1.5 Warranty: The manufacturers standard equipment warranty shall be for a period of not less than one year from date of startup or eighteen months from date of shipment, whichever occurs first.
S3000D
- B 28
S3000D
5.1. Combined Inlet Shields: Combined inlet shields shall be separate from the wet deck surface and removable to allow easy access for inspection of the air/water interface at the air inlet side of the equipment. Combined inlet shields shall prevent UV-light and
debris from entering the unit, as well as prevent water splash out during fan cycling. They shall be constructed of maintenance free, corrosion and UV resistant material.
6.0 Access
6.1 Plenum Access: Two hinged access doors shall be provided for access into the plenum section.
7.0 Sound
7.1 Sound Level: To maintain the quality of the local environment, the maximum sound pressure levels (dB) measured 15 m from the cooling tower operating at full fan speed shall not exceed the sound levels detailed below. (Alternate) 7.1 Sound Level: To maintain the quality of the local environment, the cooling tower shall be furnished with an extremely low sound fan Type Whisper Quiet. Maximum sound pressure levels (dB) measured 15 m from the cooling tower operating at full fan speed shall not exceed the sound levels detailed below.
63
125
250
500
1000
2000
4000
8000
dB(A)
Baltimore Aircoil
TXV - B 29
TXV
Product Detail
TXV Open Cooling Tower ...................................................................... B30 Benefits ..................................................................................................... B32 Construction Details ................................................................................ B34 Custom Features and Options ................................................................ B35 Accessories ............................................................................................... B37 Engineering Data ..................................................................................... B39 Structural Support .................................................................................. B42 Engineering Specifications ..................................................................... B43
TXV - B 30
TXV
General Description
Series 1500 Cooling Towers minimize the operating, installation, and maintenance costs associated with both new and replacement cooling tower projects. The Series 1500 delivers fully rated thermal performance over a wide range of flow and temperature requirements. Standard design features minimize the costs associated with enclosures, support requirements, electrical service, piping, and rigging.
Key Features
z
Ideal replacement unit Single side air inlet Low energy consumption Low installed cost Easy maintenance Reliable year-round operation Long service life
Baltimore Aircoil
TXV - B 31
TXV - B 32
Benefits
Ideal Replacement Unit
z
Support Steel Units are designed to mount directly on the existing support steel of many cooling towers (both cross flow and counter flow). Electrical Service Fan motor configurations can be supplied to match existing wiring. Enclosures Units fit in most existing enclosures with little or no modifications due to the single air inlet design.
Single air inlet provides installation flexibility in tight layouts
TXV
Evaporative Cooling Equipment minimizes the energy consumption of the entire system because it provides lower operating temperatures. The owner saves money while conserving natural resources and reducing environmental impact. TXV provides heat rejection at the lowest possible energy input and maintenance requirements via: - High efficiency, low kW axial fans - High efficiency BACross Wet Deck, which provides maximum air/water contact time at low air pressure drops - Multiple Fan Motor System: independent fan motor and drive assembly per fan, which allows extra steps of capacity control.
Baltimore Aircoil
TXV - B 33
Single Side Air Inlet Units can be placed close to solid walls, reducing the size of enclosures and allowing for more profitable use of premium space. Modular Design The modular design minimizes the size and weight of the heaviest lift, allowing for the use of smaller, less costly cranes. Modular Design All models mount directly on parallel I-beams and ship complete with motors and drives factory-installed and aligned.
The unit shown ships in tow pieces to minimize shipping and rigging costs
Easy Maintenance
z
Easy Cleaning The wet deck surface is elevated above the sloped cold water basin floor to facilitate flushing of dirt and debris from this critical area. Hinged Access Doors and Standard Internal Walkway Provide easy entry to the spacious plenum for routine drive maintenance. Accessibility Make-up, drain, overflow and optional basin accessories are accessible from outside the unit.
Belt Drive System utilizes special corrosion-resistant materials of construction and state-ofthe-art technology to ensure ease of maintenance and reliable year-round performance. Combined Inlet Shields prevent biological growth from sunlight, act as a filter for air borne impurities and debris and eliminate water splash out.
Materials of Construction Various materials are available to meet the corrosion resistance, unit operating life, and budgetary requirements of any project (See section Technical Resources, Materials of Construction" for more details)
TXV - B 34
Construction Details
TXV
1. Heavy-Duty Construction
z
5. BACross Wet Deck Surface with Integral Drift Eliminators (Not Shown)
z
Plastic material Impervious to rot, decay and biological attack Designed and manufactured by BAC
Premium quality belts Corrosion resistant sheaves Heavy-duty bearings Adapted fan motor for operation in saturated conditions.
z z
Sloped cold water basin for easy cleaning Suction strainer with anti-vortex hood Adjustable water make-up assembly from air inlet side Integral internal walkway as standard
Steel covers in easy to remove sections Low pump head gravity distribution basin Large orifice, non-clog nozzles Integral strainer
Baltimore Aircoil
TXV - B 35
Standard Construction: Steel panels and structural elements are constructed of Z600 heavy-gauge hot-dip galvanized steel protected with the Baltiplus Corrosion Protection on the outside of the unit. Optional BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System: The BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System, a hybrid polymer coating used to extend equipment life, is applied to all hot-dip galvanized steel components of the unit. Optional Stainless Steel Construction: Steel panels and structural elements are constructed of stainless steel either type 304 or 316.
Note: Refer to section Technical Resources, Material Options for more details on the materials described above.
TXV - B 36
TXV
For extremely sound sensitive installations, factory designed, tested and rated sound attenuation is available for both the air inlet and discharge.
Baltimore Aircoil
TXV - B 37
Accessories
External Service Platform with Ladder, Safety Cage and Handrails
In the event the owner requires easy access to the top of the unit, the unit can be furnished with a platform and ladders extending from the base of the unit to the platform, as well as safety cages, and handrail packages.
Note: Top air inlet screens are recommended with this option.
Internal Ladder
For access to the motor and drive assemblies internal ladders are available on models TXV-292 up to TXV-500 and TXV-310 up to TXV-425.
External Service Platform, Ladder and Safety Cage
TXV - B 38
Basin Heaters
Units exposed to below freezing ambient temperatures require protection to prevent freezing of the water in the cold water basin when the unit is idle. Factory-installed heaters, which maintain the water temperature at 4C, are a simple and inexpensive way of providing such protection. The heater package includes the heaters, a thermostat and a low level cut out switch to protect the heaters if the water level is too low. Standard electric heaters are selected for -18C ambient temperature.
Model No. TXV TXV 109 - 154 TXV 177 - 193 TXV 217 - 237 TXV 292 - 333 TXV 354 - 500 TXV 310 - 425 Heater -18C (kW) 1x6 1x6 1x8 1x8 2x6 2x6
TXV
Baltimore Aircoil
TXV - B 39
Engineering Data
REMARK: Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
1. Water in; 2. Water out; 3. Make Up; 4. Overflow ND80; 5. Drain ND50; 6.Access Door.
Model No. TXV TXV 109 TXV 123 TXV 135 TXV 154 TXV 177 TXV 193 TXV 217 TXV 237
Operating Weight (kg) 3040 3060 3070 3090 3780 3790 4600 4610
Shipping Weight (kg) 1640 1660 1670 1690 1910 1920 2290 2300
Heaviest Section (kg) 1640 1660 1670 1690 1910 1920 2290 2300
Air Flow (m/s) 16,4 18,8 20,8 23,8 27,1 29,8 30,8 33,9
Fan Motor (kW) (1) 4,0 (1) 5,5 (1) 7,5 (1) 11 (2) 5,5 (2) 7,5 (2) 5,5 (2) 7,5
Fluid Inlet ND (mm) 150 150 150 150 150 150 200 200
Fluid Outlet ND (mm) 200 200 200 200 200 200 200 200
Make Up ND (mm) 25 25 25 25 25 25 40 40
TXV - B 40
TXV
1. Water in; 2. Water out; 3. Make Up; 4. Overflow ND80; 5. Drain ND50; 6.Access door.
Operating Weight (kg) 6090 6110 6130 8560 8570 8610 8710
Model TXV TXV 292 TXV 314 TXV 333 TXV 354 TXV 402 TXV 441 TXV 500
Shipping Weight (kg) 3100 3120 3140 4040 4050 4080 4180
Heaviest Section (kg) 1720 1740 1760 2260 2270 2300 2400
Air Flow (m/s) 39,1 42,1 45,6 46,6 53,4 58,8 67,7
Fan Motor (kW) (2) 7,5 (2) 11 (2) 11 (3) 4,0 (3) 5,5 (3) 7,5 (3) 11
Fluid Inlet ND (mm) 250 250 250 250 250 250 250
Fluid Outlet ND (mm) 250 250 250 250 250 250 250
Make Up ND (mm) 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
1. Water in; 2. Water out; 3. Make Up; 4. Overflow ND80; 5. Drain ND50; 6.Access Door.
Baltimore Aircoil
TXV - B 41
Model No. TXV TXV 310 TXV 340 TXV 365 TXV 385 TXV 425
Fan Motor (kW) (2) 5,5 (2) 7,5 (2) 11 (2) 11 (2) 15
Make Up ND (mm) 40 40 40 40 40
General Notes
1. All connections 100 mm and smaller are MPT. Connections 125 mm and larger are bevelled-for-welding. 2. Make-up, overflow, suction, and drain connections can be provided on end opposite to that shown; consult your BAC Balticare representative.
3. Models TXV 292 up to 333, TXV 354 up to 500 and TXV 310 up to 425 are shipped in two sections per cell. The top section is the heaviest and has a height of 2130 mm.
Sound Attenuation
Model No TXV TXV 109- 154 TXV 177 - 193 TXV 217 - 237 TXV 292 - 333 TXV 354 - 500 TXV 310 - 425 D 1345 1345 1665 1665 1500 2005
Dimensions (mm) Ht 3885 3885 3885 5120 5260 5525 Intake 190 250 250 400 600 450
Models TXV 292 up to 333, TXV 354 up to 500 and TXV 310 up to TXV 425: intake attenuators ship in two sections. Indicated weights are total weights of two sections. W = Unit Width, Refer to general Engineering Data.
TXV - B 42
Structural Support
REMARK: Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
The recommended support arrangement for units consists of parallel I-beams running the full length of the unit, spaced as shown in the following drawing. Besides providing adequate support, the steel also serves to raise the unit above any solid foundation to ensure access to the bottom of the unit. To support units in an alternate steel support arrangement, consult your BAC Balticare Representative.
TXV
Dimensions (mm) A 2325 2325 2925 3550 2925 B 2440 C 255 255 255 255 270
N of 16 mm Anchor Bolts 4 4 4 4 8
Notes:
1. The recommended support arrangement for the units consists of parallel I-beams extending the full length of the unit. Supports and anchor bolts are to be designed and furnished by others. 2. All supporting beams are to be flush and level at top and must be oriented relative to gage line as shown. 3. Recommended design loads for each unit support beam should be 70% of the total unit operating weight applied as a uniform load to each of the unit beams. Beams should be designed in accordance with standard structural practice. For the maximum allowable deflection of beams under the unit see table. 4. All mounting holes have a diameter of 22 mm at the locations shown. 5. If vibration isolators are used, a rail or channel must be provided between the unit (and optional attenuator) and the isolators to provide continuous unit support. Additionally the support beams must be designed to accommodate the overall length and mounting hole location of the isolators that may differ from those of the unit. Refer to vibration isolator drawings for these data.
Baltimore Aircoil
TXV - B 43
Engineering Specifications
1.0 Cooling Tower
1.1 General: Furnish and install _____ factory-assembled, induceddraft, axial fan, crossflow cooling tower(s) with single side air entry and vertical air discharge. Overall dimensions shall not exceed approximately _____ mm long x ______ mm wide x _____ mm high. The total connected fan kW shall not exceed _____ kW. The cooling tower(s) shall be Baltimore Aircoil Model ____________. 1.2 Thermal Capacity: The cooling tower(s) shall be warranted by the manufacturer to cool _____ l/s of water from ______ C to _____C at _____C entering wet-bulb temperature. 1.3 Corrosion Resistant Construction (standard): Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all steel panels and structural members shall be constructed of heavy-gauge Z600 metric hot-dip galvanised steel with all edges given a protective coating of zinc-rich compound and protected with the BALTIPLUS Corrosion Protection. (Alternate 1.3) Corrosion Resistant Construction (optional): Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all steel panels and structural members shall be protected with the BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System. The system shall consist of Z600 metric hot-dip galvanised steel prepared in a four-step (clean, pre-treat, rinse, dry) process with an electrostatically sprayed, thermosetting, hybrid polymer fuse-bonded to the substrate during a thermally activated curing stage and monitored by a 23-step quality assurance program. (Alternate 1.3) Type 304 or 316 Stainless Steel Construction: All steel panels and structural members, including the structural frame, hot and cold water basins, distribution covers and fan deck shall be constructed of Type 304 or 316 stainless steel and assembled with stainless steel nut and bolt fasteners. The fan cylinder shall be constructed of heavy-gauge Z600 metric hot-dip galvanised steel and protected with the BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System. 1.4 Quality Assurance: The cooling tower manufacturer shall have a Management System certified by an accredited registrar as complying with the requirements of ISO-9001:2000 to ensure consistent quality of products and services. 1.5 Warranty: The manufacturers standard equipment warranty shall be for a period of not less than one year from date of start-up or eighteen months from date of shipment, whichever occurs first.
TXV - B 44
6.0 Access
TXV
6.1. Plenum Access: Hinged access doors shall be provided on one or two sides of the tower for access into plenum section.
7.0 Sound
7.1 Sound Level: To maintain the quality of the local environment, the maximum sound pressure levels (dB) measured 15 m from the cooling tower operating at full fan speed shall not exceed the sound levels detailed below.
63
125
250
500
1000
2000
4000
8000
dB(A)
Baltimore Aircoil
FXT - B 45
FXT
Product Detail
FXT Open Cooling Towers ..................................................................... B46 Benefits ..................................................................................................... B48 Construction Details ................................................................................ B49 Custom Features and Options ................................................................ B50 Accessories ............................................................................................... B51 Engineering Data ..................................................................................... B52 Structural Support .................................................................................. B54 Engineering Specifications ..................................................................... B56
FXT - B 46
FXT
General Description
FXT Cooling Towers deliver independently verified, fully rated thermal performance over a wide range of flow and temperature requirements. Standard design features satisfy todays environmental concerns, minimize installation costs, maximize operating reliability, and simplify maintenance requirements.
Key Features
z
Low energy consumption Low installed cost Easy maintenance Long service life Crossflow design Forced draught configuration Single side horizontal air entry Horizontal air discharge Aluminium axial fans Gravity water distribution
Baltimore Aircoil
FXT - B 47
FXT - B 48
Benefits
Low Installed Cost
z
All single cell FXT Cooling Towers ship completely assembled, minimizing installation time and cost:
-
FXT
z z
Easy Maintenance
The interior of the unit is accessible through circular access doors for adjusting the float valve, cleaning the strainer or flushing the basin The fan motor is located on the exterior of the unit for easy maintenance and belt adjustment. On most models, a single threaded bolt and nut assembly further simplifies belt adjustment. Extended lubrication fittings are located on the exterior of the unit for bearing lubrication.
The Fan Motor is easily accessible at the base of the unit's exterior
Materials of Construction Various materials are available to meet the corrosion resistance, unit operating life, and budgetary requirements of any project (See section Technical Resources, Materials of Construction" for more details)
Evaporative cooling equipment minimizes the energy consumption of the entire system because it provides lower operating temperatures. The owner saves money while conserving natural resources and reducing environmental impact. The FXT provides the heat rejection required at the lowest possible energy input via:
-
High efficiency, low kW axial fans High efficiency BACross Wet Deck, which provides maximum air/water contact time at low air pressure drops Variable frequency drives
Baltimore Aircoil
FXT - B 49
Construction Details
z z
Impervious to rot, decay and biological attack Designed and manufactured by BAC
7. Inlet Screens
z z
Protection from moving parts Easily removed for access to fans, bearings, motor and drives
Low pump head gravity distribution basin Large orifice, non-clog nozzles Steel distribution covers
9. Strainer
z
10. Access Door 5. BACross Wet Deck Surface with Integral Drift Eliminators
z z
Plastic material
FXT - B 50
Standard Construction: Steel panels and structural elements are constructed of heavy-gauge hot-dip galvanized steel protected with the Baltiplus Corrosion Protection on the outside of the cooling towers. Optional BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System: The BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System, a hybrid polymer coating used to extend equipment life, is applied to all hot-dip galvanized steel components of the cooling tower.
FXT
Note: See section Technical Resources, Material Options for more details on the materials described above.
Baltimore Aircoil
FXT - B 51
Accessories
Basin Heaters
Units exposed to below freezing ambient temperatures require protection to prevent freezing of the water in the cold water basin when the unit is idle. Factory-installed heaters, which maintain the water temperature at 4C, are a simple and inexpensive way of providing such protection. The heater package includes the heaters, a thermostat and a low level cut out switch to protect the heaters if the water level is too low. Standard electric heaters are selected for -18C ambient temperature.
Model FXT 27 - FXT 68 FXT 74 - FXT 86 FXT 97 - FXT 133 FXT 160 - FXT 250 FXT 194 - FXT 266 FXT 320 - FXT 500 Heaters -18 C (kW) 1x3 1x4 2x3 2x4 4x3 4x4
FXT - B 52
Engineering Data
REMARK: Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
FXT
1. Drain; 2. Water Outlet; 3. Overflow; 4. Make-Up; 5. Water Inlet; 6. Access Door ; 7. Top of Distribution Box; 8. Metering Orifices; 9. Flow Divider; *External Screen section only on FXT 211, 250, 422, 500.
Baltimore Aircoil
FXT - B 53
Model FXT FXT 27 FXT 32 FXT 43 FXT 51 FXT 60 FXT 68 FXT 74 FXT 88 FXT 97 FXT 116 FXT 133 FXT 160 FXT 173 FXT 211 FXT 250 FXT 194 FXT 232 FXT 266 FXT 320 FXT 346 FXT 422 FXT 500
Operating Weight (kg) 945 950 1100 1110 1425 1430 1920 1925 2755 2765 2780 3640 3655 4275 4295 5505 5525 5565 7285 7320 8545 8590
Shipping Weight (kg) 425 430 455 465 555 560 780 785 1000 1010 1025 1310 1325 1620 1640 1995 2015 2055 2615 2650 3230 3275
Heaviest Section (kg) 425 430 455 465 555 560 780 785 1000 1010 1025 1310 1325 1620 1640 1000 1010 1030 1310 1325 1620 1640
Air Flow (m/s) 4,85 5,32 7,08 8,11 9,93 11,76 11,03 13,07 14,68 17,40 19,93 24,10 26,53 30,22 34,60 29,36 34,81 39,85 48,19 53,04 60,44 69,19
Fan Motor (kW) (1) 0,75 (1) 1,1 (1) 1,5 (1) 2,2 (1) 2,2 (1) 4,0 (1) 2,2 (1) 4,0 (1) 2,2 (1) 4,0 (1) 5,5 (1) 5,5 (1) 7,5 (1) 7,5 (1) 11 (2) 2,2 (2) 4,0 (2) 5,5 (2) 5,5 (2) 7,5 (2) 7,5 (2) 11
Fluid Inlet ND (mm) 100 100 150 150 150 150 200 200 200 200 200 200 200 200 200 (2) 200 (2) 200 (2) 200 (2) 200 (2) 200 (2) 200 (2) 200
Fluid Outlet ND (mm) 100 100 150 150 150 150 200 200 200 200 200 200 200 200 200 (2) 200 (2) 200 (2) 200 (2) 200 (2) 200 (2) 200 (2) 200
Make Up ND (mm) 15 15 15 15 15 15 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 50 50 50 50 50 50 50
H (mm) 1810 1810 2216 2216 2216 2216 2540 2540 2540 2540 2540 2540 2540 3356 3356 2540 2540 2540 2540 2540 3353 3353
L (mm) 1374 1374 1374 1374 1832 1832 1832 1832 2772 2772 2772 3660 3660 3660 3660 5556 5556 5556 7334 7334 7334 7334
W (mm) 2181 2181 2181 2181 2181 2181 2219 2219 2219 2219 2219 2219 2219 2219 2219 2219 2219 2219 2219 2219 2219 2219
General Notes
1. Unless otherwise indicated, all connections ND 100 and smaller are MPT and connections ND 125 and larger are beveled for welding. 2. Operating weight is for tower with water level in the cold water basin at overflow. 3. Unit height is indicate, for precise value refer to the certified print. 4. Inlet piping must rest on the flow divider. The inlet piping to the distribution box must be the correct size as indicated in the table.
FXT - B 54
Structural Support
REMARK: Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
The recommended support arrangement for units consists of parallel I-beams running the full length of the unit, spaced as shown in the following drawing. Besides providing adequate support, the steel also serves to raise the unit above any solid foundation to ensure access to the bottom of the unit. To support units in an alternate steel support arrangement, consult your BAC Balticare Representative.
FXT
1. Supporting steelwork and anchor bolts are to be selected and installed by others. 2. All supporting steel must be flush and level at the top and must be oriented to the gage line as shown in SECTION A-A. 3. Recommended design loads for each beam should be 65% of the total operating weight applied as a uniform load to each beam. Beam should be designed in accordance with standard design practice. Refer to the below table for the maximum allowable deflection of beams
4. All mounting holes are 16 mm diameter at the locations shown. 5. If continuous vibration isolator rails are used, be certain to allow for the length of the rails when determining length of supporting steel. Vibration isolator rails are sometimes longer than the cooling tower dimensions shown. Refer to vibration isolator drawings for this information. If point vibration isolation is used, the isolators should be installed at the mounting hole locations shown.
Single Cell
Recommended Support
Alternate Support
1. Holes; 2. Outline of Tower; 3. Support Beams (by others); 4. Air Inlet Side.
Baltimore Aircoil
FXT - B 55
Double Cell
1. Holes; 2. Outline of Tower; 3. Support Beams (by others); 4. Air Inlet Side
Model FXT FXT 27 FXT 32 FXT 43 FXT 51 FXT 60 FXT 68 FXT 74 FXT 88 FXT 97 FXT 116 FXT 133 FXT 160 FXT 173 FXT 211 FXT 250 FXT 194 FXT 232 FXT 266 FXT 320 FXT 346 FXT 422 FXT 500
A (mm) 1549 1549 1549 1549 1549 1549 1549 1549 2181 2181 2181 2181 2181 2181 2181 2181 2181 2181 2181 2181 2181 2181
B (mm) 1067 1067 1067 1067 1524 1524 1524 1524 2438 2438 2438 3353 3353 3353 3353 2438 2438 2438 3353 3353 3353 3353
P1 (kg) 284 285 330 333 449 450 528 529 758 760 765 1001 1005 1154 1160 758 760 765 1001 1007 1154 1160
P2 (kg) 189 190 220 222 264 265 432 433 620 622 626 819 822 983 988 619 622 626 820 823 983 988
FXT - B 56
Engineering Specifications
1.0 Cooling Tower
1.1 General: Furnish and install _____ factory-assembled, forceddraft, axial fan, crossflow cooling tower(s). The tower(s) shall have air entry on one side only. The tower(s) shall have the fan and all moving parts located in the dry entering airstream provide greater reliability and long life. Overall dimensions shall not exceed approximately _____ mm long x ______ mm wide x _____ mm high. The total connected fan kW shall not exceed _____ kW. The cooling tower(s) shall be Baltimore Aircoil Model ____________. 1.2 Thermal Capacity: The cooling tower(s) shall be warranted by the manufacturer to cool _____ l/s of water from ______ C to _____C at _____C entering wet-bulb temperature. 1.3 Corrosion Resistant Construction (standard): Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all steel panels and structural members shall be constructed of heavy-gauge Z600 metric hot-dip galvanized steel with all edges given a protective coating of zinc-rich compound and the exterior protected with the BALTIPLUS Corrosion Protection. (Alternate 1.3) Corrosion Resistant Construction (optional): Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all steel panels and structural members shall be protected with the BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System. The system shall consist of Z600 metric hot-dip galvanized steel prepared in a four-step (clean, pre-treat, rinse, dry) process with an electrostatically sprayed, thermosetting, hybrid polymer fuse-bonded to the substrate during a thermally activated curing stage and monitored by a 23-step quality assurance program. 1.4 Quality Assurance: The cooling tower manufacturer shall have a Management System certified by an accredited registrar as complying with the requirements of ISO-9001:2000 to ensure consistent quality of products and services. 1.5 Warranty: The manufacturers standard equipment warranty shall be for a period of not less than one year from date of startup or eighteen months from date of shipment, whichever occurs first.
FXT
5.0 Access
5.1 Basin Access: Circular access doors shall be provided for easy access to the make-up water assembly and suction strainer for routine maintenance.
6.0 Sound
6.1 Sound Level: To maintain the quality of the local environment, the maximum sound pressure levels (dB) measured 15 m from the cooling tower operating at full fan speed shall not exceed the sound levels detailed below.
63
125
250
500
1000
2000
4000
8000
dB(A)
Baltimore Aircoil
RCT - B 57
RCT
.
Product Detail
RCT Open Cooling Tower ...................................................................... B58 Benefits ..................................................................................................... B60 Construction Details ................................................................................ B64 Custom Features and Options ................................................................ B66 Accessories ............................................................................................... B67 Engineering Data ..................................................................................... B68 Structural Support .................................................................................. B72 Engineering Specifications ..................................................................... B75
RCT - B 58
RCT
General Discription
Commercial applications demand reliable, cost effective and energy efficient solutions. With an ever increasing focus on operational reliability and ease of maintenance. It is paramount that cooling equipment be also easy to inspect, clean & maintain. The RCT-2000 cooling tower responds to all these requirements thanks to built-in design features. Industrial applications face unique challenges in their processes with varying site conditions The RCT-2000 cooling tower provides solutions to these challenges by reducing the cost of plant design, construction, operation and on-going maintenance, whilst improving the standard of quality and construction, required by medium to heavy industry.
Key Features
z
Total Lower Installation Costs Low Noise Low Height Superior Pultruded Composite Construction Superior Maintenance and Cleaning Possibilities
Baltimore Aircoil
RCT - B 59
RCT - B 60
Benefits
Total Lower Installation Costs
RCT
Modular Design
Factory Assembled
Single or multiplexed configurations, common or segmented basins, partitioned or extended air inlets and increased capacity control steps, all are but a few examples of the flexible modular cooling tower design. The tower can be shipped directly from the factory as a fully assembled unit, as unit modules or knocked down, to suit diverse and often restricted on-site conditions. The low shipping weights and modular shipping options reduce transport and crane costs. Lifting lugs, provided as standard, offer secure fixing points for safe crane lifts. Lower installation costs are achieved due to flanged inlet-outlet connections, solvent welded drain connections and threaded make-up, overflow and quick-fill connections.
Low Noise
The use of high efficiency axial fans as standard, a smooth faced streamlined air entry fan cylinder and a minimum tip clearance, all translate into a low air inlet velocity which in turn ensures noise levels are minimised. Varying fan powers can also be achieved within a nominal tower size.
Baltimore Aircoil
RCT - B 61
Low Height
The tower has been designed as a low height counter-flow cooling tower able to accommodate height sensitive sites, reduce pump head and provide easy access to all of its components.
Low Height
Access to complete unit interior - The large access panel is fitted with easily removable knobs. Removing the access panel does not require any tools or dismantling of the tower structure, providing unequalled access to all of the internal cooling tower components for inspection, cleaning and maintenance.
Basin Accessible from all Sides - Removal of the louvers, requiring no tools, provides access to all sides of the smooth faced cold water basin for inspection, cleaning and maintenance.
RCT - B 62
Easy Access to Float Valve - Access to and adjustment of the float valve is simplified. The stainless steel suction strainer can easily be inspected, removed and cleaned inside.
RCT
Removable Fill
Removable Fill - The fill medium can easily be removed for cleaning thanks in part to the ample accessibility, gained by removal of the access panel, and to the easy to handle removable fill blocks. Removable Spray System - Cleaning and inspection of the spray system can be performed insitu or by removing the spray branch arms. No tools are required for the removal of the branch arms or the individual water distribution nozzles.
Removable Eliminators
Removable Eliminators - Removal of high efficiency drift eliminators can be accomplished easily without the removal of other internal components or by having to dismantle the tower structure. The eliminators rest on supports specifically designed to this purpose.
Baltimore Aircoil
RCT - B 63
Motor Outside Airstream - Units larger than model 2142 include an adjustable motor base plate for belt tensioning, extended lubrication lines with externally mounted grease nipples are provided, as standard to ease of scheduled maintenance. Smaller units are supplied as direct drive units.
Easy Access to Drives - Removal of the fan screen for access to belts and drives is not required. These drive components are easily accessible through the specially designed hinged belt guard for inspection adjustment or replacement purposes.
RCT - B 64
Construction Details
RCT
1. Fan
z z z z
Aluminium Axial Fans Small tip clearance tolerance Low air inlet velocity Minimum Noise
2. Drive Train
z z z z
Easy access to drives and belts for inspection and adjustment. Stainless steel shaft. Corrosion resistant cast aluminium sheaves Heavy-duty bearings
3. Motor
z z z
Models RCT-2118 and 2129 utilise direct drive motor. Larger units have the fan motor outside of the moist discharge air stream and use belt drives. Belts provide reliability and long service life with low maintenance requirements
Baltimore Aircoil
RCT - B 65
4. Drift Eliminators
z z z
UV resistant non-corrosive material, impervious to rot, decay and biological attack Three distinct changes in air direction to reduce drift loss significantly Assembled in easy to handle sections, which can be removed for access to the equipment interior
5. Access Door
z
The larger access door is easily removable to provide complete access to drift eliminators, spray system and fill Larger units are equipped with anchor points to secure door when removed
6. Fill
z z z
The fill is impervious to rot, decay and resistant to fungus or biological attacks It consists of high efficiency cross-fluted sheets, solvent welded into lightweight blocks Blocks are sized for easy handling and removal for cleaning.
Low pressure, stationery type nozzles Heavy duty PVC spray branches are grommeted to facilitate removal and cleaning
The cold water basin is made of fibreglass reinforced polyester (FRP) and extra reinforced in critical areas. Sloped basin sides with smooth internal finish for easy cleaning.
9. Strainer
z
Adjustable water make-up assembly, over flow and quick fill connections are supplied standard.
11. Connections
Flanged inlet- and outlet connections z Threaded make-up-, over flow- and quick fill connections
z
12. Louvers
z
Removal of the louvers provides access to all sides of the cold water basin for inspection, cleaning and maintenance.
13. Roofdeck
z z
Smooth faced air entry fan cylinders Close manufacturing tolerances allow small tip clearance providing an increased efficiency.
RCT - B 66
RCT
High efficiency fans with direct drive motors for models RCT-2118 and RCT-2129. Larger models are belt driven. All belt driven units have extended lubrication lines to the edge of the fan cylinder. The mechanical equipment support and fan guard are made of hot dip galvanised steel. Optional: Mechanical equipment support assembly in SST 304.
Factory Assembled
The RCT Tower is completely factory-assembled. Optional: The tower can be shipped in knocked-down version for assembly on site. This enables overseas transport in containers and significantly reduces transport cost.
Standard Heat Transfer Surface: The filmtype heat transfer surface supplied as standard with the cooling towers has been carefully selected for industrial applications. The 19 mm spacing between the surface sheets gives excellent air/water contact with low air pressure loss. The standard heat transfer surface provides high thermal efficiency and is sufficient to avoid clogging in most environments. Optional Film-Type Space 12 mm: For applications where the cooling tower water is clean, alternative models with 12 mm fill are available.
Telescopic fill supports (only for heavy duty 26 mm Fill Type)
Heavy Duty 26 mm Fill Type: Heavier contamination, which results in a heavy accumulation on the heat transfer surface, requires a higher structural strength than can be accomplished with film-type. For such situations, a heat transfer surface is available, constructed of heavy-duty wave formed FRP panels spaced 26 mm apart. With the unique integrated telescopic fill supports, the FRP fill panels can easily be removed for cleaning.
Baltimore Aircoil
RCT - B 67
Accessories
Two-Speed Fan Motor
An effective method of adding steps of capacity control and saving energy is the installation of twospeed fan motors in lieu of the standard single-speed motors. Two-speed motors are ideally suited for this purpose. At half fan speed the equipment capacity is still about 60% of design whereas the drawn fan power is only about 20% of the full speed motor power. In addition, at low speed, sound levels will generally reduce by about 9 dB(A).
Basin Heaters
Units exposed to below freezing ambient temperatures require protection to prevent freezing of the water in the cold water basin when the unit is idle. Factory-installed heaters, which maintain the water temperature at 4C, are a simple and inexpensive way of providing such protection. The heater package includes the heaters, a thermostat and a low level cut out switch to protect the heaters if the water level is too low. Standard electric heaters are selected for -18C ambient temperature.
Model No. RCT Single Fan Units RCT-2118 / RCT 2129 RCT-2142 / RCT-2156 RCT-2183 / RCT-2208 RCT-2238 / RCT2262 RCT-2299 / RCT-2320 RCT-2368 / RCT-2386 RCT-2418 / RCT-2441 1x5 1x6 1x6 2x4 2x5 2x6 2x6 Heater -18C (kW) Double Fan Units 2x5 2x6 2x6 4x4 4x5 N.A. N.A.
Equalising Connection
Whenever cooling towers are installed to operate in parallel, the water level in the basins should be equalised by means of an equalising connection. The equalising connection can be either a whole pattern cut out only or a connection to the basin.
RCT - B 68
Engineering Data
Single Fan Units - Square Box Sizes
RCT
1. Water Inlet; 2. Water Outlet; 3. Drain; 4. Overflow; 5. Make-Up; 6. Quick Fill; 7. Fan Motor.
Model
L 2284 2284 2589 2589 2894 2894 3198 3198 3499 3499
H 3252 3252 3326 3326 3413 3413 3646 3646 3810 3810
Shipping Operatin Fan Air Fan Weight g Weight Motor Flow (mm) (kg) (kg) (kW) (m/s) 1000 1000 1250 1250 1550 1550 1800 1800 2100 2100 2675 2675 3375 3375 4125 4125 4850 4850 5700 5700 5,5 7,5 5,5 7,5 7,5 11 11 15 15 18,5 15,4 17,3 18,5 20,4 23,9 27,2 31,2 34,2 39,0 41,8 1524 1524 1829 1829 2134 2134 2134 2134 2438 2438
Inlet ND (mm) 150 150 150 150 200 200 200 200 200 200
Outlet ND (mm) 150 150 150 150 200 200 200 200 250 250
Drain ND (mm) 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50
Overflow ND (mm) 50 50 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80
Makeup ND (mm) 20 20 20 20 20 20 40 40 40 40
Quick-fill ND (mm) 20 20 20 20 20 20 40 40 40 40
RCT-2118-1 2284 RCT-2129-1 2284 RCT-2142-1 2589 RCT-2156-1 2589 RCT-2183-1 2894 RCT-2208-1 2894 RCT-2238-1 3198 RCT-2262-1 3198 RCT-2299-1 3499 RCT-2320-1 3499
Remarks: 1. Access door is always opposite to inlet connection end. 2. Alternative inlet/outlet and tower configurations are available. 3. Nominal outlet connection size provided. 4. Actual outlet sized to match flow. 5. Models RCT-2118-1 and RCT-2129-1 have direct drive motors.
Baltimore Aircoil
RCT - B 69
1. Water Inlet; 2. Water Outlet; 3. Drain; 4. Overflow; 5. Make-Up; 6. Quick Fill; 7. Fan Motor.
Model
Shipping Operatin Fan Weight g Weight Motor (kg) (kg) (kW) 2700 2700 3000 3000 7300 7300 8500 8500 18,5 22 18,5 22
Drain ND (mm) 50 50 50 50
Overflow ND (mm) 80 80 80 80
Makeup ND (mm) 40 40 40 40
Quick-fill ND (mm) 40 40 40 40
RCT-2368-1 3198 4787 RCT-2386-1 3198 4787 RCT-2418-1 3500 5247 RCT-2441-1 3500 5247
Remarks: 1. Access door is always opposite to inlet connection end. 2. Alternative inlet/outlet and tower configurations are available. 3. Nominal outlet connection size provided. 4. Actual outlet sized to match flow.
RCT - B 70
RCT
1. Water Inlet; 2. Water Outlet; 3. Drain; 4. Overflow; 5. Make-Up; 6. Quick Fill; 7. Fan Motor.
Model
H 3385 3385 3479 3479 3585 3585 3836 3836 4019 4019
Shipping Operatin Weight g Weight (kg) (kg) 2 x 5,5 2 x 7,5 2 x 5,5 2 x 7,5 2 x 7,5 2 x 11 2 x 11 2 x 15 2 x 15 2 x 18,5 30,8 34,6 37,1 40,8 47,8 54,4 62,4 68,4 78,1 83,5
Fan (mm)
Inlet ND (mm)
Outlet ND (mm) 200 200 250 250 250 250 250 250 250 250
Drain ND (mm) 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50
Overflow ND (mm) 50 50 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80
Makeup ND (mm) 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
Quick-fill ND (mm) 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40
RCT-2118-2 4551 2284 RCT-2129-2 4551 2284 RCT-2142-2 5160 2589 RCT-2156-2 5160 2589 RCT-2183-2 5770 5894 RCT-2208-2 5770 2894 RCT-2238-2 6379 3198 RCT-2262-2 6379 3198 RCT-2299-2 6985 3499 RCT-2320-2 6985 3499
30,8 2 x 1524 2 x 150 34,6 2 x 1524 2 x 150 37,1 2 x 1829 2 x 150 40,8 2 x 1829 2 x 150 47,8 2 x 2134 2 x 200 54,4 2 x 2134 2 x 200 62,4 2 x 2134 2 x 200 68,4 2 x 2134 2 x 200 78,1 2 x 2438 2 x 200 83,5 2 x 2438 2 x 200
Remarks: 1. Access door is always opposite to inlet connection end. 2. Alternative inlet/outlet and tower configurations are available. 3. Nominal outlet connection size provided. 4. Actual outlet sized to match flow. 5. Models RCT-2118-2 and RCT-2129-2 have direct drive motors.
Baltimore Aircoil
RCT - B 71
Model RCT-2118-3 RCT-2129-3 RCT-2142-3 RCT-2156-3 RCT-2183-3 RCT-2208-3 RCT-2238-3 RCT-2262-3 RCT-2299-3 RCT-2320-3
W 6817 6817 7732 7732 8646 8646 9560 9560 10471 10471
L 2284 2284 2589 2589 2894 2894 3198 3198 3499 3499
H 3452 3452 3555 3555 3671 3671 3931 3931 4124 4124
Shipping Weight (kg) 3000 3000 3750 3750 4650 4650 5400 5400 6300 6300
Operating Weight (kg) 8025 8025 10125 10125 12375 12375 14550 14550 17100 17100
Air Flow (m/s) 46,2 52 55,6 61,2 71,6 81,6 93,6 102,6 117,1 125,3
Fan (mm) 3 x 1524 3 x 1524 3 x 1829 3 x 1829 3 x 2134 3 x 2134 3 x 2134 3 x 2134 3 x 2438 3 x 2438
Inlet ND (mm) 3 x 150 3 x 150 3 x 150 3 x 150 3 x 200 3 x 200 3 x 200 3 x 200 3 x 200 3 x 200
Remarks: 1. Access door is always opposite to inlet connection end. 2. Alternative water inlet and tower configurations are available. 3. Triple fan units are not available with common FRP Basin. Only for installation on concrete basin.
RCT - B 72
Structural Support
The recommended support arrangement for units consists of parallel I-beams running the full length of the unit, spaced as shown in the following drawing. Besides providing adequate support, the steel also serves to raise the unit above any solid foundation to ensure access to the bottom of the unit. To support units in an alternate steel support arrangement, consult your BAC Balticare Representative.
RCT
1. Outline of Unit; 2. Mounting holes; 3. FRP Cold Water Basin; 4. Water Inlet Side.
1. Outline of Unit; 2. Mounting holes; 3. FRP Cold Water Basin; 4. Water Inlet Side.
Baltimore Aircoil
RCT - B 73
MINIMUM SUPPORT REQUIREMENTS RCT-2000 Nominal Box Size A 7 x 7 8 x 8 9 x 9 10 x 10 11 x 11 10 x 15 11 x 16,5 2260 2560 2865 3170 3475 3170 3475 B C 1130 1280 1435 1585 1740 1585 1740 1485 1640 1695 1850 D E F N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A 1185 1290 1085 1140 1295 1400 DIMENSIONS (mm) G H J 200 200 200 200 200 200 200 K 150 150 150 150 150 150 150 L 100 100 100 100 100 100 100 M 130 130 130 130 130 130 130 N 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 400 400 P Q N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A R PIER DESIGN LOADS (kg) S 410 510 620 730 T 540 680 830 970 U V W
210 N/A N/A 340 N/A N/A 420 N/A N/A 490 N/A N/A
860 1140 570 N/A N/A 730 980 490 N/A N/A
1. Outline of Unit; 2. Mounting holes; 3. FRP Cold Water Basin; 4. Water Inlet Side.
MINIMUM SUPPORT REQUIREMENTS RCT-2000 Nominal Box Size A 14 x 7 16 x 8 18 x 9 20 x 10 22 x 11 2260 2560 2865 3170 3475 B C D 1135 1285 1435 1590 1740 E F N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A 1130 1280 1435 1585 1740 DIMENSIONS (mm) G H J 200 200 200 200 200 K 150 150 150 150 150 L 100 100 100 100 100 M 130 130 130 130 130 N 70 70 70 70 70 P N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A Q 205 205 205 205 205 R 150 150 150 150 150 PIER DESIGN LOADS (kg) S 410 510 620 730 T 540 680 830 970 U 210 340 420 490 V W N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A
RCT - B 74
RCT
1. Outline of Unit; 2. Water Inlet Side.
MINIMUM SUPPORT REQUIREMENTS RCT-2000 Nominal Box Size A 21 x 7 24 x 8 27 x 9 30 x 10 33 x 11 2260 2560 2865 3170 3475 B C D 1135 1285 1435 1590 1740 E F N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A 1130 1280 1435 1585 1735 DIMENSIONS (mm) G H J 200 200 200 200 200 K 150 150 150 150 150 L 100 100 100 100 100 M 130 130 130 130 130 N 70 70 70 70 70 P N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A Q 205 205 205 205 205 R 150 150 150 150 150 PIER DESIGN LOADS (kg) S 410 510 620 730 T U V W N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A
REMARK: Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
Baltimore Aircoil
RCT - B 75
Engineering Specifications
1.0 Cooling Tower
1.1 General: Supply and install factory assembled cooling tower of counter-flow, induced draft, axial fan design. Each cooling tower shall be guaranteed by the manufacturer to cool ___ litres per second of water from ___ C (HW) entering water temperature to ___ C (CW) leaving water temperature at ___ C (WB) entering wet bulb temperature.
RCT - B 76
RCT
Baltimore Aircoil has developed a network of highly qualified sales representatives backed up by an experienced technical staff who will work hand-in-hand with you to ensure that each of your projects is a success. If you need help deciding which product to use, you can count on the support of your local BAC Balticare representative to develop solutions that meet your requirements. You can find BAC contact details on the web www.BaltimoreAircoil.com or You can send a request to info-bac@baltimoreaircoil.be
Baltimore Aircoil
IMT - B 77
IMT
Product Detail
IMT Open Cooling Towers ..................................................................... B78 Benefits ..................................................................................................... B80 Construction Details ................................................................................ B82 Custom Features and Options ................................................................ B83 Accessories ............................................................................................... B85 Engineering Data ..................................................................................... B86 Structural Support .................................................................................. B89 Engineering Specifications ..................................................................... B94
IMT - B 78
IMT
General Description
The features of modular design are incorporated in all IMT cooling towers to significantly reduce site assembly time and cost. IMT cooling towers are designed to meet the demanding conditions of a harsh industrial environment. Highly corrosion resistant materials are available to insure long life under these conditions. Structural strength is provided by heavy duty structural angles of stainless steel, hot dip galvanized steel or galvanized steel protected by the Baltibond Corrosion protection system. Standard cladding and fan stack materials are Fiberglass Reinforced Polyester (FRP)
Key Features
z
Sharply reduced Site assembly cost Superior durability through industrial quality materials Assured thermal performance Versatility in selection to suit every project requirement
Baltimore Aircoil
IMT - B 79
IMT - B 80
Benefits
Different Construction Material Options
To meat each customers technical and economic requirement, IMT cooling towers offer a broad choice of construction materials such as :
z
Fibreglass Reinforced Polyester cladding with a hot dip galvanised steel structure Z600 hot dip galvanised cladding and structure protected with the unique Baltibond Corrosion Protection System. Fibreglass Reinforced Polyester cladding with a stainless steel structure
IMT
Modular Design - The time consuming field assembly of individual parts is reduced to the rigging of large factory assembled sections and final assembly details. Your own construction people can receive the shipment, assemble the modules and component parts, and complete the cooling tower installation in a fraction of time required for conventional field erected cooling towers. Less construction time on site means less susceptibility to the variables of weather, labour productivity and workmanship. Field cutting, patching and drilling are virtually eliminated by use of standardized modular sections. The result is the consistent high quality, quickly assembled installation required by todays industrial cooling tower user.
Baltimore Aircoil
IMT - B 81
IMT - B 82
Construction Details
IMT
1. Wet Deck Surface
z Efficient plastic heat transfer surface suitable for most industrial
applications
7. Access Door
z Large sized access door in the fan plenum.
8. Fan Motor
z TEFC fan motor, IP 55 protected and Class F insulation designed for
cooling tower operation.
2. Steel Frame
z Heavy duty steel structural angles connected with corresponding hardware
3. FRP casing
z Fibreglass reinforced (FRP) fan stack
4. Axial Fan
z Heavy duty, extruded aluminium axial fan, with maximum fan efficiency z Safe fan selection distant from critical fan speed or resonant frequencys
5. Drift Eliminators
z UV resistant non-corrosive material, impervious to rot, decay and biological
attack
z Three distinct changes in air direction to reduce drift loss significantly z Assembled in easy to handle sections, which can be removed for access to
the equipment interior
z Specially designed belt with corrosion resistant fan sheave. z Heavy duty grease lubricated ball bearings with moisture seals and integral
slinger rings
Baltimore Aircoil
IMT - B 83
Standard Construction: Structural elements are constructed of Z600 heavy-gauge galvanized steel, hot-dip galvanized after fabrication. Optional BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System: The BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System, a hybrid polymer coating used to extend equipment life, is applied to all hot-dip galvanized steel components of the unit. Optional Stainless Steel Construction: Structural elements are constructed of stainless steel either type 304 or 316.
Note: Refer to section Technical Resources, Material Options for more details on the materials described above.
Standard Unit Hot-Dip Galvanized Structure Cold Water Sump* Cladding Fan Cowl Frame and Support Columns Louvers Not Available Fiberglass Reinforced Polyester Fiberglass Reinforced Polyester Steel Hot-Dip Galvanized after Fabrication Fiberglass Reinforced Polyester
Optional Stainless Steel Structure Not Available Fiberglass Reinforced Polyester Fiberglass Reinforced Polyester 304 or 316 Stainless Steel Fiberglass Reinforced Polyester
Optional Baltibond Corrosion Protection System (BBCPS) Z 600 Galvanized Steel with BBCPS Z 600 Galvanized Steel with BBCPS Fiberglass Reinforced Polyester Z 600 Galvanized Steel with BBCPS Fiberglass Reinforced Polyester
IMT - B 84
Wetdeck Surface
z
IMT
Standard Heat Transfer Surface: The filmtype heat transfer surface supplied as standard with the cooling towers has been carefully selected for industrial applications. The 19 mm spacing between the surface sheets gives excellent air/water contact with low air pressure loss. The standard heat transfer surface provides high thermal efficiency and is sufficient to avoid clogging in most environments. Optional Film-Type Space 12 mm: For applications where the cooling tower water is clean, alternative models with 12 mm fill are available.
Telescopic fill supports (only for heavy duty 26 mm Fill Type)
Heavy Duty 26 mm Fill Type: Heavier contamination, which results in a heavy accumulation on the heat transfer surface, requires a higher structural strength than can be accomplished with film-type. For such situations, a heat transfer surface is available, constructed of heavy-duty wave formed FRP panels spaced 26 mm apart. With the unique integrated telescopic fill supports, the FRP fill panels can easily be removed for cleaning.
Baltimore Aircoil
IMT - B 85
Accessories
Electric Water Level Control Package
The electric water level control to allow replaces the standard mechanical make-up valve when a more precise water level control is required. This package consists of a float switch mounted in the basin and a solenoid activated valve in the make-up water line. The valve is slow closing to minimize water hammer. (Only for models IMT 500 up to IMT 990 with factory supplied basin.)
Basin Heaters
Units exposed to below freezing ambient temperatures require protection to prevent freezing of the water in the cold water basin when the unit is idle. Factory-installed heaters, which maintain the water temperature at 4C, are a simple and inexpensive way of providing such protection. The heater package includes the heaters, a thermostat and a low level cut out switch to protect the heaters if the water level is too low. Standard electric heaters are selected for -18C ambient temperature. (Only for models IMT 500 up to IMT 990 with factory supplied basin).
Model No. IMT IMT 500-630 IMT 650-760 IMT 795-990 Heaters -18C (kW) 2x8 4x5 4x6
Two-Step Thermostat
Single stage thermostats or two stage thermostats can be used for fan motor speed control.
Maintenance Switch
Safety switches or local isolators allow the electrical supply to motors to be disconnected for safety purposes during inspection or maintenance.
IMT - B 86
Engineering Data
REMARK: Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
IMT
1. Water Inlet; 2. Access Door; 3. Motor System (Gear Drive Option); 4. Concrete Basin (by Others).
Model No. IMT IMT 500-1B O IMT 500-1B P IMT 630-1B P IMT 630-1B Q IMT 650-1B Q IMT 650-1B R IMT 760-1B R IMT 795-1B Q IMT 795-1B R IMT 990-1B R IMT 990-1B S IMT 925-1B S IMT 1195-1B S IMT 1195-1B T
Operating Weight (kg) 6430 6430 7120 7120 7980 7980 9020 9840 9840 10950 10950 11820 13410 13410
Shipping. Weight (kg) 4690 4690 5000 5000 5550 5550 6140 6850 6850 7390 7390 7820 8730 8730
Heaviest Section (kg) 1460 1460 1620 1620 1820 1820 2120 2050 2050 2320 2320 2440 2890 2892
Water In Width W (mm) 4800 4800 4800 4800 4800 4800 4800 6000 6000 6000 6000 6000 6000 6000
Length L(mm) 4880 4880 4880 4880 6080 6080 6080 6080 6080 6080 6080 7280 7280 7280
Height H(mm) 5140 5140 5450 5450 5450 5450 5760 5450 5450 5760 5760 5750 6060 6060
Airflow m/s 64,4 70,6 66,1 70,8 86,1 91,3 85.7 105,0 111,0 104,0 112,0 133.0 125,0 137,0
Water In ND (mm) (2x) 200 (2x) 200 (2x) 200 (2x) 200 (2x) 250 (2x) 250 (2x) 250 (2x) 250 (2x) 250 (2x) 250 (2) 250 (2x) 300 (2x) 300 (2x) 300
Baltimore Aircoil
IMT - B 87
1. Water Inlet; 2. Access Door; 3. Fan Motor System (Gear Drive Option); 4. Concrete Basin (by others).
Model No. IMT IMT 1155-1B T IMT 1360-1B T IMT 1550-1B T IMT 1550-1B U IMT 1695-1B T IMT 1695-1B U IMT 1780-1B U IMT 1780-1B V IMT 1945-1B U IMT 1945-1B V
Operating Weight (kg) 13890 15430 20900 20900 21400 21400 23400 23400 24000 2400
Shipping Weight (kg) 9280 10020 13600 13600 14100 14100 15800 15800 16400 16400
Heaviest Section (kg) 2030 2280 3300 3300 3300 3300 4200 4200 4200 4200
Water in Width W (mm) 7200 7200 7200 7200 7200 7200 8400 8400 8400 8400
Length L (mm) 7280 7280 8480 8480 8480 8480 8480 8480 8480 8480
Height H (mm) 5450 5760 6070 6070 6070 6070 6120 6120 6120 6120
Airflow (m/s) 165 155 170 182 192 203 228 242 220 234
Water Inlet ND (mm) (3x) 250 (3x) 250 (3x) 300 (3x) 300 (3x) 300 (3x) 300 (3x) 300 (3x) 300 (3x) 300 (3x) 300
IMT - B 88
IMT
1. Water Inlet; 2. Access Door; 3. Fan Motor System (Gear Drive Option); 4. Concrete Basin (by others).
Model No. IMT IMT 1990-1B V IMT 1990-1B W IMT 2260-1B V IMT 2260-1B W IMT 2320-1B V IMT 2320-1B W IMT 2530-1B V IMT 2530-1B W
Operating Weight (kg) 27600 27600 28300 28300 31200 31200 32000 32000
Shipping Weight (kg) 17900 17900 18600 18600 20000 20000 20800 20800
Heaviest Section (kg) 3300 3300 3300 3300 3700 3700 2700 2700
Water In Width W (mm) 9600 9600 9600 9600 9600 9600 9600 9600
Length L (mm) 8480 8480 8480 9480 9680 9680 9680 9680
Height H (mm) 6120 6120 6120 6120 6580 6580 6580 6580
Airflow (m/s) 270 272 262 271 297 315 287 305
Motor (kW) 110 132 110 132 110 132 110 132
Water Inlet ND (mm) (4x) 300 (4x) 300 (4x) 300 (4x) 300 (4x) 300 (4x) 300 (4x) 300 (4x) 300
General Notes
1. Special models with alternative configurations, fan power options or heat transfer surface options are available. Contact your BAC Balticare Representative for information. IMT models 500 to 990 are also available with sump as an option. Contact your local BAC Balticare Representative for sump dimensions of these models. 2. Motors located inside the fan plenum for models IMT-500 to IMT650.
Baltimore Aircoil
IMT - B 89
Structural Support
REMARK: Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
IMT-500 - 1195
IMT - B 90
Model No. IMT IMT 500-1B O IMT 500-1B P IMT 630-1B P IMT 630-1B Q IMT 650-1B Q IMT 650-1B R IMT 760-1B R
Support Points (Concrete Sump) (12) x M 12 (12) x M 12 (12) x M 12 (12) x M 12 (12) x M 12 (12) x M 12 (12) x M 12 (12) x M 12
IMT
IMT 795-1B Q IMT 795-1B R IMT 990-1B R IMT 990-1B S IMT 925-1B S IMT 1195-1B S IMT 1195-1B T
Baltimore Aircoil
IMT - B 91
IMT - B 92
IMT
Model No. IMT IMT 1550-1B IMT 1550-1B IMT 1695-1B IMT 1695-1B IMT 1780-1B IMT 1780-1B IMT 1945-1B IMT 1945-1B
Baltimore Aircoil
IMT - B 93
Model No. IMT IMT 1990-1B IMT 1990-1B IMT 2260-1B IMT 2260-1B IMT 2320-1B IMT 2320-1B IMT 2530-1B IMT 2530-1B
Notes:
IMT Cooling Towers provided without the integral sump by BAC should be supported on concrete columns or sump walls as shown. Dimensions A en B show the minimum inside sump dimensions and the table above gives the total number of support points required in the sump. For exact support locations of double cell models refer to foundation drawing available from your BAC Balticare Representative.
IMT - B 94
Engineering Specifications
1.0 Cooling Tower
1.1 General: Furnish and install _____ factory-assembled, induceddraft, axial fan, counterflow cooling tower(s) with vertical air discharge, conforming in all aspects to the specifications, schedules and as shown on the plans. Overall dimensions shall not exceed approximately _____ mm long x ______ mm wide x _____ mm high. The total connected fan kW shall not exceed _____ kW. The cooling tower(s) shall be Baltimore Aircoil Model ____________. (Alternate 1.3) Corrosion Resistant Construction (optional): Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all steel panels and structural members shall be protected with the BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System. The system shall consist of Z600 metric hot-dip galvanized steel prepared in a four-step (clean, pre-treat, rinse, dry) process with an electrostatically sprayed, thermosetting, hybrid polymer fuse-bonded to the substrate during a thermally activated curing stage and monitored by a 23-step quality assurance program. 1.4 Quality Assurance: The cooling tower manufacturer shall have a Management System certified by an accredited registrar as complying with the requirements of ISO-9001:2000 to ensure consistent quality of products and services. 1.5 Warranty: The manufacturers standard equipment warranty shall be for a period of not less than one year from date of startup or eighteen months from date of shipment, whichever occurs first.
IMT
1.2 Thermal Capacity: The cooling tower(s) shall be warranted by the manufacturer to cool _____ l/s of water from ______ C to _____C at _____C entering wet-bulb temperature. 1.3 Corrosion Resistant Construction (standard): Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all structural members shall be constructed of heavy-gauge Z600 hot-dip galvanized steel with all edges given a protective coating of zinc-rich compound and hot dip galvanized after fabrication. Cladding will be of trapezium formed Fiberglass Reinforced Polyester (FRP) panels.
Baltimore Aircoil
IMT - B 95
6.0 Access
6.1. Access : Access doors for inspection of the internal components of the tower shall be installed on the plenum above the drift eliminators.
7.0 Sound
7.1 Sound Level: To maintain the quality of the local environment, the maximum sound pressure levels (dB) measured 15 m from the cooling tower operating at full fan speed shall not exceed the sound levels detailed below.
63
125
250
500
1000
2000
4000
8000
DB(A)
IMT - B 96
IMT
Baltimore Aircoil has developed a network of highly qualified sales representatives backed up by an experienced technical staff who will work hand-in-hand with you to ensure that each of your projects is a success. If you need help deciding which product to use, you can count on the support of your local BAC Balticare representative to develop solutions that meet your requirements. You can find BAC contact details on the web www.BaltimoreAircoil.com or You can send a request to info-bac@baltimoreaircoil.be
Baltimore Aircoil
VTL - B 97
VTL
.
Product Detail
VTL Open Cooling Towers ..................................................................... B98 Benefits ................................................................................................... B100 Construction Details .............................................................................. B102 Custom Features and Options .............................................................. B103 Accessories ............................................................................................. B105 Engineering Data ................................................................................... B107 Structural Support ................................................................................. B111 Engineering Specifications .................................................................... B112
VTL - B 98
VTL
General Description
Open Circuit Cooling Towers with centrifugal fans, deliver fully rated thermal performance over a wide range of flow and temperature requirements. This type of cooling towers can be installed indoors and can accommodate limited ceiling or enclosure heights. Cooling tower with centrifugal fans minimise sound levels and installation costs, provides year round operating reliability, and simplifies maintenance requirements. Cooling Towers provide an answer to the growing need to save water and energy and help protect the environment by providing the highest system efficiency.
Key Features
z
Suitable for indoor and outdoor installations Suitable for high temperature applications Low sound Single side air inlet Low energy consumption Low installed cost Easy maintenance Reliable year-round operation Long service life Suitable for locations with limited ceiling or enclosure heights and roof top installations
Baltimore Aircoil
VTL - B 99
VTL - B 100
Benefits
Installation and Application Flexibility
z
Indoor Installations Centrifugal fans can overcome the static pressure imposed by external ductwork, allowing this type of cooling towers to be installed indoors. High Temperature Applications A range of wet deck and construction options are available to accommodate entering water temperatures of up to 65C. Low Profile Models Motors and drive of low profile units are adjacent to the casing section to yield models suitable for use in height sensitive installations.
VTL
Low Sound
z
Centrifugal Fan - Centrifugal fans have inherently low sound characteristics. Single Side Air Inlet - Particularly sound-sensitive areas can be accommodated by facing the quiet side (back panel) to the sound-sensitive direction.
Evaporative Cooling Equipment minimizes the energy consumption of the entire system because it provides lower operating temperatures. The owner saves money while conserving natural resources and reducing environmental impact.
Support All models mount directly on two parallel I-beams (supplied by others) and ship complete with motors and drives factoryinstalled and aligned. Modular Design All models without intake or discharge accessories ship in one piece to minimize field installation time and lifting time.
Easy Maintenance
z
Internal Access - The interior of the unit is easily accessible for adjusting the float valve, cleaning the strainer or flushing the basin.
Modular Design
V-Belt Drive The fans, motor, and drive system are located outside of the moist discharge airstream, protecting them from moisture, condensation and icing hence allowing a safe yearround operation.
Baltimore Aircoil
VTL - B 101
The water level control is easily reached from the access door
Materials of Construction Various materials are available to meet the corrosion resistance, unit operating life, and budgetary requirements of any project (See section "Technical Resources, Materials of Construction" for more details)
VTL - B 102
Construction Details
.
VTL
1. Heavy-Duty Construction
z
z z z
Impervious to rot, decay and biological attack Self extinguishing High temperature wet deck option
V-belt drive
6. Strainer
Heavy-duty bearings and fan motor
z
7. Access Door
z
Quiet Operation
8. Drift Eliminators
z
Plastic spray header and branches Large orifice, non-clog nozzles Grommetted for easy maintenance
UV resistant non-corrosive material, impervious to rot, decay and biological attack Three distinct changes in air direction to reduce drift loss significantly Assembled in easy to handle sections, which can be removed for access to the equipment interior
Plastic material
Baltimore Aircoil
VTL - B 103
Standard Construction: Steel panels and structural elements are constructed of Z600 heavy-gauge hot-dip galvanized steel protected with the Baltiplus Corrosion Protection on the outside of the unit. Optional BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System: The BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System, a hybrid polymer coating used to extend equipment life, is applied before assembly to all hot-dip galvanized steel components of the unit. Optional Stainless Steel Construction: Steel panels and structural elements are constructed of stainless steel either type 304 or 316. Optional Water-Contact Stainless Steel Cold Water Basin: A cost-effective alternative to an all stainless steel unit. The critical components in the cold water basin and the cold water basin itself are provided in stainless steel. The remaining components are protected with the BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System.
Note: See section Technical Resources, Material Options for more details on the materials described above.
VTL - B 104
VTL
Baltimore Aircoil
VTL - B 105
Accessories
Basin Heaters
Units exposed to below freezing ambient temperatures require protection to prevent freezing of the water in the cold water basin when the unit is idle. Factory-installed heaters, which maintain the water temperature at 4C, are a simple and inexpensive way of providing such protection. The heater package includes the heaters, a thermostat and a low level cut out switch to protect the heaters if the water level is too low. Standard electric heaters are selected for -18C ambient temperature.
Model No. VTL VTL 039-072 VTL 076 VTL 079 VTL 082 VTL 086-094 VTL 095 VTL 103-137 VTL 139-215 VTL 225 VTL 227 VTL 238-272 Heaters -18 C (kW) 1x3 1x4 1x3 1x4 1x5 1x4 1x5 2x4 2x5 2x4 2x5
VTL - B 106
VTL
Discharge Hoods
Discharge hoods reduce the risk of re-circulation in tight enclosures by increasing discharge air velocity, and can be used to elevate the unit discharge above adjacent walls to comply with layout guidelines.
Baltimore Aircoil
VTL - B 107
Engineering Data
REMARK: Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
1. Water Inlet; 2. Water Outlet; 3. Access Door; 4. Make up ND25; 5. Overflow ND50; 6. Drain ND50; 7. Fan Motor. Overflow connection is 80 mm on models VTL 086-L, VTL-094-M and VTL 103-K through VTL 137-M.
Model VTL VTL 039-G VTL 045-H VTL 052-H VTL 059-H VTL 059-J VTL 066-J VTL 072-K VTL 076-J VTL 079-K VTL 082-K VTL 086-L VTL 094-M VTL 095-K VTL 103-K VTL 116-L VTL 126-L VTL 126-M VTL 137-M
Operating Weight (kg) 1200 1230 1260 1290 1310 1320 1330 1720 1410 1740 2050 2060 1850 2150 2180 2320 2190 2330
Shipping Weight (kg) 720 750 780 810 830 840 850 1010 930 1030 1120 1130 1140 1220 1250 1390 1260 1400
Heaviest Section (kg) 720 750 780 810 830 840 850 1010 930 1030 1120 1130 1140 1220 1250 1390 1260 1400
Air Flow Fan Motor (m/s) (kW) 7,0 8,0 7,7 7,3 8,6 8,1 8,8 9,7 8,3 10,6 14,0 15,4 10,0 11,8 13,3 12,8 14,5 13,6 (1) 2,2 (1) 4,0 (1) 4,0 (1) 4,0 (1) 5,5 (1) 5,5 (1) 7,5 (1) 5,5 (1) 7,5 (1) 7,5 (1) 11,0 (1) 15,0 (1) 7,5 (1) 7,5 (1) 11,0 (1) 11,0 (1) 15,0 (1) 15,0
Fluid Inlet ND (mm) (1) 100 (1) 100 (1) 100 (1) 100 (1) 100 (1) 100 (1) 100 (1) 150 (1) 100 (1) 150 (1) 150 (1) 150 (1) 150 (1) 150 (1) 150 (1) 150 (1) 150 (1) 150
Fluid Outlet Make Up A H L1 L2 W ND (mm) ND (mm) (mm) (mm) (mm) (mm) (mm) (1) 100 (1) 100 (1) 100 (1) 100 (1) 100 (1) 100 (1) 100 (1) 150 (1) 100 (1) 150 (1) 150 (1) 150 (1) 150 (1) 150 (1) 150 (1) 150 (1) 150 (1) 150 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 75 75 75 75 75 75 75 105 75 105 105 105 105 105 105 105 105 105 1560 1560 1785 1990 1785 1990 1990 1990 2480 1990 1560 1560 2480 1990 1990 2480 1990 2480 3350 3350 3350 3350 3350 3350 3350 4560 3350 4560 5480 5480 4560 5480 5480 5480 5480 5480 1820 1820 1820 1820 1820 1820 1820 2730 1820 2730 3650 3650 2730 3650 3650 3650 3650 3650 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250
VTL - B 108
VTL
1. Water Inlet; 2. Water Outlet; 3. Access Door; 4. Make up ND 25; 5. Overflow ND 80; 6. Drain ND 50; 7. Fan Motor.
Operating Weight (kg) 3000 3010 3100 3170 3190 3200 3380 4000 3400 4110 4080 4310
Model VTL VTL 139-L VTL 152-M VTL 171-L VTL 185-M VTL 198-N VTL 209-O VTL 215-N VTL 225-O VTL 227-O VTL 238-N VTL 245-P VTL 272-P
Shipping Weight (kg) 1560 1570 1670 1740 1760 1770 1950 2080 1970 2210 2180 2410
Heaviest Section (kg) 1560 1570 1670 1740 1760 1770 1950 2080 1970 2210 2180 2410
Air Flow Fan Motor (m/s) (kW) 19,9 21,6 18,8 20,4 21,8 23,0 20,8 25,5 22,0 23,4 27,8 26,8 (1) 11,0 (1) 15,0 (1) 11,0 (1) 15,0 (1) 18,5 (1) 22,0 (1) 18,5 (1) 22,0 (1) 22,0 (1) 18,5 (1) 30,0 (1) 30,0
Fluid Inlet ND (mm) (1) 200 (1) 200 (1) 200 (1) 200 (1) 200 (1) 200 (1) 200 (1) 200 (1) 200 (1) 200 (1) 200 (1) 200
Fluid Outlet Make Up A H L1 L2 W ND (mm) ND (mm) (mm) (mm) (mm) (mm) (mm) (1) 200 (1) 200 (1) 200 (1) 200 (1) 200 (1) 200 (1) 200 (1) 200 (1) 200 (1) 200 (1) 200 (1) 200 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 130 130 130 130 130 130 130 130 130 130 130 130 1560 1560 1990 1990 1990 1990 2480 1990 2480 2480 1990 2480 4560 4560 4560 4560 4560 4560 4560 5480 4560 5480 5480 5480 2730 2730 2730 2730 2730 2730 2730 3650 2730 3650 3650 3650 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400
General Notes
1. All connections 150 mm and smaller are MPT. Connections 200 mm and larger are bevelled-for-welding. 2. Fan kW is at 0 Pa ESP. To operate against external static pressure up to 125 Pa, consult your local BAC Balticare Representative for size and location. 3. Make up, overflow, suction, drain connections and access door can be provided on side opposite to that shown; consult your BAC representative. 4. Unit height is indicative, for precise value refer to certified print. 5. Shipping/operating weights indicated are for units without accessories such as sound attenuators, discharge hoods, etc. Consult factory certified prints to obtain weight additions and the heaviest section to be lifted.
Baltimore Aircoil
VTL - B 109
Sound Attenuation
HS Horizontal Intake Sound Attenuation
1.Discharge attenuator, 2. Access Door, 3. Intake Attenuator; H & W: unit height and width (see engineering data).
1.Discharge attenuator, 2. Access Door, 3. Intake Attenuator; H & W: unit height and width (see engineering data).
VTL - B 110
VTL
1.Discharge attenuator, 2. Access Door, 3. Intake Attenuator, 4. Plenum; H & W: unit height and width (see engineering data).
Dimensions (mm) Model No VTL HS VTL039 G - 079 K VTL076 J - 095 K VTL086 L - 137 M VTL139 L - 227 O VTL225 O - 272 P 2390 2640 2640 2640 2640 L2 HD 3125 3375 3375 3375 3375 VS 2010 2010 2010 2010 2010 L1 HS,HD,VS 1820 2730 3650 2730 3650 Intake Attenuator HS 410 460 460 650 650 HD 685 730 730 1115 1115 VS 465 430 420 545 545
Weight (kg) Discharge Attenuator HS 205 290 360 460 560 HD 220 305 390 490 620 VS 225 310 395 485 600 HS 615 750 820 1110 1210 Total HD 905 1035 1120 1605 1735 VS 690 740 815 1030 1145
Note: All VL-units + HS or VS attenuators ship in 2 pieces. All VL-units + HD attenuators ship in 3 pieces.
Baltimore Aircoil
VTL - B 111
Structural Support
REMARK: Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
The recommended support arrangement for units consists of parallel I-beams running the full length of the unit, spaced as shown in the following drawing. Besides providing adequate support, the steel also serves to raise the unit above any solid foundation to ensure access to the bottom of the unit. To support units in an alternate steel support arrangement, consult your BAC Balticare Representative.
3334
1193
13
13 13 13
Notes:
1. The recommended support arrangement for VL units consists of two parallel I-beams extending the full length of the unit. Supports and anchor bolts are to be designed and furnished by others. 2. All supporting beams are to be flush and level at top and must be oriented relative to gage line as shown. 3. Recommended design loads for each unit support beam should be 70% of the total unit operating weight applied as a uniform load to each of the unit beams. Beams should be designed in accordance with standard structural practice. For the maximum allowable deflection of beams under the unit refer to above table. 4. All mounting holes have a diameter of 22 mm at the locations shown. 5. If vibration isolators are used, a rail or channel must be provided between the unit and the isolators to provide continuous unit support. Additionally the support beams must be designed to accommodate the overall length and mounting hole location of the isolators that may differ from those of the unit. Refer to vibration isolator drawings for these data.
VTL - B 112
Engineering Specifications
1.0 Cooling Tower
1.1 General: Furnish and install _____ factory-assembled, forceddraft, centrifugal fan, counter flow cooling tower(s) with vertical air discharge, conforming in all aspects to the specifications, schedules and as shown on the plans. Overall dimensions shall not exceed approximately _____ mm long x ______ mm wide x _____ mm high. The total connected fan power shall not exceed _____ kW. The cooling tower(s) shall be Baltimore Aircoil Model ____________. Corrosion Protection System. The system shall consist of Z600 metric hot-dip galvanized steel prepared in a four-step (clean, pre-treat, rinse, dry) process with an electrostatically sprayed, thermosetting, hybrid polymer fuse-bonded to the substrate during a thermally activated curing stage and monitored by a 23-step quality assurance program. (Alternate 1.3) Corrosion Resistant Construction (optional): Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all steel panels and structural members shall be constructed of Type 304 or 316 stainless steel and assembled with stainless steel nut and bolt fasteners. 1.4 Quality Assurance: The cooling tower manufacturer shall have a Management System certified by an accredited registrar as complying with the requirements of ISO-9001:2000 to ensure consistent quality of products and services. 1.5 Warranty: The manufacturers standard equipment warranty shall be for a period of not less than one year from date of startup or eighteen months from date of shipment, whichever occurs first.
VTL
1.2 Thermal Capacity: The cooling tower(s) shall be warranted by the manufacturer to cool _____ l/s of water from ______ C to _____C at _____C entering wet-bulb temperature. 1.3 Corrosion Resistant Construction (standard): Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all steel panels and structural members shall be constructed of heavy-gauge Z600 metric hot-dip galvanized steel with all edges given a protective coating of zinc-rich compound and the exterior protected with the BALTIPLUS Protection. (Alternate 1.3) Corrosion Resistant Construction (optional): Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all steel panels and structural members shall be protected with the BALTIBOND
Baltimore Aircoil
VTL - B 113
5.0 Access
5.1 Basin Access: Circular access doors shall be provided for easy access to the make-up water assembly and suction strainer for routine maintenance.
6.0 Sound
6.1 Sound Level: To maintain the quality of the local environment, the maximum sound pressure levels (dB) measured 15 m from the cooling tower operating at full fan speed shall not exceed the sound levels detailed below.
63
125
250
500
1000
2000
4000
8000
dB(A)
VTL - B 114
VTL
Baltimore Aircoil has developed a network of highly qualified sales representatives backed up by an experienced technical staff who will work hand-in-hand with you to ensure that each of your projects is a success. If you need help deciding which product to use, you can count on the support of your local BAC Balticare representative to develop solutions that meet your requirements. You can find BAC contact details on the web www.BaltimoreAircoil.com or You can send a request to info-bac@baltimoreaircoil.be
Baltimore Aircoil
VXT - B 115
VXT
Product Detail
VXT Open Cooling Tower ..................................................................... B116 Benefits .................................................................................................... B118 Construction Details .............................................................................. B120 Custom Features and Options .............................................................. B122 Accessories ............................................................................................. B124 Engineering Data ................................................................................... B126 Structural Support ................................................................................ B131 Engineering Specifications ................................................................... B134
VXT - B 116
VXT
General Description
Open Circuit Cooling Towers with centrifugal fans, deliver fully rated thermal performance over a wide range of flow and temperature requirements. This type of cooling towers can be installed indoors and can accommodate limited ceiling or enclosure heights. Cooling tower with centrifugal fans minimise sound levels and installation costs, provides year round operating reliability, and simplifies maintenance requirements. Cooling Towers provide an answer to the growing need to save water and energy and help protect the environment by providing the highest system efficiency.
Key Features
z
Suitable for indoor and outdoor installations Suitable for high temperature applications Low sound Single side air inlet Low energy consumption Low installed cost Easy maintenance Reliable year-round operation Long service life
Baltimore Aircoil
VXT - B 117
VXT - B 118
Benefits
Installation and Application Flexibility
z
Indoor Installations Centrifugal fans can overcome the static pressure imposed by external ductwork, allowing this type of cooling towers to be installed indoors. High Temperature Applications A range of wet deck and construction options are available to accommodate entering water temperatures of up to 65C.
VXT
Low Sound
z
Centrifugal Fan - Centrifugal fans have inherently low sound characteristics. Single Side Air Inlet - Particularly sound-sensitive areas can be accommodated by facing the quiet side (back panel) to the sound-sensitive direction.
Evaporative Cooling Equipment minimizes the energy consumption of the entire system because it provides lower operating temperatures. The owner saves money while conserving natural resources and reducing environmental impact.
Support All models mount directly on two parallel I-beams (supplied by others) and ship complete with motors and drives factory-installed and aligned. Modular Design Large models ship in multiple sections to minimize the size and weight of the heaviest lift, allowing for the use of smaller, less costly cranes.
Easy Maintenance
z
Internal Access - The interior of the unit is easily accessible for adjusting the float valve, cleaning the strainer or flushing the basin.
The water level control is easily reached from the access door.
V-Belt Drive The fans, motor, and drive system are located outside of the moist discharge airstream, protecting them from moisture, condensation and icing hence allowing a safe yearround operation.
Baltimore Aircoil
VXT - B 119
Materials of Construction Various materials are available to meet the corrosion resistance, unit operating life, and budgetary requirements of any project (See section "Technical Resources, Materials of Construction" for more details)
VXT - B 120
Construction Details
VXT
Upper Section
Lower Section
Baltimore Aircoil
VXT - B 121
3. Centrifugal Fan(s)
z
Quiet Operation
Plastic spray header and branches Large orifice, non-clog nozzles Grommetted for easy maintenance
Plastic material Impervious to rot, decay and biological attack Self extinguishing High temperature wet deck option
6. Strainer
z
7. Access Door
z
8. Drift Eliminators
z
UV resistant non-corrosive material, impervious to rot, decay and biological attack Three distinct changes in air direction to reduce drift loss significantly Assembled in easy to handle sections, which can be removed for access to the equipment interior
VXT - B 122
Standard Construction: Steel panels and structural elements are constructed of Z600 heavy-gauge hot-dip galvanized steel protected with the Baltiplus Corrosion Protection on the outside of the unit. Optional BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System: The BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System, a hybrid polymer coating used to extend equipment life, is applied before assembly to all hot-dip galvanized steel components of the unit.
VXT
Optional Stainless Steel Construction: Steel panels and structural elements are constructed of stainless steel either type 304 or 316. Optional Water-Contact Stainless Steel Cold Water Basin: A cost-effective alternative to an all stainless steel unit. The critical components in the cold water basin and the cold water basin itself are provided in stainless steel. The remaining components are protected with the BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System.
Note: See section Technical Resources, Material Options for more details on the materials described above.
Baltimore Aircoil
VXT - B 123
The use of an auxiliary sump within a heated space is the most satisfactory way to protect sump water from freezing. When the circulating pump is shut off, all the water in the water distribution, in suspension and in the sump will drain freely to the auxiliary sump.
Note: For detailed information on the calculation of the remote sump tank, please refer to the section "Technical Resources, Selection of Remote Sump Tank".
VXT - B 124
Accessories
Ladder, Safety Cage and Handrails
In the event the owner requires easy access to the top of the unit, the unit can be furnished with ladders extending from the base of the unit to the top, as well as safety cages, and handrail packages.
VXT
Note: When these access options are employed, the unit must be equipped with steel drift eliminators.
Basin Heaters
Units exposed to below freezing ambient temperatures require protection to prevent freezing of the water in the cold water basin when the unit is idle. Factory-installed heaters, which maintain the water temperature at 4C, are a simple and inexpensive way of providing such protection. The heater package includes the heaters, a thermostat and a low level cut out switch to protect the heaters if the water level is too low. Standard electric heaters are selected for -18C ambient temperature.
Model No. VXT VXT 10-25 VXT 30-55 VXT 65-85 VXT 95-135 VXT 150-185 VXT N215-N265 VXT N310-N395 VXT N430-N535 VXT 315-400 VXT 470-600 VXT 630-800 VXT 870-1200 Heater -18 C (kW) 1 x 1,5 1 x 1,5 1 x 2,5 1x3 1x4 1x6 2x4 2x6 1x6 2x5 2x6 4x5
Baltimore Aircoil
VXT - B 125
Discharge Hoods
Discharge hoods reduce the risk of re-circulation in tight enclosures by increasing discharge air velocity, and can be used to elevate the unit discharge above adjacent walls to comply with layout guidelines.
VXT - B 126
Engineering Data
REMARK: Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
VXT 10 - 185
VXT
1. Drain ND 50; 2. Water Outlet; 3. Overflow ND50; 4. Make Up; 5.Water Inlet; 6.Access Door. On models VXT-10 to VXT-135 sufficient space must be provided on the back of the unit for entry to access doors located on side opposite air entry side.
Model VXT VXT 010 VXT 015 VXT 020 VXT 025 Op. Weight Sh. Weight Heaviest Section (kg) (kg) (kg) 405 410 425 435 325 330 350 360 325 330 350 360
Fan Motor Fluid Inlet (kW) ND (mm) (1) 0,75 (1) 1,1 (1) 1,5 (1) 2,2 (1) 80 (1) 80 (1) 80 (1) 80
25 25 25 25
25 25 25 25
25 25 25 25
25 25 25
Baltimore Aircoil
VXT - B 127
1. Drain ND 50; 2. Water Outlet; 3. Overflow ND 80; 4. Make Up; 5.Water Inlet; 6.Access Door.
Sh. Op. Weight Weight (kg) (kg) 3640 3850 4080 2100 2310 2540
Air Flow Fan Motor (m/s) (kW) 23,49 23,33 24,26 (1) 22 (1) 22 (1) 30
Make Up ND (mm) 50 50 50
50 50 50 50
50 50 50 50
VXT - B 128
VXT
1. Drain ND50; 2. Water Outlet; 3. Overflow ND 80; 4. Make Up; 5.Water Inlet; 6.Access Door.
Sh. Op. Weight Weight (kg) (kg) 4905 5195 5505 5535 2960 3260 3560 3590
Model VXT
Make Up ND (mm)
H (mm)
L (mm)
W (mm)
50 50 50 50
50 50 50 50
50 50 50 50
VXT 870 VXT 945 VXT 1050 VXT 1125 VXT 1200
(3) 200 (3) 200 (3) 200 (3) 200 (3) 200
(2) 250 (2) 250 (2) 250 (2) 250 (2) 250
80 80 80 80 80
General Notes
1. All connections 100 mm and smaller are MPT. Connections 150 mm and larger are bevelled-for-welding. 2. Fan kW is at 0 Pa ESP. To operate against external static pressure up to 125 Pa, increase each fan motor one size. 3. Make up, overflow, suction, and drain connections can be provided on end opposite to that shown; consult your BAC representative.
Baltimore Aircoil
VXT - B 129
Sound Attenuation
XA + XB Sound Attenuation for VX-Line Cooling Towers
VXT - B 130
# Access doors (3) XA, XB, XC W2 Disch. Att. Int. Att. XA, XB XC 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 4 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2352 2352 2352 2352 2583 3542 3542 3542 4145 4145 4145 4145
Dimensions (mm) H1 W1 L1 L2 Intake + solid bottom XA 900 140 225 300 400 500 690 XB XC
Weights (kg) Discharge XA XB XC XA Total XB 310 490 720 890 XC N.A. N.A. N.A. N.A.
10 - 25 30 - 55 65 - 85
160 N.A. 130 270 N.A. 175 370 N.A. 280 470 N.A. 360 600 1200 440 820 1610 530
150 N.A. 270 220 N.A. 400 350 N.A. 580 420 N.A. 760
N.A. 1090 1030 1800 1815 N.A. 1090 1030 2710 2730 N.A. 1090 1030 3635 3645 3728 1600 1420 3635 3645 4687 2070 1955 3510 3645 4687 2070 1955 5365 5480
VXT
95 - 135 150 - 185 N215 N265 N310 N395 N430 - N535 315 - 400 470 - 600 630 - 800 870 - 1200
520 1070 940 1120 2270 650 1330 1220 1470 2940 970 1980 1720 2130 4250
4687 2070 1955 7185 7320 1380 1640 3220 1060 1300 2660 2440 2940 5880 5290 2560 2965 3510 3645 790 940 1850 710 880 1820 1500 1820 3670
5290 2560 2965 5365 5480 1080 1330 2590 900 1210 2490 1980 2540 5080 5290 2560 2965 7185 7320 1580 1880 3700 1420 1760 3640 3000 3640 7340 5290 2560 2965 10865 10995 2370 2820 5550 2130 2640 5460 4500 5460 11010
VXT-55 + attenuation is shipped in 4 pieces VXT-75 and VXT 85 + attenuation is shipped in 4 pieces VXT-95 + attenuation is shipped in 3 pieces Intake Attenuator: Acces opening is 775 mm high, 406 mm wide and is located at each end of the unit.
Discharge Attenuator : Access opening is 400 mm high, 1080 mm wide and is located at blank off side of the unit (VXT 10-25 has 650 mm width)
Baltimore Aircoil
VXT - B 131
Structural Support
REMARK: Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
The recommended support arrangement for units consists of parallel I-beams running the full length of the unit, spaced as shown in the following drawing. Besides providing adequate support, the steel also serves to raise the unit above any solid foundation to ensure access to the bottom of the unit. To support units in an alternate steel support arrangement, consult your BAC Balticare Representative.
Model
A Unit Length (mm) 914 1829 2737 3658 3645 3550 3550 5388 5388 7226 7226 10903
B Unit width (mm) 1207 1207 1207 1207 1438 2397 3000 2397 3000 2397 3000 3000
C Center dis. Length (mm) 750 1664 2572 3492 3492 3238 3238 5074 5074 6194 6194 10590
D Center dis. Width (mm) 1153 1153 1153 1153 1378 2327 2934 2327 2934 2327 2934 2934
E (mm)
F (mm)
G (mm)
H (mm)
Mounting Holes
VXT 10-25 VXT 30-55 VXT 65-84 VXT 95-135 VXT 150-185 VXT N215-N265 VXT 315-400 VXT N310-N395 VXT 470-600 VXT N430-N535 VXT 630-800 VXT 870-1200
3238
438
4 4 4 4 4 4 4 8 8 8 8 12
VXT - B 132
VXT
1. Outline of Unit; 2. Mounting Holes 22 mm; 3. Outline of attenuator (optional XA or XB); 4. Support Channel attached to optional XA or XB attenuator; 5. (3 + 5) Outline of Attenuator (optional XC); 6. (4 + 6) Support Channels attached to optional XC attenuator; 7. Unit; 8. Sound Attenuation (Type XA, XB or XC); 9. Air Intake.
Baltimore Aircoil
VXT - B 133
Model
A Unit Length (mm) 914 1829 2737 3658 3645 3550 3550 5388 5388 7226 7226 10903
B Unit width (mm) 1207 1207 1207 1207 1438 2397 3000 2397 3000 2397 3000 3000
C Center dis. Length (mm) 750 1664 2572 3492 3492 3238 3238 5074 5074 6194 6194 10590
D Center dis. Width (mm) 1153 1153 1153 1153 1378 2327 2934 2327 2934 2327 2934 2934
E (mm)
F (mm)
G (mm)
H (mm)
Mounting Holes
VXT 10-25 VXT 30-55 VXT 65-84 VXT 95-135 VXT 150-185 VXT N215-N265 VXT 315-400 VXT N310-N395 VXT 470-600 VXT N430-N535 VXT 630-800 VXT 870-1200
3238
438
4 4 4 4 4 4 4 8 8 8 8 12
Notes:
1. The recommended support arrangement for VX units consists of parallel I-beams extending the full length of the unit. Supports and anchor bolts are to be designed and furnished by others. 2. All supporting beams are to be flush and level at top and must be oriented relative to gage line as shown. 3. Recommended design loads for each unit support beam should be 70% of the total unit operating weight applied as a uniform load to each of the unit beams. The support beam(s) for the optional intake attenuator(s) needs to carry attenuator only, uniform load of 250 kg/m. Beams should be designed in accordance with standard structural practice. For the maximum allowable deflection of beams under the unit refer to above table. 4. All mounting holes have a diameter of 22 mm at the locations shown. 5. If vibration isolators are used, a rail or channel must be provided between the unit (and optional attenuator) and the isolators to provide continuous unit support. Additionally the support beams must be designed to accommodate the overall length and mounting hole location of the isolators that may differ from those of the unit. Refer to vibration isolator drawings for these data.
VXT - B 134
Engineering Specifications
1.0 Cooling Tower
1.1 General: Furnish and install _____ factory-assembled, forced-draft, centrifugal fan, counter flow cooling tower(s) with vertical air discharge, conforming in all aspects to the specifications, schedules and as shown on the plans. Overall dimensions shall not exceed approximately _____ mm long x ______ mm wide x _____ mm high. The total connected fan power shall not exceed _____ kW. The cooling tower(s) shall be Baltimore Aircoil Model ____________. 1.2 Thermal Capacity: The cooling tower(s) shall be warranted by the manufacturer to cool _____ l/s of water from ______ C to _____C at _____C entering wet-bulb temperature. 1.3 Corrosion Resistant Construction (standard): Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all steel panels and structural members shall be constructed of heavy-gauge Z600 metric hot-dip galvanized steel with all edges given a protective coating of zinc-rich compound and the exterior protected with the BALTIPLUS Protection. (Alternate 1.3) Corrosion Resistant Construction (optional): Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all steel panels and structural members shall be protected with the BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System. The system shall consist of Z600 metric hot-dip galvanized steel prepared in a four-step (clean, pre-treat, rinse, dry) process with an electrostatically sprayed, thermosetting, hybrid polymer fuse-bonded to the substrate during a thermally activated curing stage and monitored by a 23-step quality assurance program. (Alternate 1.3) Corrosion Resistant Construction (optional): Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all steel panels and structural members shall be constructed of Type 304 or 316 stainless steel and assembled with stainless steel nut and bolt fasteners. 1.4 Quality Assurance: The cooling tower manufacturer shall have a Management System certified by an accredited registrar as complying with the requirements of ISO-9001:2000 to ensure consistent quality of products and services. 1.5 Warranty: The manufacturers standard equipment warranty shall be for a period of not less than one year from date of startup or eighteen months from date of shipment, whichever occurs first.
VXT
5.0 Access
5.1 Basin Access: Circular access doors shall be provided for easy access to the make-up water assembly and suction strainer for routine maintenance.
6.0 Sound
6.1 Sound Level: To maintain the quality of the local environment, the maximum sound pressure levels (dB) measured 15 m from the cooling Location Discharge Air Inlet End Back 63 125 250 500 tower operating at full fan speed shall not exceed the sound levels detailed below. 1000 2000 4000 8000 dB(A)
Baltimore Aircoil
CCCT - C 1
CCCT - C 2
General Information
Closed circuit cooling towers provide evaporative cooling for many types of systems, and the specific application will largely determine which BAC Closed Circuit Cooling Tower is best suited for a project. The Product Line Overview Table is intended as a general guide. Specialized assistance is available through your local BAC Balticare Representative.
Principle of Operation
Overview
Closed circuit cooling towers operate in a manner similar to open cooling towers, except that the heat load to be rejected is transferred from the process fluid (the fluid being cooled) to the ambient air through a heat exchange coil. The coil serves to isolate the process fluid from the outside air, keeping it clean and contamination free in a closed loop. This creates two separate fluid circuits: (1) an external circuit, in which spray water circulates over the coil and mixes with the outside air, and (2) an internal circuit, in which the process fluid circulates inside the coil. During operation, heat is transferred from the internal circuit, through the coil to the spray water, and then to the atmosphere as a portion of the water evaporates.
Configuration
BAC manufactures two types of closed circuit cooling towers: combined flow and counterflow.
Combined Flow
Combined flow is the use of both a heat exchange coil and wet deck surface for heat transfer in a closed circuit cooling tower. The addition of wet deck surface to the traditional closed circuit cooling tower design reduces evaporation in the coil section, reducing the potential for scaling and fouling. BACs combined flow closed circuit cooling towers utilize parallel flow of air and spray water over the coil, and crossflow air/water flow through the wet deck surface. In parallel flow, air and water flow over the coil in the same direction. The process fluid travels from the bottom to the top of the coil, increasing efficiency by bringing the coldest spray water and air in contact with the process fluid at its coldest temperature.
Combined Flow: Parallel flow of air and water over the coil
Baltimore Aircoil
CCCT - C 3
Counterflow
In a counterflow closed circuit cooling tower design, the flow of the air is in the opposite direction of the spray water. In BACs counterflow closed circuit cooling towers, air travels vertically up through the unit while the spray water travels vertically down over the coil.
Fan System
The flow of air through most factory assembled Counterflow Configuration evaporative cooling equipment is provided by one or more mechanically driven fans. The fan(s) may be axial or centrifugal, each type having its own distinct advantages. Axial fan units require approximately half the fan motor kilowatt of comparably sized centrifugal fan units, offering significant life-cycle cost savings. Centrifugal fan units are capable of overcoming reasonable amounts of external static pressure ( 125 Pa), making them suitable for both indoor and outdoor installations. Centrifugal fans are also inherently quieter than axial fans, although the difference is minimal and can often be overcome through the application of optional low sound fans and/or sound attenuation on axial fan units. Fans can be applied in an induced draft or a forced draft configuration.
Centrifugal Fans
Axial Fans
Induced Draft The rotating air handling components of induced draft equipment are mounted in the top deck of the unit, minimizing the impact of fan noise on near-by neighbors and providing maximum protection from fan icing with units operating in sub-freezing conditions. The air being drawn through the unit hereby discharges over the inducing fan. The use of corrosion resistant materials ensures long life and minimizes maintenance requirements for the air handling components. Forced Draft Rotating air-handling components are located on the air inlet face at the base of forced draft towers whereby fresh air is blown through the unit. This base fan position facilitates easy access for routine maintenance and service. Additionally, location of these components in the dry entering air stream extends component life by isolating them from the corrosive saturated discharge air.
Capacity Range
In the Product Line Overview Table, product capacities are called out in terms of a flow rate. This refers to the fluid flow rate that the unit can cool from a 30C entering water temperature to 25C leaving water temperature at a 21C entering ambient wet-bulb temperature. All capacities shown are for a single cell; multiple cell units can be applied to achieve larger capacities.
CCCT - C 4
Typical Applications
A list of typical applications is provided in the Product Line Overview Table for your reference.
Principle of Operation
Configuration Fan System Capacity Range (Single Cell) Maximum Entering Fluid Temperature
Counterflow Centrifugal Fan, Forced Draft 1 tot 200 l/s 82C Small to medium HVAC & industrial applications such as water source heat pump loops and air compressor cooling Indoor installations High temperature applications Tight enclosures & installations requiring a single air inlet Extremely sound sensitive applications
Typical Applications
Small to medium HVAC & industrial applications Installations with extremely low height requirements Indoor installations High temperature industrial applications Extremely sound sensitive applications
1. Air In; 2. Air Out; 3. Fluid In; 4. Fluid Out; 5. Wet Deck Surface; 6. Cold Water Basin; 7. Water Distribution System; 8. Coil; 9. Spray Water Pump; 10. Eliminators; 11. Optional Extended Surface.
HFL, HXI and DFC water saving and hybrid wet-dry products are available to meet these specific design requirements. Refer to the "Water Saving Products" section for more details on these products.
Baltimore Aircoil
CCCT - C 5
S1500 FXV - Single Air Inlet Models FXV-D Dual Air Inlet Models
Combined flow Axial Fan, Induced Draft 3 to 149 l/s 82C Small to medium HVAC & industrial applications such as water source heat pump loops and air compressor cooling Tight enclosures & installations requiring a single air inlet Unit replacements
Combined flow Axial Fan, Induced Draft 200 to 330 82C Medium to large HVAC & industrial applications such as electric arc furnaces and pharmaceutical plants
CCCT - C 6
Overview
Performance
If an application must produce full capacity throughout the year, maintaining a clean, reliable system loop is critical. Isolating the process fluid in a closed loop system prevents airborne
Baltimore Aircoil
CCCT - C 7
contaminants from entering and fouling the system. Sustaining optimum performance in an open loop system will require regular maintenance to assure similar efficiency. High efficiency chillers and heat exchangers rely on clean process water to function properly and are significantly impacted by even small amounts of fouling.
Expense
The initial equipment cost of an open loop system will be less than a comparably sized closed loop system, since the open system does not include the intermediate heat exchanger component. However, the higher first cost of a closed loop system will be paid back during years of operation through the following savings:
z
Cleaner process fluid results in a cleaner internal surface area, and higher efficiency components in the system (e.g. chiller) Reduced system maintenance costs Reduced water treatment costs for evaporative equipment Operating in free cooling mode during the winter to save energy consumption
Maintenance
Since the process fluid of a closed loop system is completely isolated from the environment, routine maintenance is only required on the heat rejection equipment itself. The need to shut down the system periodically to clean the heat exchanger is dramatically reduced, if not entirely eliminated. Providing clean process fluid to the system will extend the life of other components in the system (condenser bundles, compressors, etc.).
Water Treatment
Maintaining proper process fluid quality in a system may involve several steps, such as chemical treatment, filtration equipment and the addition of clean make-up water. A closed circuit cooling tower can provide the following advantages over an open cooling tower:
z
Lower volume of recirculating water to treat Process loop requires minimal treatment During periods of dry operation, the need for make-up water is eliminated
Operational Flexibility
Closed circuit cooling towers allow for the following modes of operation not possible with open cooling towers:
z
Free cooling operation without the need for an intermediate heat exchanger: Chiller turned off Dry operation: Conserve water and treatment chemicals, prevent icing and eliminate plume Variable pumping: Closed condenser water loop allows for variable speed pumping to conserve energy
CCCT - C 8
Total cost: Addition of a heat exchanger (pump, piping, etc.) to the open tower loop brings the initial cost much closer to that of the closed circuit tower system Single piece of equipment: Compact design of the closed circuit tower conserves space in a self-contained package, compared to multiple locations for the tower/heat exchanger arrangement Maintenance: Narrow spacing in heat exchanger (e.g. plate and frame) may trap solids introduced by the open tower, requiring frequent, time consuming cleaning to assure optimum performance Dry operation: Open tower/heat exchanger system cannot be run dry in the winter
Overview
These guidelines provide some general information to help decide whether a closed circuit cooling tower is better suited for a particular application than an open tower, with or without a heat exchanger. For additional assistance with a project, please contact your local BAC Balticare Representative.
Note : BAC offers heat exchanger skids in combination with most of his open cooling tower products. These skids are available for both new installations or to retrofit on existing installations. The heat exchanger skid consists of a plate heat exchanger with pump and interconnecting piping and appendages. The skids are delivered on a heavy duty frame and with steel panel enclosure. Refer to your BAC Balticare representative for more details and selections.
Baltimore Aircoil
CCCT - C 9
Engineering Considerations
Location
Units must have an adequate supply of fresh air to the air inlet(s). When units are located adjacent to building walls or in enclosures, care must be taken to ensure that the warm, saturated discharge air is not deflected off surrounding walls or enclosures and drawn back to the air inlet(s).
Warning: Each unit should be located and positioned to prevent the introduction of the warm discharge air and the associated drift, which may contain chemical or biological contaminants including Legionella, into the ventilation systems of the building on which the unit is located or those of adjacent buildings.
Note: For detailed recommendations on layout, please consult your local BAC Balticare Representative.
For VL and VX products, bottom screens or solid bottom panels may be desirable or necessary for safety, depending on the location and conditions at the installation site.
Capacity Control
Variable Frequency Drives (VFD) Installations which are to be controlled by Variable Frequency Drives (VFD) require the use of an inverter duty motor as designed IEC 34.1, which recognizes the increased stresses placed on motors by these drive systems. Inverter duty motors must be furnished on VFD applications in order to maintain the motor warranty. Fan motors must be furnished with thermal protection (either PTC sensors or coil thermostats normally open, or normally closed). The motor protection consists of temperature sensitive cutout devices embedded in the motor windings (minimum 3 per motor). BAC offers factory installed motor control packages including VFD drives. Refer to the section "Technical Resources, Motor Controls". Check with your local BAC Balticare representative for availability.
Warning: When the fan speed is to be changed from the factory-set speed, including through the use of a variable speed control device, steps must be taken to avoid operating at or near fan speeds that cause a resonance with the unit or its supporting structure. At start-up, the variable frequency drive should be cycled slowly between zero and full speed and any speeds that cause a noticeable resonance in the unit should be locked out by the variable speed drive.
Fan Cycling Fan cycling is the simplest method of capacity control. The number of steps of capacity control can be increased using the Baltiguard Fan System, the independent fan motor option, or two-speed fan motors in conjunction with fan cycling (see the Custom Features & Options section of the appropriate product line to determine whether the Baltiguard Fan System or the independent fan motor option are available; two-speed motors are available for all products). These options provide substantial energy savings when compared to simple fan cycling.
Warning: Rapid on-off cycling can cause the fan motor to overheat. It is recommended that controls be set to allow a maximum of 6 on-off cycles per hour.
CCCT - C 10
Note: Spray water pump cycling should not be used for capacity control. This method of control often results in short cycling of the pump motor as capacity changes substantially with pump cycling. In addition, alternate wetting and drying of the coil promotes scaling of the heat exchanger coil surface.
Capacity Control Dampers (VFL and VXI models only) On centrifugal fan models, modulating capacity control dampers are available to provide close control of the leaving temperature. See Section "Accessories" or contact your local BAC Balticare representative.
Overview
Vibration cutout switches are recommended on all axial fan installations. Vibration cutout switches are designed to interrupt power to the fan motor and/or provide an alarm to the operator in the event of excessive vibration. BAC offers both electronic and mechanical vibration cutout switches on all evaporative condensers.
Water Treatment
As water evaporates in the unit, the dissolved solids originally present in the water remain in the system. The concentration of these dissolved solids increases rapidly and can cause scale and corrosion. In addition, airborne impurities and biological contaminants, including Legionella, may be introduced into the circulating water. To control all potential contaminants, a water treatment program must be employed. In many cases, a simple bleed-off may be adequate for control of scale and corrosion. However, biological contamination, including Legionella, can be controlled only through the use of biocides. Such treatment should be initiated at system startup, after periods of equipment shutdown, and continued regularly thereafter. Accordingly, it is strongly recommended a biocide treatment be initiated when the unit is first filled with water and continued regularly thereafter. For more information, consult the appropriate Operating and Maintenance Manual. When a water treatment program is employed, it must be compatible with construction materials. Batch feeding of chemicals into the unit is not recommended. If units are constructed with optional corrosion resistant materials, acid treatment may be considered; however, the water quality must be maintained within the guidelines set forth in the Operating and Maintenance Instructions.
Note: Unless a common remote sump is utilised, each cell of a multi-cell installation must be treated as a separate entity, even if the cold water basins are equalised.
For complete Water Quality Guidelines, see the appropriate Operating and Maintenance Instruction Manual, available at www.baltimoreaircoil.com. For specific recommendations on water treatment, contact a competent water treatment supplier.
Sound Levels
Sound rating data are available for all BAC models. When calculating the sound levels generated by a unit, the designer must take into account the effects of the geometry of the tower as well as the distance and direction from the unit to noise-sensitive areas. Whisper Quiet fans and intake and discharge sound attenuation can be supplied on certain models to provide reduced sound characteristics (see the Custom Features and Options section of the appropriate product line for details). The Baltiguard Fan System, two-speed motors, or variable frequency drives can also be used to reduce sound during periods of non-peak thermal loads. For more information on sound and how it relates to evaporative cooling equipment, see Section "Technical Resources, Fundamentals of Sound". For detailed low sound selections, please consult your local BAC Balticare Representative.
Baltimore Aircoil
CCCT - C 11
Winterization
When a unit is shut down in freezing weather, the basin water must be protected by draining to an indoor auxiliary remote sump tank or by providing supplementary heat to the cold water basin. Supplementary heat can be provided by electric immersion heaters or in some cases, hot water, steam coils, or steam injectors. All exposed water piping, make-up lines, and spray pumps (if applicable) that do not drain at shutdown should be traced with electric heater tape and insulated. When dry operation is planned for low ambient conditions, centrifugal fan units should be supplied with oversized fan motors to prevent motor overload when the spray water is not operating. For remote sump applications, the spray water pump must be selected for the required flow at a total head which includes the vertical lift, pipe friction (in supply and suction lines) plus the required pressure at the inlet header of the water distribution system (14 kPa). A valve should always be installed in the discharge line from the pump to permit adjusting flow to the unit requirement. Inlet water pressure should be measured by a pressure gauge installed in the water supply riser at the spray water inlet, and adjusted to the specified inlet pressure.
Note: Axial fan units are not suitable for indoor installations.
Safety
Adequate precautions, appropriate for the installation and location of these products, should be taken to safeguard the public from possible injury and the equipment and the premises from damage. Operation, maintenance and repair of this equipment should be undertaken only by personnel qualified to do so. Proper care, procedures and tools must be used in handling, lifting, installing, operating, maintaining, and repairing this equipment to prevent personal injury and/or property damage.
Fluid Compatibility
The fluid to be cooled must be compatible with the coil material (standard serpentine are carbon steel, hot-dip galvanized on the outside only). Fluids not compatible with coil materials can lead to corrosion and tube failure. Certain fluids may require occasional pressure cleaning or mechanical cleaning of the inside of coil tubes. In such cases the coil must be designed to provide this capability.
CCCT - C 12
Overview
coil freezing can occur even at full flow. Protective means are readily available to avoid potential freeze problems. Where the system will permit, the best protection against coil freeze-up is the use of an industrially inhibited anti-freeze solution. When this is not possible, the system must be designed to meet both of the following conditions: 1. Maintain minimum recommended flow through the coil at all times, as per the table below: 2. Maintain a heat load on the circulating fluid so that the temperature of the fluid leaving the coil will not be below 7C. If the process load is extremely light, or if the process is periodically shut off entirely, then an auxiliary heat load must be applied to the circulating fluid when below freezing ambient temperatures exist to prevent damage to the coil. Refer to the Heat Loss Data table (see the product section for applicable heat loss data) for the auxiliary heat load requirement. The amount of auxiliary heat necessary to prevent coil freezing can be further reduced by the use of a positive closure damper hood and insulation. Draining the coil is not recommended as a normal method of freeze protection. However, draining is acceptable as an emergency method of freeze protection. Frequent draining can promote corrosion inside the coil tubes. If the coil is not protected by an industrially inhibited anti-freeze solution, an automatic drain valve and air vent is recommended to drain the coil if flow stops or fluid temperature drops below 7C when the ambient temperature is below freezing. Note that cold water basin heaters will not provide freeze protection for the coil. The coil of dry and adiabatic coolers can never drain completely. If a minimum heat load can not be guaranteed on the dry coil during the winter period, then the use of an anti-freeze solution is the only available protection against coil freezing.
Model VFL 24X - 48X VFL 72X - 96X VXI 9, 18, 27, 36 VXI 50 VXI 70 VXI 95, 145 VXI 144, 215 VXI 180 VXI 190, 290 VXI 288, 430 VXI 360 VXI 42X, 43X FXV 44X FXV Q44X FXV 5XX FXV Q5XX FXV 64X, 66X FXV Q6XX FXV D288X FXV D288XQ FXV 364X FXV 364XQ Minimum Flow (l/s) 4,1 7,9 3,5 5 7 8 13 11 16 26 22 3 5 10 6 12 7 14 18 36 18 36
Warranties
Please refer to the Limitation of Warranties applicable to and in effect at the time of the sale/ purchase of these products.
Baltimore Aircoil
VXI - C 13
VXI
Product Detail
VXI Closed Circuit Cooling Towers ...................................................... C14 Benefits ..................................................................................................... C16 Construction Details ................................................................................ C17 Custom Features and Options ................................................................ C19 Accessories ............................................................................................... C21 Engineering Data ..................................................................................... C23 Structural Support .................................................................................. C30 Engineering Specifications ..................................................................... C32
VXI - C 14
VXI
General Description
VXI Closed Circuit Cooling Towers deliver fully rated thermal performance over a wide range of flow and temperature requirements. The VXI can be installed indoors and can accommodate limited ceiling or enclosure heights. The VXI design minimizes sound levels and installation costs, provides year-round operating reliability, and simplifies maintenance requirements.
Key Features
z
Suitable for indoor and outdoor installations Suitable for high temperature applications Low sound Single side air inlet Low energy consumption Low installed cost Easy maintenance Reliable year-round operation Long service life
Baltimore Aircoil
VXI - C 15
VXI - C 16
Benefits
Installation and Application Flexibility
z
Indoor Installations Centrifugal fans can overcome the static pressure imposed by external ductwork, allowing these units to be installed indoors.
Low Sound
VXI
z z
Centrifugal Fan - Centrifugal fans have inherently low sound characteristics. Single Side Air Inlet - Particularly sound-sensitive areas can be accommodated by facing the quiet side (back panel) to the sound-sensitive direction.
Evaporative Cooling Equipment minimizes the energy consumption of the entire system because it provides lower operating temperatures. The owner saves money while conserving natural resources and reducing environmental impact.
Support All models mount directly on two parallel I-beams (supplied by others) and ship complete with motors and drives factory-installed and aligned. Modular Design Large models ship in multiple sections to minimize the size and weight of the heaviest lift, allowing for the use of smaller, less costly cranes.
Easy Maintenance
z
Internal Access - The interior of the unit is easily accessible for adjusting the float valve, cleaning the strainer or flushing the basin.
Materials of Construction Various materials are available to meet the corrosion resistance, unit operating life, and budgetary requirements of any project (See section "Technical Resources, Materials of Construction" for more details)
V-Belt Drive The fans, motor, and drive system are located outside of the moist discharge airstream, protecting them from moisture, condensation and icing hence allowing a safe yearround operation.
The water level control is easily reached from the access door.
Baltimore Aircoil
VXI - C 17
Construction Details
Upper Section
Lower Section
VXI - C 18
Plastic spray header and branches Large orifice, non-clog nozzles Grommetted for easy maintenance
VXI
3. Coil
z
Continuous serpentine, steel tubing Hot-dip galvanized after fabrication (HDGAF) Sloped tubes for free drainage of fluid Designed for max. 10 bar operating pressure according to PED
4. Drift Eliminators
z
UV resistant non-corrosive material, impervious to rot, decay and biological attack Three distinct changes in air direction to reduce drift loss significantly Assembled in easy to handle sections, which can be removed for access to the equipment interior
6. Centrifugal Fan(s)
z
Quiet Operation
Close coupled, bronze fitted centrifugal pump Totally enclosed fan cooled (TEFC) motor Bleed line with metering valve installed from pump discharge to overflow
8. Access Door
z
Baltimore Aircoil
VXI - C 19
Standard Construction: Steel panels and structural elements are constructed of Z600 heavy-gauge hot-dip galvanized steel protected with the Baltiplus Corrosion Protection on the outside of the unit. Optional BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System: The BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System, a hybrid polymer coating used to extend equipment life, is applied before assembly to all hot-dip galvanized steel components of the unit. Optional Stainless Steel Construction: Steel panels and structural elements are constructed of stainless steel either type 304 or 316. Optional Water-Contact Stainless Steel Cold Water Basin: A cost-effective alternative to an all stainless steel unit. The critical components in the cold water basin and the cold water basin itself are provided in stainless steel. The remaining components are protected with the BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System.
Note: See section Technical Resources, Material Options for more details on the materials described above.
Coil Configurations
z
Standard Serpentine Coil: The standard condensing coil is constructed of continuous lengths of all prime surface steel, hot-dip galvanized after fabrication (HDGAF). Optional Extended Surface Coil: Coils are available with selected rows finned at 3 to 5 fins per inch for wet/dry applications. The coil is hot-dip galvanized after fabrication (HDGAF). Optional Stainless Steel Coil: Coils are available in Type 304L or 316L stainless steel for specialized applications.
All coils are designed for low pressure drop with sloping tubes for free drainage of fluid.
VXI - C 20
VXI
Baltimore Aircoil
VXI - C 21
Accessories
Electric Water Level Control Package
The electric water level control replaces the standard mechanical make-up valve when a more precise water level control is required. This package consists of a float switch mounted in the basin and a solenoid activated valve in the makeup water line. The valve is slow closing to minimize water hammer.
Basin Heaters
Units exposed to below freezing ambient temperatures require protection to prevent freezing of the water in the cold water basin when Electric Water Level Control Package the unit is idle. Factory-installed heaters, which maintain the water temperature at 4C, are a simple and inexpensive way of providing such protection. The heater package includes the heaters, a thermostat and a low level cut out switch to protect the heaters if the water level is too low. Standard electric heaters are selected for -18C ambient temperature.
Model No. VXI VXI 9-X VXI 18-X VXI 27-X VXI 36-X VXI 50-X VXI 70-X VXI 95-X VXI 144-X VXI 145-X VXI 180-X VXI 190-X VXI 215-X VXI 288-X VXI 290-X VXI 360-X VXI 430-X Heaters -18C (kW) 1 x 1,5 1 x 1,5 1 x 2,5 1x3 1x4 1x6 1x6 2x4 2x4 2x5 2x6 2x6 4x4 4x4 4x5 4x6
VXI - C 22
VXI
Note: When these access options are employed, the unit must be equipped with steel drift eliminators.
Discharge Hoods
Discharge hoods reduce the risk of re-circulation in tight enclosures by increasing discharge air velocity, and can be used to elevate the unit discharge above adjacent walls to comply with layout guidelines.
Baltimore Aircoil
VXI - C 23
Engineering Data
REMARK: Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
VXI 9 - VXI 36
1. Drain ND50; 2. Outlet Connection ND80 for VXI 9-X and ND100 for VXI 18-X, VXI 27-X and VXI 36-X; 3. Overflow ND50; 4. Make Up ND25; 5. Inlet Connection ND80 for VXI 9-X and ND100 for VXI 18-X, VXI 27-X and VXI 36-X; 6. Vent ND15; 7. Access Door (not shown).
Model No. VXI VXI 9-1 VXI 9-2 VXI 9-3 VXI 18-0 VXI 18-1 VXI 18-2 VXI 18-3 VXI 27-1 VXI 27-2 VXI 27-3 VXI 36-2 VXI 36-3
Operating Weight (kg) 780 870 980 1120 1270 1440 1650 1760 1990 2300 2300 2850
Shipping Weight (kg) 670 760 830 920 1030 1160 1330 1320 1500 1730 1800 2080
Heaviest Section (kg) 660* 480 540 920* 1030* 700 860 1320* 1000 1200 1200 1440
Air Flow (m3/s) 2,3 2,2 2,5 4,6 5,0 4,8 5,5 7,6 6,8 7,1 10,4 10,9
Fan Motor (kW) (1x) 1,5 (1x) 1,5 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 4,0 (1x) 4,0 (1x) 4,0 (1x) 5,5 (1x) 5,5 (1x) 5,5 (1x) 7,5 (1x) 7,5 (1x) 11
Spray Water Flow (l/s) 2,2 2,2 2,2 4,7 4,7 4,7 4,7 7,3 7,3 7,3 9,5 9,5
Pump Motor (kW) (1x) 0,25 (1x) 0,25 (1x) 0,25 (1x) 0,37 (1x) 0,37 (1x) 0,37 (1x) 0,37 (1x) 0,75 (1x) 0,75 (1x) 0,75 (1x) 0,75 (1x) 0,75
Coil Volume (l) (1x) 75 (1x) 95 (1x) 115 (1x) 98 (1x) 140 (1x) 182 (1x) 224 (1x) 205 (1x) 269 (1x) 333 (1x) 356 (1x) 442
H (mm) 2245 2467 2683 2035 2245 2467 2683 2343 2578 2813 2578 2813
L (mm) 914 914 914 1829 1829 1829 1829 2737 2737 2737 3658 3658
W (mm) 1207 1207 1207 1207 1207 1207 1207 1207 1207 1207 1207 1207
VXI - C 24
VXI 50 - VXI 70
VXI
1. Drain ND50; 2. Outlet Connection ND100; 3. Overflow ND 80; 4. Make Up ND25 for VXI 50-X and ND50 for VXI 70-X; 5. Inlet Connection ND100; 6. Vent ND 15; 7. Access Door.
Model No. VXI VXI 50-2 VXI 50-3 VXI 50-4 VXI 70-2 VXI 70-3 VXI 70-4
Fan Motor (kW) (1x) 11 (1x) 11 (1x) 15 (1x) 15 (1x) 18,5 (1x) 18,5
Spray Water Flow (l/s) 13,9 13,9 13,9 19,2 19,2 19,2
Pump Motor (kW) (1x) 1,5 (1x) 1,5 (1x) 1,5 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2
Coil Volume (l) (1x) 515 (1x) 638 (1x) 762 (2x) 356 (2x) 442 (2x) 527
1. Drain ND50 (not shown); 2. Outlet Connection ND100; 3. Overflow ND80; 4. Make Up ND50; 5. Inlet Connection ND100; 6. Vent ND15; 7. Access Door.
Baltimore Aircoil
VXI - C 25
Model
Operating Weight (kg) 7740 8630 9520 10100 11460 12810 14160 15400 17160 18920 20350 22980 25700 28420
Shipping Weight (kg) 4990 5630 6180 6300 7280 8175 9260 9820 11100 12305 12680 14570 16550 18505
Heaviest Section (kg) 3200 3850 4470 3780 4715 5710 6690 3390* 3840 4470 5120* 5120* 5710 6690
Air Flow (m3/s) 27,6 26,7 26,2 39,9 38,6 37,5 36,6 55,4 53,4 52,5 79,5 77,8 75,0 73,1
Fan Motor (kW) (1x) 30 (1x) 30 (1x) 30 (1x) 37 (1x) 37 (1x) 37 (1x) 37 (2x) 30 (2x) 30 (2x) 30 (2x) 37 (2x) 37 (2x) 37 (2x) 37
Spray Water Flow (l/s) 25,2 25,2 25,2 38,5 38,5 38,5 38,5 50,4 50,4 50,4 77,0 77,0 77,0 77,0
Pump Motor (kW) (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (2x) 2,2 (2x) 2,2 (2x) 2,2 (2x) 4 (2x) 4 (2x) 4 (2x) 4
Coil Volume (l) (2x) 448 (2x) 556 (2x) 664 (2x) 506 (2x) 669 (2x) 832 (2x) 995 (4x) 448 (4x) 556 (4x) 664 (4x) 506 (4x) 669 (4x) 832 (4x) 995
H (mm) 4013 4248 4483 3778 4013 4248 4483 4013 4248 4483 3778 4013 4248 4483
L (mm) 3550 3550 3550 5385 5385 5385 5385 7226 7226 7226 10903 10903 10903 10903
VXI 95-2 VXI 95-3 VXI 95-4 VXI 145-1 VXI 145-2 VXI 145-3 VXI 145-4 VXI 190-2 VXI 190-3 VXI 190-4 VXI 290-1 VXI 290-2 VXI 290-3 VXI 290-4
1. Drain ND50; 2. Outlet Connection ND100; 3. Overflow ND80; 4. Make Up ND50 for VXI 180-X and ND80 for VXI 360-X; 5. Inlet Connection ND100; 6. Vent ND15; 7. Access Door.
Model
Fan Motor (kW) (2x) 18,5 (2x) 18,5 (2x) 22,0 (4x) 18,5 (4x) 18,5 (4x) 22,0
Spray Water Flow (l/s) 46,7 46,7 46,7 93,4 93,4 93,4
Coil Volume (l) (2x) 847 (2x) 1052 (2x) 1258 (4x) 847 (4x) 1052 (4x) 1258
VXI 180-2 VXI 180-3 VXI 180-4 VXI 360-2 VXI 360-3 VXI 360-4
VXI - C 26
VXI
1. Drain ND50; 2. Outlet Connection ND100. 3. Overflow ND80; 4. Make Up ND50 for VXI 144-X, VXI 215-X, VXI 288-X and ND80 for VXI 430-X; 5. Inlet Connection ND 100; 6. Vent ND15; 7. Access Door.
Model
Operating Weight (kg) 12070 13390 14710 15830 17730 19730 21690 24230 26850 29540 31750 35550 39550 43560
Shipping Weight (kg) 7270 8210 8470 9130 10460 12035 13435 14520 16520 18280 18230 20890 23770 26845
Heaviest Section (kg) 4680 5610 6550 5510 6900 8310 9710 5280* 5610 6550 7210* 7210* 8300 9710
Air Flow (m3/s) 38,6 40,2 39,4 59,4 57,9 62,3 60,4 77,3 80,0 78,8 119,2 115,9 124,6 120,7
Fan Motor (kW) (1x) 30 (1x) 37 (1x) 37 (2x) 22 (2x) 22 (2x) 30 (2x) 30 (2x) 30 (2x) 37 (2x) 37 (4x) 22 (4x) 22 (4x) 30 (4x) 30
Spray Water Flow (l/s) 39,1 39,1 39,1 56,8 56,8 56,8 56,8 78,2 78,2 78,2 113,6 113,6 113,6 113,6
Pump Motor (kW) (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (2x) 4 (2x) 4 (2x) 4 (2x) 4 (2x) 4 (2x) 4 (2x) 4
Coil Volume (l) (2x) 686 (2x) 851 (2x) 1015 (2x) 774 (2x) 1024 (2x) 1272 (2x) 1521 (4x) 686 (4x) 851 (4x) 1015 (4x) 774 (4x) 1024 (4x) 1272 (4x) 1521
H (mm) 4075 4310 4545 3840 4075 4310 4545 4075 4310 4545 3840 4075 4310 4545
L (mm) 3550 3550 3550 5388 5388 5388 5388 7226 7226 7226 10903 10903 10903 10903
W (mm) 3607 3607 3607 3607 3607 3607 3607 3607 3607 3607 3607 3607 3607 3607
VXI 144-2 VXI 144-3 VXI 144-4 VXI 215-1 VXI 215-2 VXI 215-3 VXI 215-4 VXI 288-2 VXI 288-3 VXI 288-4 VXI 430-1 VXI 430-2 VXI 430-3 VXI 430-4
General Notes
1. Make up, overflow, suction, drain connections and access door can be provided on side opposite to that shown; consult your BAC Balticare representative. 2. Unit height is indicative, for precise value refer to certified print. 3. Shipping/operating weights indicated are for units without accessories such as sound attenuators, discharge hoods, etc. Consult factory certified prints to obtain weight additions and the heaviest section to be lifted. 4. The standard right hand arrangement as shown has the air inlet side on the right when facing the connection end (for double pump units there is no difference between right and left hand arrangement; make-up connection only at one side). Left hand can be furnished by special order. Water connections are always located on the same end of the unit. 5. For indoor applications of closed circuit cooling towers, the room may be used as a plenum with ductwork attached to the discharge only. If inlet ductwork is required, an enclosed fan section must be specified; consult your BAC Balticare representative for details. 6. Fan kW is at 0 Pa ESP. To operate against external static pressure up to 125 Pa, increase each fan motor one size. 7. On models VXI 9 to VXI 36 access doors are located at the opposite of the air inlet side, ensure sufficient space for entry when positioning these units. 8. Coil, overflow, make-up and spray water connections are always located on the same end of the unit.
Baltimore Aircoil
VXI - C 27
9. When flow rate on model VXI 50 exceeds 30 l/s, on models VXI 144, 180, 215 exceeds 60 l/s and on models VXI 288, 360 and 430 exceeds 120 l/s, the quantity of coil connections will be double. 10. Models VXI 9 through VXI 70 have one coil section and one fan motor, which can be switched on and off. Multiple speed motors are available for additional steps of capacity control. Modulating capacity control can be obtained with fan discharge dampers. Consult your local BAC Balticare representative for details. 11. For dry operation, standard motors must be increased one size to avoid motor overloading. Extended surface coils are available to vastly increase dry capacity without motor size increase. Consult your local BAC Balticare representative for selection and pricing. 12. Models VXI 95, 144, 145, 180 and 215 are single side coil connection units. For these models coil, overflow, make-up and spray water connections are always located on the same end of the unit. Models can be supplied as standard in right hand arrangement as shown. Left-hand arrangement can be supplied on special order. Fan cycling of these models result in only on-off operation. 13. Models VXI 190, 290, 288, 360 and 430 are double side coil units. Coil, overflow and spray water connections are provided on both ends.
Sound Attenuation
Unit + Atten. # pieces shipped Dimensions (mm) W2 H1 W1 L1 L2 Intake + solid bottom XA 902 1816 2731 3645 3645 3645 3645 5480 140 225 300 400 500 690 690 XB 160 270 370 470 XC N.A. N.A. N.A. N.A. Weights (kg) Discharge XA 130 175 280 360 XB 150 220 350 420 XC N.A. N.A. N.A. N.A. XA 270 400 580 760 Total XB 310 490 720 890 XC N.A. N.A. N.A. N.A.
VXI
XA, XB, XC Disch. Att. Int. Att. XA, XB XC 9-X 18-X 27-X 36-X 50-X 70-X 95-X 145-X 190-X 290-X 180-X 360-X 144-X 215-X 288-X 430-X 4(1) 4(1) 4 4 4 4 4 4 7 7 4 7 4 4 7 7 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 2 4 2 4 1 2 2 4 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2352 2352 2352 2352 2583 3542 3542 3542 3542 3542 4145 4145 4752 4752 4752 4752
N.A. 1090 1030 1829 N.A. 1090 1030 2737 N.A. 1090 1030 3658 3728 1600 1420 3645 4687 2070 1955 3550 4687 2070 2365 3550 4687 2070 2365 5385 4687 2070 2365 7226
520 1070 940 1120 2270 650 1330 1220 1470 2940 800 1640 1350 1620 3250
7322 1380 1640 3220 1320 1600 3280 2700 3240 6500
4687 2070 2365 10903 10998 1920 2320 4540 1660 2180 4480 3580 4500 9020 5290 2560 2965 5388 5480 1080 1330 2590 900 1210 2490 1980 2540 5080
5290 2560 2965 10903 10994 2160 2660 5180 1800 2420 4980 3960 5080 10160 5897 2560 3575 3550 5897 2560 3575 5388 5897 2560 3575 7226 3645 840 990 1900 810 1030 2130 1650 2020 4030
5480 1150 1400 2660 1020 1410 2920 2170 2810 5580 7322 1680 1980 3800 1620 2060 4260 3300 4040 8060
5897 2560 3575 10903 10994 2300 2800 5320 2040 2820 5840 4340 5620 11160
VXI 9-1, VXI 18-0 and VXI 18-1 + Attenuator are shipped in 3 pieces Intake Attenuator: Access opening is 775 mm high, 405 mm wide and is located at each end of the unit.
Discharge Attenuator : Access opening is 405 mm high, 1170 mm wide and is located at blank off side of the unit (VXI-9-X has 650 mm width)
VXI - C 28
XA + XB Sound Attenuation
VXI
1. Access Door; L= Unit Length; W= Unit Width; H.= Unit Height (see Engineering Data).
XC Sound Attenuation
1. Access Door; L= Unit Length; W= Unit Width; H.= Unit Height (see Engineering Data).
Baltimore Aircoil
VXI - C 29
(1) Heat loss data based on 10C water and -14C ambient temperature with 20 m/s wind velocity (fans and pump off)
VXI - C 30
Structural Support
REMARK: Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
The recommended support arrangement for units consists of parallel I-beams running the full length of the unit, spaced as shown in the following drawing. Besides providing adequate support, the steel also serves to raise the unit above any solid foundation to ensure access to the bottom of the unit. To support units in an alternate steel support arrangement, consult your BAC Balticare Representative.
VXI
Notes:
1. The recommended support arrangement for VX units consists of parallel I-beams extending the full length of the unit. Supports and anchor bolts are to be designed and furnished by others. 2. All supporting beams are to be flush and level at top and must be oriented relative to gage line as shown. 3. Recommended design loads for each unit support beam should be 70% of the total unit operating weight applied as a uniform load to each of the unit beams. The support beam(s) for the optional intake attenuator(s) needs to carry attenuator only, uniform load of 250 kg/m. Beams should be designed in accordance with standard structural practice. For the maximum allowable deflection of beams under the unit refer to above table. 4. All mounting holes have a diameter of 22 mm at the locations shown. 5. If vibration isolators are used, a rail or channel must be provided between the unit (and optional attenuator) and the isolators to provide continuous unit support. Additionally the support beams must be designed to accommodate the overall length and mounting hole location of the isolators that may differ from those of the unit. Refer to vibration isolator drawings for these data.
Baltimore Aircoil
VXI - C 31
1. Outline of Unit; 2. Mounting Holes 22 mm; 3. Outline of attenuator (optional XA or XB);4. Support Channel attached to optional XA or XB attenuator; 5.+3. Outline of Attenuator (optional XC); 6.+4. Support Channels attached to optional XC attenuator; 7. Unit; 8. Sound Attenuator; 9. Air Intake.
Model
A Unit Length (mm) 914 1829 2737 3658 3645 3550 3550 5385 7226 10903 5388 10903 3550 5388 7226 10903
B Unit width (mm) 1207 1207 1207 1207 1438 2397 2397 2397 2397 2397 3000 3000 3607 3607 3607 3607
C D Center dis. Center dis. Length Width (mm) (mm) 750 1664 2572 3492 3492 3238 3238 5074 6914 10586 5074 10586 3238 5074 6914 10586 1153 1153 1153 1153 1378 2397 2327 2327 2327 2327 2934 2934 3537 3537 3537 3537
Mounting holes 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 8 8 16 8 16 4 8 8 16
9-X 18-X 27-X 36-X 50-X 70-X 95-X 145-X 190-X 290-X 180-X 360-X 144-X 215-X 288-X 430-X
VXI - C 32
Engineering Specifications
1.0 Closed Circuit Cooling Tower
1.0 General: Furnish and install ____factory assembled, forced draft, centrifugal fan, closed circuit cooling tower(s) with vertical air discharge, conforming in all aspects to the specifications and schedules as shown on the plans. Overall dimensions shall not exceed approximately ____mm long x ____mm wide x ____ mm high. The total connected fan kW shall not exceed ____kW. The total connected pump kW shall not exceed ____kW. The closed circuit cooling tower(s) shall be Baltimore Aircoil Company Model(s) ________________. 1.2. Thermal Capacity (water as heat transfer fluid): The closedcircuit cooling tower(s) shall be warranted by the manufacturer to cool ______l/s of _______ water from ____C to ____C at ____C entering wet-bulb temperature. (Alternate1.2.) Thermal Capacity (aqueous glycol solution as heat transfer fluid): The closed circuit cooling tower(s) shall be warranted by the manufacturer to cool ________l/s of _____% by volume ethylene/propylene glycol solution from ______C to _____C at _____C entering wet-bulb temperature. Coil pressure drop shall not exceed ________bar. 1.3. Corrosion Resistant Construction: Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all steel panels and structural members shall be constructed of heavy-gauge Z600 metric hot-dip galvanized steel, with all sheared edges given a protective coating of zinc-rich compound and the exterior protected with the Baltiplus Corrosion Protection. (Alternate1.3.) Corrosion Resistant Construction: Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all steel panels and structural members shall be protected with the BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System. The system shall consist of Z600 metric hot-dip galvanized steel prepared in a four-step (clean, pre-treat, rinse, and dry) process with an electrostatically sprayed, thermosetting hybrid polymer fuse-bonded to the substrate during a thermally activated curing stage and monitored by a 23-step quality assurance program. 1.4. Quality Assurance: The closed circuit cooling tower manufacturer shall have a management system certified by an accredited registrar as complying with the requirements of ISO9001:2000 to ensure consistent quality of its products and services. 1.5. Warranty: The manufacturers standard equipment warranty shall be for a period of not less than one year from date of startup or eighteen months from date of shipment, whichever occurs first.
VXI
Baltimore Aircoil
VXI - C 33
5.0 Access
5.1 Basin Access: Circular access doors shall be provided for easy access to the make-up water assembly and suction strainer for routine maintenance.
6.0 Sound
6.1 Sound Level: To maintain the quality of the local environment, the maximum sound pressure levels (dB) measured 15 m from the cooling tower operating at full fan speed shall not exceed the sound levels detailed below.
63
125
250
500
1000
2000
4000
8000
dB(A)
VXI - C 34
VXI
Baltimore Aircoil has developed a network of highly qualified sales representatives backed up by an experienced technical staff who will work hand-in-hand with you to ensure that each of your projects is a success. If you need help deciding which product to use, you can count on the support of your local BAC Balticare representative to develop solutions that meet your requirements. You can find BAC contact details on the web www.BaltimoreAircoil.com or You can send a request to info-bac@baltimoreaircoil.be
Baltimore Aircoil
VFL - C 35
Product Detail
VFL Closed Circuit Cooling Tower ....................................................... C36 Benefits ..................................................................................................... C38 Construction Details ................................................................................ C40 Custom Features and Options ................................................................ C41 Accessories ............................................................................................... C43 Engineering Data ..................................................................................... C45 Structural Support .................................................................................. C50 Engineering Specifications ..................................................................... C51
VFL - C 36
General Description
VFL Closed Circuit Cooling Towers deliver fully rated thermal performance over a wide range of flow and temperature requirements. The VFL can be installed indoors and minimize sound levels, and are available to accommodate limited ceiling or enclosure heights. The VFL design minimizes installation costs, provides year-round operating reliability, and simplifies maintenance requirements.
Key Features
Suitable for indoor and outdoor installations Suitable for high temperature applications Suitable for locations with limited ceiling or enclosure heights and roof top installations Low sound Single side air inlet Low energy consumption Low installed cost Easy maintenance Reliable year-round operation Long service life
Baltimore Aircoil
VFL - C 37
VFL - C 38
Benefits
Installation and Application Flexibility
Indoor Installations Centrifugal fans can overcome the static pressure imposed by external ductwork, allowing this type of cooling towers to be installed indoors. Low Profile Models The fan section of low profile units is adjacent to the casing section to yield models suitable for use in height sensitive installations. Low profile models are available in heights of 1855 mm up to 2560 mm.
Low Sound
Centrifugal Fan - Centrifugal fans have inherently low sound characteristics.
Single Side Air Inlet - Particularly sound-sensitive areas can be accommodated by facing the quiet side (back panel) to the sound-sensitive direction.
Easy Maintenance
Internal Access - The interior of the unit is easily accessible for adjusting the float valve, cleaning the strainer or flushing the basin.
Modular Design
Baltimore Aircoil
VFL - C 39
VFL - C 40
Construction Details
Assembled in easy to handle sections, which can be removed for access to the equipment interior
6. Centrifugal Fan(s)
Quiet Operation
3. Coil
Continuous serpentine, steel tubing Hot-dip galvanized after fabrication (HDGAF) Sloped tubes for free drainage of fluid Designed for max. 10 bar operating pressure according to PED
4. Drift Eliminators
UV resistant non-corrosive material, impervious to rot, decay and biological attack Three distinct changes in air direction to reduce drift loss significantly
8. Access Door
Circular access door
Baltimore Aircoil
VFL - C 41
Optional Stainless Steel Construction: Steel panels and structural elements are constructed of stainless steel either type 304 or 316. Optional Water-Contact Stainless Steel Cold Water Basin: A cost-effective alternative to an all stainless steel unit. The critical components in the cold water basin and the cold water basin itself are provided in stainless steel. The remaining components are protected with the BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System.
Note: See section Technical Resources, Material Options for more details on the materials described above.
Coil Configurations
Standard Serpentine Coil: The standard condensing coil is constructed of continuous lengths of all prime surface steel, hot-dip galvanized after fabrication (HDGAF). Optional Extended Surface Coil: Coils are available with selected rows finned at 3 to 5 fins per inch for wet/dry applications. The coil is hot-dip galvanized after fabrication (HDGAF). Optional Stainless Steel Coil: Coils are available in Type 304L or 316L stainless steel for specialized applications. All coils are designed for low pressure drop with sloping tubes for free drainage of fluid.
VFL - C 42
Baltimore Aircoil
VFL - C 43
Accessories
Electric Water Level Control Package
The electric water level control replaces the standard mechanical make-up valve when a more precise water level control is required. This package consists of a float switch mounted in the basin and a solenoid activated valve in the makeup water line. The valve is slow closing to minimize water hammer.
Basin Heaters
Units exposed to below freezing ambient temperatures require protection to prevent freezing of the water in the cold water basin when the unit is idle. Factory-installed heaters, which maintain the water temperature at 4C, are a simple and inexpensive way of providing such protection. The heater package includes the heaters, a thermostat and a low level cut out switch to protect the heaters if the water level is too low. Standard electric heaters are selected for -18C ambient temperature.
Model No. VFL VFL 24X VFL 36X VFL 48X VFL 72X VFL 96X Heaters -18C (kW) 1x3 1x4 1x5 2x4 2x5
Modulating capacity control dampers are available to provide better leaving water temperature control than can be obtained from fan cycling alone. Fan discharge dampers consist of a single airfoil type damper blade located in the discharge of each fan housing. A standard electrical control package for dampers is available from BAC.
VFL - C 44
Discharge Hoods
Discharge hoods reduce the risk of re-circulation in tight enclosures by increasing discharge air velocity, and can be used to elevate the unit discharge above adjacent walls to comply with layout guidelines.
Baltimore Aircoil
VFL - C 45
Engineering Data
REMARK: Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
VFL 24 X - VFL 48 X
1. Fluid in ND100; 2. Fluid Out ND100; 3.Access Door; 4. Make Up ND25; 5. Overflow ND50 for VFL 24X - VFL 36x and ND80 for VFL 48X; 6. Drain ND50; 7. Vent ND15.
Model No. VFL VFL 241-H VFL 242-H VFL 242-J VFL 243-J VFL 361-L VFL 361-M VFL 362-M VFL 363-K VFL 363-M VFL 481-M VFL 482-L VFL 483-L VFL 483-M VFL 484-M
Operating Weight (kg) 1950 2220 2230 2470 2800 2810 3130 3470 3540 3490 3930 4390 4400 4860
Shipping Weight (kg) 1280 1460 1490 1670 1810 1820 2090 2280 2350 2170 2490 2830 2840 3170
Heaviest Section (kg) 1280 1460 1490 1670 1810 1820 2090 2280 2350 2170 2490 2830 2840 3170
Air Flow (m/s) 7,6 7,4 8,1 7,9 12,7 13,8 13,4 10,8 13,0 15,1 13,6 13,4 14,6 14,3
Spray Water Flow (l/s) 5,9 5,9 5,9 5,9 9,0 9,0 9,0 9,0 9,0 12,1 12,1 12,1 12,1 12,1
Pump Motor (kW) 0,55 0,55 0,55 0,55 0,75 0,75 0,75 0,75 0,75 1,1 1,1 1,1 1,1 1,1
Coil Volume (L) (1x) 176 (1x) 229 (1x) 229 (1x) 282 (1x) 258 (1x) 258 (1x) 338 (1x) 418 (1x) 418 (1x) 341 (1x) 448 (1x) 556 (1x) 556 (1x) 664
H (mm) 1855 2015 2015 2230 1855 1855 2090 2350 2350 1855 2090 2350 2350 2560
L (mm) 3350 3350 3350 3350 4560 4560 4560 4560 4560 5480 5480 5480 5480 5480
W (mm) 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250
VFL - C 46
VFL 72 X - VFL 96 X
1. Fluid in ND100; 2. Fluid Out ND100; 3.Access Door; 4. Make Up ND50; 5. Overflow ND80; 6. Drain ND50; 7. Vent ND15.
Model No. VFL VFL 721-L VFL 721-M VFL 721-O VFL 722-N VFL 722-O VFL 723-L VFL 723-O VFL 724-O VFL 961-P VFL 962-N VFL 962-O VFL 962-P VFL 963-O VFL 963-P VFL 964-P
Operating Weight (kg) 5150 5160 5190 5880 5900 6610 6650 7320 6520 7285 7310 7400 8210 8310 9300
Shipping Weight (kg) 3150 3160 3190 3700 3720 4210 4250 4790 3850 4360 4400 4500 5060 5160 5810
Heaviest Section (kg) 3150 3160 3190 3700 3720 4210 4250 4790 3850 4360 4400 4500 5080 5160 5810
Air Flow (m/s) 20,0 21,8 24,6 22,8 24,0 19,3 23,4 22,9 28,7 24,5 25,9 28,3 25,6 27,9 27,4
Spray Water Flow (l/s) 17,9 17,9 17,9 17,9 17,9 17,9 17,9 17,9 24,2 24,2 24,2 24,2 24,2 24,2 24,2
Pump Motor (kW) 1,1 1,1 1,1 1,1 1,1 1,1 1,1 1,1 2,2 2,2 2,2 2,2 2,2 2,2 2,2
Coil Volume (L) (2x) 258 (2x) 258 (2x) 258 (2x) 338 (2x) 338 (2x) 418 (2x) 418 (2x) 498 (2x) 341 (2x) 448 (2x) 448 (2x) 448 (2x) 556 (2x) 556 (2x) 664
H (mm) 1855 1855 1855 2090 2090 2350 2350 2560 1855 2090 2090 2090 2350 2350 2560
L (mm) 4560 4560 4560 4560 4560 4560 4560 4560 5480 5480 5480 5480 5480 5480 5480
W (mm) 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400
General Notes
1. All location dimensions for coil connections are approximate and should not be used for prefabrication of connecting piping. 2. If discharge hoods with positive closure dampers are furnished, see table in section Engineering Data Straight Discharge Hood with PCD for added weight and height. 3. For external static pressure up to 125 Pa use next larger motor size. 4. For indoor applications of fluid coolers, the room may be used as a plenum with ductwork attached to the discharge only. If inlet ductwork is required, an enclosed fan section must be specified; consult your BAC Balticare representative for details. 5. Fan cycling results only in on-off operation. For additional steps of control, two-speed fan motors are available. More precise capacity control can be obtained with modulation fan discharge dampers or a BALTIGUARD Drive System 6. Make up, overflow, suction, drain connections and access door can be provided on side opposite to that shown; consult your BAC Balticare representative. 7. Shipping/operating weights indicated are for units without accessories such as sound attenuators, discharge hoods, plume abatement coils, etc. Consult factory certified prints to obtain weight additions and the heaviest section to be lifted.
Baltimore Aircoil
VFL - C 47
Sound Attenuation
HS Horizontal Intake Sound Attenuation
1.Discharge attenuator, 2. Access Door, 3. Intake Attenuator; W & H = Unit Dimensions (See Engineering Data).
1.Discharge attenuator, 2. Access Door, 3. Intake Attenuator; W & H = Unit Dimensions (See Engineering Data).
VFL - C 48
1.Discharge attenuator, 2. Access Door, 3. Intake Attenuator, 4. Plenum; W & H = Unit Dimensions (See Engineering Data).
Dimensions (mm) Model No VFL HS VFL 24X VFL 36X VFL 48X VFL 72X VFL 96X 2390 2640 2640 2640 2640 L2 HD 3125 3375 3375 3375 3375 VS 2010 2010 2010 2010 2010 L1 HS,HD,VS 1820 2730 3650 2730 3650 Intake Attenuator + Solid Bottom HS 430 465 465 665 665 HD 625 660 660 980 980 VS 548 541 566 756 761
Maximum Weight (kg) Discharge Attenuator HS 210 295 365 465 565 HD 230 315 385 500 605 VS 192 264 334 419 529 HS 640 760 830 1130 1230 Total HD 855 975 1045 1480 1585 VS 740 805 900 1175 1290
Note: All units with HS or VS attenuators ship in 2 pieces. All units with HD attenuators ship in 3 pieces.
Baltimore Aircoil
VFL - C 49
1. Access Door.
Heat Loss Data (kW) (1) Model No. VFL VFL 241-H VFL 242-H VFL 242-J VFL 243-J VFL 361-L VFL 361-M VFL 362-M VFL 363-K VFL 363-M VFL 481-M VFL 482-L VFL 483-L VFL 483-M VFL 484-M VFL 721-L VFL 721-M VFL 721-O VFL 722-N VFL 722-O VFL 723-L VFL 723-O VFL 724-O VFL 961-P VFL 962-N VFL 962-O VFL 962-P VFL 963-O VFL 963-P VFL 964-P Standard Unit 10,6 12,7 12,7 14,4 16,0 16,0 19,1 21,6 21,6 23,0 27,2 30,5 30,5 33,8 40,1 40,1 40,1 46,4 46,4 51,5 51,5 56,6 47,9 56,3 56,3 56,3 63,0 63,0 69,7 Unit with Discharge Hood and PCDs 6,3 6,7 6,7 7,1 9,8 9,8 10,4 11,0 11,0 13,8 14,5 15,2 15,2 15,9 17,8 17,8 17,8 18,6 18,6 19,3 19,3 20,0 20,1 21,0 21,0 21,0 21,9 21,9 23,8 L W H
1820
1200
865
2730
1200
865
3650
1200
865
2730
2400
865
3650
2400
865
(1) Heat loss data based on 10C water and 14C ambient temperature with 20 m/s wind velocity (fans and pump off).
VFL - C 50
Structural Support
REMARK: Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
The recommended support arrangement for units consists of parallel I-beams running the full length of the unit, spaced as shown in the following drawing. Besides providing adequate support, the steel also serves to raise the unit above any solid foundation to ensure access to the bottom of the unit. To support units in an alternate steel support arrangement, consult your BAC Balticare Representative.
Notes:
1. The recommended support arrangement for VL units consists of two parallel I-beams extending the full length of the unit. Supports and anchor bolts are to be designed and furnished by others. 2. All supporting beams are to be flush and level at top and must be oriented relative to gage line as shown. 3. Recommended design loads for each unit support beam should be 70% of the total unit operating weight applied as a uniform load to each of the unit beams. Beams should be designed in accordance with standard structural practice. For the maximum allowable deflection of beams under the unit refer to above table. 4. All mounting holes have a diameter of 22 mm at the locations shown. 5. If vibration isolators are used, a rail or channel must be provided between the unit and the isolators to provide continuous unit support. Additionally the support beams must be designed to accommodate the overall length and mounting hole location of the isolators that may differ from those of the unit. Refer to vibration isolator drawings for these data.
Baltimore Aircoil
VFL - C 51
Engineering Specifications
1.0 Closed Circuit Cooling Tower
1.0 General: Furnish and install ____factory assembled, forced draft, centrifugal fan, closed circuit cooling tower(s) with vertical air discharge, conforming in all aspects to the specifications and schedules as shown on the plans. Overall dimensions shall not exceed approximately ____mm long x ____mm wide x ____ mm high. The total connected fan kW shall not exceed ____kW. The total connected pump kW shall not exceed ____kW. The closed circuit cooling tower(s) shall be Baltimore Aircoil Company Model(s) ________________. 1.2. Thermal Capacity (water as heat transfer fluid): The closedcircuit cooling tower(s) shall be warranted by the manufacturer to cool ______l/s of _______ water from ____C to ____C at ____C entering wet-bulb temperature. (Alternate1.2.) Thermal Capacity (aqueous glycol solution as heat transfer fluid): The closed circuit cooling tower(s) shall be warranted by the manufacturer to cool ________l/s of _____% by volume ethylene/propylene glycol solution from ______C to _____C at _____C entering wet-bulb temperature. Coil pressure drop shall not exceed ________bar. 1.3. Corrosion Resistant Construction: Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all steel panels and structural members shall be constructed of heavy-gauge Z600 metric hot-dip galvanized steel, with all sheared edges given a protective coating of zinc-rich compound and the exterior protected with the Baltiplus Corrosion Protection. (Alternate1.3.) Corrosion Resistant Construction: Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all steel panels and structural members shall be protected with the BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System. The system shall consist of Z600 metric hot-dip galvanized steel prepared in a four-step (clean, pre-treat, rinse, and dry) process with an electrostatically sprayed, thermosetting hybrid polymer fuse-bonded to the substrate during a thermally activated curing stage and monitored by a 23-step quality assurance program. 1.4. Quality Assurance: The closed circuit cooling tower manufacturer shall have a management system certified by an accredited registrar as complying with the requirements of ISO9001:2000 to ensure consistent quality of its products and services. 1.5. Warranty: The manufacturers standard equipment warranty shall be for a period of not less than one year from date of startup or eighteen months from date of shipment, whichever occurs first.
VFL - C 52
5.0 Access
5.1 Basin Access: Circular access doors shall be provided for easy access to the make-up water assembly and suction strainer for routine maintenance.
6.0 Sound
6.1 Sound Level: To maintain the quality of the local environment, the maximum sound pressure levels (dB) measured 15 m from the cooling tower operating at full fan speed shall not exceed the sound levels detailed below.
63
125
250
500
1000
2000
4000
8000
dB(A)
Baltimore Aircoil
FXV - C 53
FXV
Product Detail
FXV Closed Circuit Cooling Tower ....................................................... C54 Benefits ..................................................................................................... C56 Construction Details ................................................................................ C58 Custom Features and Options ................................................................ C60 Accessories ............................................................................................... C62 Engineering Data FXV Models .............................................................. C65 Structural Support FXV Models ............................................................ C70 Engineering Data FXV-D Models .......................................................... C71 Structural Support FXV-D Models ........................................................ C74 Engineering Specifications ..................................................................... C75
FXV - C 54
FXV
General Description
FXV Closed Circuit Cooling Towers deliver fully rated thermal performance over a wide range of flow and temperature requirements. Standard design features satisfy todays environmental concerns, minimize installation costs, maximize year-round operating reliability, and simplify maintenance requirements.
Key Features
z
Low Energy Consumption Low installed cost Easy maintenance Application flexibility Reliable year-round operation Long service life
Baltimore Aircoil
FXV - C 55
FXV - C 56
Benefits
Low Energy Consumption
z
Evaporative Cooling Equipment minimizes the energy consumption of the entire system because it provides lower operating temperatures. The owner saves money while conserving natural resources and reducing environmental impact. FXV provides heat rejection at the lowest possible energy input and maintenance requirements via: - High efficiency, low kW axial fans - Closed loop cooling, which minimizes process fouling - Patented combined flow technology, which reduces evaporation directly off the coil, minimizing the potential for scaling and fouling - Parallel flow of air and spray water, which eliminates scale-promoting dry spots - Multiple Fan Motor System: independent fan motor and drive assembly per fan, which allows for extra steps of capacity control.
FXV
z z z z z
Easy Maintenance
Access - Hinged access doors provide easy access to the unit interior. In addition, all FXV models are provided with an internal walkway as standard. An internal walkway is available as an option on FXV-D models. Spacious Interior Provides easy access to the cold water basin, drift eliminators, fan drive system and heat transfer coil. Access to Spray Distribution Parallel flow of air and spray water over the coil allows for inspection and access to the top of the coil during full operation.
Baltimore Aircoil
FXV - C 57
Application Flexibility
z
Difficult thermal duties - The combined flow design is ideal for applications requiring a close approach and/or large range. Replacement applications Single air inlet models are designed to mount directly on existing support steel of both crossflow and counterflow units. Highest capacity in the industry FXV-D models offer the highest single cell capacity of any evaporative closed circuit cooling tower in the industry. Projects benefit from fewer required cells, lower overall fan kW, and fewer piping connections.
Belt Drive System utilizes special corrosion-resistant materials of construction and state-ofthe-art technology to ensure ease of maintenance and reliable year-round performance. Combined Inlet Shields prevent biological growth from sunlight, act as a filter for air borne impurities and debris and eliminate water splash out.
Materials of Construction Various materials are available to meet the corrosion resistance, unit operating life, and budgetary requirements of any project (See section "Technical Resources, Materials of Construction" for more details)
FXV - C 58
Construction Details
FXV Models
FXV
1. Heavy-Duty Construction
z Z600 hot-dip galvanized steel panels
6. BACross Wet Deck Surface with Integral Drift Eliminators (Not Shown)
z Plastic material z Impervious to rot, decay and biological attack z Designed and manufactured by BAC
overflow
PED
Baltimore Aircoil
FXV - C 59
FXV-D Models
1. Heavy-Duty Construction
z Heavy-gauge Z600 galvanized steel frame
PED
6. Coil Section
z Continuous serpentine, steel tubing z Hot-dip galvanized after fabrication (HDGAF) z Sloped tubes for free drainage of fluid
overflow
FXV - C 60
Standard Construction: Steel panels and structural elements are constructed of Z600 heavy-gauge hot-dip galvanized steel protected with the Baltiplus Corrosion Protection on the outside of the unit. Optional BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System: The BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System, a hybrid polymer coating used to extend equipment life, is applied to all hot-dip galvanized steel components of the unit. Optional Stainless Steel Construction: Steel panels and structural elements are constructed of stainless steel either type 304 or 316.
FXV
Note: Refer to section Technical Resources, Material Options for more details on the materials described above.
Baltimore Aircoil
FXV - C 61
FXV - C 62
Accessories
Basin Heaters
Units exposed to below freezing ambient temperatures require protection to prevent freezing of the water in the cold water basin when the unit is idle. Factory-installed heaters, which maintain the water temperature at 4C, are a simple and inexpensive way of providing such protection. The heater package includes the heaters, a thermostat and a low level cut out switch to protect the heaters if the water level is too low. Standard electric heaters are selected for -18C ambient temperature.
Model No. FXV FXV 422 FXV 423 FXV 424 FXV 432 FXV 433 FXV 442 FXV 443 FXV 444 FXV Q440 FXV Q441 FXV 542 FXV 543 FXV 544 FXV Q540 FXV Q541 FXV 561 FXV 562 FXV Q560 FXV Q561 FXV 642 FXV 643 FXV 644 FXV 661 FXV 662 FXV Q661 FXV D288 FXV D364 Heaters -18C (kW) 1 x4 1x4 1x4 1x6 1x6 1x6 1x6 1x6 1x6 1x6 1x8 1x8 1x8 1x8 1x8 2x6 2x6 2x6 2x6 2x6 2x6 2x6 2x8 2x8 2x8 2 x 14 2 x 14
FXV
Internal Ladder
For access to the motor and drive assemblies internal ladders are available on all models.
External Service Platform, Ladder and Safety Cage
Baltimore Aircoil
FXV - C 63
FXV - C 64
FXV
The FXVs innovative design results in a low heat loss when the unit is idle. When additional heat loss protection is desired, coil air intake hoods with factory mounted PCDs and damper actuators can be provided.
Mechanical Equipment Removal System
Baltimore Aircoil
FXV - C 65
1. Fluid in; 2. Fluid out; 3. Make-Up ND15; 4. Overflow ND80; 5. Drain ND50; 6. Access door; 7. Vent ND15.
Model No. FXV FXV 422-H FXV 422-J FXV 422-K FXV 423-J FXV 423-K FXV 432-J FXV 432-K FXV 432-L FXV 433-L FXV 442-K FXV 442-L FXV 442-M FXV 443-L FXV 443-M FXV 444-M FXV Q440-K FXV Q440-L FXV Q441-L
Operating Weight (kg) 3570 3590 3600 3800 3810 5240 5250 5260 5580 6640 6660 6670 7090 7100 7520 6640 6660 7510
Shipping Weight (kg) 2350 2370 2380 2520 2530 3370 3390 3410 3640 4150 4180 4190 4480 4490 4780 4150 4180 4770
Heaviest Section (kg) 1440 1450 1460 1600 1610 2140 2150 2160 2390 2590 2610 2620 2910 2920 3210 2590 2610 3200
Air Flow (m3/s) 12,5 14,3 15,7 13,9 15,3 20 22 25,1 24,5 25,5 29,2 32,1 28,5 31,4 30,7 25,5 29,1 27,9
Fan Motor (kW) 4 5,5 7,5 5,5 7,5 (2) 4 (2) 4 (2) 5,5 (2) 5,5 (2) 4 (2) 5,5 (2) 7,5 (2) 5,5 (2) 7,5 (2) 7,5 (2) 4 (2) 5,5 (2) 5,5
Spray Pump Inlet/Outlet Coil Volume Water Motor Coil Conn. (L) Flow (kW) (mm) (l/s) 12 12 12 12 12 18 18 18 18 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 1,1 1,1 1,1 1,1 1,1 2,2 2,2 2,2 2,2 2,2 2,2 2,2 2,2 2,2 2,2 2,2 2,2 2,2 (1x) 226 (1x) 226 (1x) 226 (1x) 278 (1x) 278 (1x) 337 (1x) 337 (1x) 337 (1x) 418 (1x) 452 (1x) 452 (1x) 452 (1x) 560 (1x) 560 (1x) 669 (1x) 452 (1x) 452 (1x) 669 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 150 (1x) ND 150 (1x) ND 150
H (mm) 3980 3980 3980 3980 3980 3980 3980 3980 3980 3980 3980 3980 3980 3980 3980 3980 3980 3980
L (mm) 1861 1861 1861 1861 1861 2775 2775 2775 2775 3690 3690 3690 3690 3690 3690 3690 3690 3690
W (mm) 2385 2385 2385 2385 2385 2385 2385 2385 2385 2385 2385 2385 2385 2385 2385 2385 2385 2385
FXV - C 66
FXV
1. Fluid in; 2. Fluid out; 3. Make-Up ND25; 4. Overflow ND80; 5. Drain ND50; 6. Access door; 7. Vent ND15.
Model No. FXV FXV 542-L FXV 542-M FXV 542-N FXV 543-M FXV 543-N FXV 543-O FXV 544-N FXV 544-O FXV Q540-M FXV Q540-O FXV Q541-N FXV Q541-O FXV 561-M FXV 561-N FXV 561-O FXV 562-M FXV 562-N FXV 562-O FXV Q560-L FXV Q560-O FXV Q561-L FXV Q561-O
Operating Weight (kg) 7960 7970 8000 8600 8620 8630 9250 9260 7970 8000 9250 9260 10650 10700 10710 11590 11640 11650 11580 11650 13470 13550
Shipping Weight (kg) 4960 4970 5000 5410 5440 5450 5880 5890 4970 5010 5880 5890 6430 6480 6490 7090 7140 7150 7070 7150 8420 8490
Heaviest Section (kg) 3240 3250 3270 3690 3710 3720 4150 4160 3250 3280 4150 4160 4020 4070 4090 4680 4730 4740 4670 4740 6010 6090
Air Flow (m3/s) 31,7 34,9 37,5 33,9 36,5 38,8 35,7 38,1 34,9 39,8 35,7 38,1 53,1 57,2 60,8 52,7 56,7 60,3 47,8 60,1 45,6 57,3
Fan Motor (kW) (2) 5,5 (2) 7,5 (2) 11 (2) 7,5 (2) 11 (2) 11 (2) 11 (2) 11 (2) 7,5 (2) 11 (2) 11 (2) 11 (3) 7,5 (3) 11 (3) 11 (3) 7,5 (3) 11 (3) 11 (3) 5,5 (3) 11 (3) 5,5 (3) 11
Pump Motor (kW) 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 5,5 5,5 5,5 5,5 5,5 5,5 5,5 5,5 5,5 5,5
Coil Volume (L) (1x) 671 (1x) 671 (1x) 671 (1x) 832 (1x) 832 (1x) 832 (1x) 993 (1x) 993 (1x) 671 (1x) 671 (1x) 993 (1x) 993 (1x) 762 (1x) 762 (1x) 762 (1x) 1007 (1x) 1007 (1x) 1007 (1x) 1007 (1x) 1007 (1x) 1562 (1x) 1562
Inlet/Outlet Coil Conn. (mm) (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 150 (1x) ND 150 (1x) ND 150 (1x) ND 150 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 150 (1x) ND 150 (1x) ND 150 (1x) ND 150
H (mm) 4790 4790 4790 4790 4790 4790 4790 4790 4790 4790 4790 4790 4930 4930 4930 4930 4930 4930 4930 4930 4930 4930
L (mm) 3690 3690 3690 3690 3690 3690 3690 3690 3690 3690 3690 3690 5520 5520 5520 5520 5520 5520 5520 5520 5520 5520
W (mm) 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985
Baltimore Aircoil
FXV - C 67
1. Fluid in; 2. Fluid out ND 3. Make-Up ND25; 4. Overflow ND80; 5. Drain ND50; 6. Access door; 7. Vent ND15.
Model No. FXV FXV 642-L FXV 642-M FXV 642-N FXV 643-M FXV 643-N FXV 643-O FXV 644-N FXV 644-O FXV 661-M FXV 661-N FXV 661-O FXV 662-M FXV 662-N FXV 662-O FXV Q661-M FXV Q661-N FXV Q661-O
Operating Weight (kg) 9070 9090 9110 9770 9800 9810 10470 10480 12260 12300 12320 13270 13310 13330 15310 15360 15370
Shipping Weight (kg) 5380 5400 5420 5880 5900 5910 6370 6380 7000 7050 7060 7710 7760 7770 9160 9210 9220
Heaviest Section (kg) 3490 3510 3530 3990 4010 4020 4480 4490 4360 4400 4420 5070 5110 5130 6510 6560 6570
Air Flow (m3/s) 36,1 39,7 42,8 38,4 41,3 43,9 40,5 43 61 65,5 70 60,1 64,7 68,7 56,9 61,3 65,1
Fan Motor (kW) (2) 5,5 (2) 7,5 (2) 11 (2) 7,5 (2) 11 (2) 11 (2) 11 (2) 11 (3) 7,5 (3) 11 (3) 11 (3) 7,5 (3) 11 (3) 11 (3) 7,5 (3) 11 (3) 11
Pump Motor (kW) 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 5,5 5,5 5,5 5,5 5,5 5,5 5,5 5,5 5,5
Coil Volume (L) (1x) 723 (1x) 723 (1x) 723 (1x) 896 (1x) 896 (1x) 896 (1x) 1069 (1x) 1069 (1x) 821 (1x) 821 (1x) 821 (1x) 1084 (1x) 1084 (1x) 1084 (1x) 1658 (1x) 1658 (1x) 1658
Inlet/Outlet Coil Conn. (mm) (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 100 (1x) ND 150 (1x) ND 150 (1x) ND 150
H (mm) 4790 4790 4790 4790 4790 4790 4790 4790 4930 4930 4930 4930 4930 4930 4930 4930 4930
L (mm) 3690 3690 3690 3690 3690 3690 3690 3690 5520 5520 5520 5520 5520 5520 5520 5520 5520
W (mm) 3610 3610 3610 3610 3610 3610 3610 3610 3610 3610 3610 3610 3610 3610 3610 3610 3610
General Notes
1. Operating weight is for the tower with the water level in the cold water basin at the overflow. 2. When the flow rate for FXV units exceeds 25 l/s the quantity of the coil connections will be double. When the flow rate for FXV-Q units exceeds 57 l/s, connections of ND200 will be used (1 x inlet; 1 x outlet). 3. Inlet and outlet connections are beveled for welding. 4. Standard make-up, drain and overflow connections are MPT. 5. Dimensional drawings show standard (right hand) arrangements. Left hand arrangements can be furnished by special order. 6. All FXV-models will be shipped in two sections: upper and lower section.
FXV - C 68
FXV
1. Intake Attenuator; 2. Discharge Attenuator.
Model No FXV FXV 42X FXV 43X FXV (Q)44X FXV (Q)54X FXV (Q)56X FXV 64X FXV (Q)66X
Dimensions (mm) D 1345 1345 1345 1500 1500 2005 2005 Ht 4715 4715 4715 5525 5665 5525 5665 Intake 100 130 175 250 375 250 375
Weight (kg) Discharge 140 210 255 270 385 310 440
Baltimore Aircoil
FXV - C 69
Heat Loss Data (kW) Model No. FXV FXV 422 FXV 423 FXV 424 FXV 432 FXV 433 FXV 442 FXV 443 FXV 444 FXV Q440 FXV Q441 FXV 542 FXV 543 FXV 544 FXV Q540 FXV Q541 FXV 561 FXV 562 FXV Q560 FXV Q561 FXV 642 FXV 643 FXV 644 FXV 661 FXV 662 FXV Q661 Standard Unit 25,6 30,9 35,9 38,5 46,4 50,7 61,0 70,7 50,7 70,7 71,1 86,0 99,9 71,1 99,9 82,9 105,8 105,8 147,6 76,2 91,8 106,4 89,3 113,6 157,4 Unit with Positive Closure Damper Hood 13,2 14,1 15,1 18,4 19,7 23,0 24,5 26,0 23,0 26,0 29,7 31,4 33,0 29,7 33,0 42,8 44,8 44,8 48,6 30,7 32,3 33,9 44,2 46,2 50,1 Weight (kg) 150 150 150 200 200 250 250 250 250 250 310 310 310 310 310 450 450 450 450 340 340 340 490 490 490
Positive Closure Damper Hood Length (L) (mm) 1815 1815 1815 2730 2730 3645 3645 3645 3645 3645 3645 3645 3645 3645 3645 5480 5480 5480 5480 3645 3645 3645 5480 5480 5480 Width (X) (mm) 1045 1045 1045 1045 1045 1045 1045 1045 1045 1045 1490 1490 1490 1490 1490 1490 1490 1490 1490 1615 1615 1615 1615 1615 1615 Height (Y) (mm) 835 835 835 835 835 835 835 835 835 835 835 835 835 835 835 835 835 835 835 835 835 835 835 835 835 Total Height (H) (mm) 4715 4715 4715 4715 4715 4715 4715 4715 4715 4715 5525 5525 5525 5525 5525 5665 5665 5665 5665 5525 5525 5525 5665 5665 5665
Notes:
1. Heat loss data based on 10C coil water and 14C with 20 m/s wind velocity (fans and pump off). 2. Positive closure dampers are available to reduce the heat loss during shut down. Consult your BAC Balticare representative for further details. 3. Electric immersion heaters with thermostat and low level cut out switch. All components are factory installed in the cooler pan. Heaters are selected to maintain +4C pan water at 18C ambient temperature. In outdoor locations trace heating and insulation of spray pump(s) (by others) may be required for freeze protection. 4. Hood weight excludes shipping skid weight.
FXV - C 70
FXV
Model FXV FXV 42X FXV 43X FXV (Q)44X FXV (Q)54X FXV 64X FXV (Q)56X FXV (Q)66X
Max. Deflection (mm) W 5 8 10 10 10 12 12 2385 2385 2385 2985 3610 2985 3610 L 1860 2775 3690 3690 3690 5520 5520
Dimensions (mm) A 2325 2325 2325 2925 3550 2925 3550 B 2440 2440 C 255 255 255 255 255 270 270
No of 16 mm Anchorbolts 4 4 4 4 4 8 8
Notes :
1. Support steel and anchor bolts to be designed and furnished by others. 2. All support steel must be level at the top. 3. Beams must be selected in accordance with accepted structural practice. Maximum deflection of beam under unit see table. 4. If vibration isolation rails are to be used between the unit and supporting steel, be certain to allow for the length of the vibration rails when determining the length of the supporting steel, as vibration rail length and mounting hole locations may differ from those of the unit. 5. If point vibration isolation is used with multi-cell units, the isolators must be located under the support steel, not between the support steel and the towers.
Baltimore Aircoil
FXV - C 71
1. Fluid out (see Note 2); 2. Fluid in (see Note 2); 3. Make-up ND40; 4. Overflow ND80; 5. Drain ND50; 6. Access Door
Max. Operating Weight (kg) 20355 22030 22030 23830 25805 25805
Max. Shipping Weight (kg) 12892 14150 14140 14715 16200 16200
Max. Heaviest Section (6) (kg) 3650 4280 4280 4260 5005 5005
Max. Air Flow (m3/s) 105,5 104,7 104,2 132,5 131,2 130,6
Spray Water Flow (l/s) 108,5 108,5 108,5 108,5 108,5 108,5
H (mm)
L (mm)
W (mm)
(2x) 1082 (2x) 1294 (2x) 1283 (2x) 1268 (2x) 1514 (2x) 1540
General Notes
1. Operating weight is for the tower with the water level in the cold water basin at the overflow. 2. The actual size and number of inlet and outlet connections may vary with the design flow rate. Consult unit print for dimensions. 3. Inlet and outlet connections are beveled for welding. 4. Standard make-up, drain and overflow connections are located on the bottom of the unit. 5. Models shipped with an optional gear drive may have heights up to 130 mm greater than shown. Models with fan motor up to 22 kW are belt driven only; models with motor between 22 kW and 45 kW have standard belt drive but gear drive as an option; models with 55 kW motor have gear drive only. 6. FXV-D Models will be shipped in four sections; 1 x lower, 1 x fan and 2 x coil section. Weight is shown for one coil section.
FXV - C 72
FXV
1. Inlet Attenuator; 2. Discharge Attenuator.
Weight (kg) Both Intake Sides 685 808 Discharge 477 563
Baltimore Aircoil
FXV - C 73
Heat Loss Data (kW) Model No. FXV FXV-D288-3 FXV-D288-4 FXV-D288-Q FXV-D364-3 FXV-D364-4 FXV-D364-Q Standard Unit 222,8 258,2 258,2 262,0 303,7 303,7 Unit with Positive Closure Damper Hood 81,1 86,3 86,3 96,8 101,5 101,5 Total Weight (kg) 470
Positive Closure Damper Hood Length (L) (mm) 3632 Width (X) (mm) 1915 Height (Y) (mm) 835 Total Height (H) (mm)
6272
545
4245
1915
835
6272
Notes:
1. Heat loss data based on 10C coil water and 14C with 20 m/s wind velocity (fans and pump off). 2. Positive closure dampers are available to reduce the heat loss during shut down. Consult your BAC Balticare representative for further details. 3. Electric immersion heaters with thermostat and low level cut out switch. All components are factory installed in the cooler pan. Heaters are selected to maintain +4C pan water at 18C ambient temperature. In outdoor locations trace heating and insulation of spray pump(s) (by others) may be required for freeze protection. 4. Hood weight excludes shipping skid weight. 5. Models shipped with optional gear drive may be higher.
FXV - C 74
FXV
No of 16 mm Anchorbolts 12 12
Notes:
1. The recommended support arrangement for the units consists of parallel I-beams extending the full length of the unit. Supports and anchor bolts are to be designed and furnished by others. 2. All supporting beams are to be flush and level at top and must be oriented relative to gage line as shown. 3. Recommended design loads for each unit support beam should be 70% of the total unit operating weight applied as a uniform load to each of the unit beams. Beams should be designed in accordance with standard structural practice. For the maximum allowable deflection of beams under the unit see table. 4. All mounting holes have a diameter of 22 mm at the locations shown. 5. If vibration isolators are used, a rail or channel must be provided between the unit (and optional attenuator) and the isolators to provide continuous unit support. Additionally the support beams must be designed to accommodate the overall length and mounting hole location of the isolators that may differ from those of the unit. Refer to vibration isolator drawings for these data.
Baltimore Aircoil
FXV - C 75
Engineering Specifications
1.0 Closed Circuit Cooling Tower
1.1 General: Furnish and install ____factory assembled closed circuit cooling tower(s) of induced draft design with single side air entry and vertical air discharge. Overall dimensions shall not exceed approximately ____ mm long x ____ mm wide, with an overall height not exceeding approximately _____ mm. Operating weight shall not exceed ____ kg. The closed circuit cooling tower(s) shall be Baltimore Aircoil Company Model(s)________________. (Alternate 1.1) General: Furnish and install ____factory assembled closed circuit cooling tower(s) of induced draft design with dual side air entry and vertical air discharge. Overall dimensions shall not exceed approximately ____ mm long x ____ mm wide, with an overall height not exceeding approximately _____ mm. Operating weight shall not exceed ____ kg. The closed circuit cooling tower(s) shall be Baltimore Aircoil Company Model(s)________________. 1.2. Thermal Capacity (water as heat transfer fluid): The closedcircuit cooling tower(s) shall be warranted by the manufacturer to cool ______l/s of _______ water from ____C to ____C at ____C entering wet-bulb temperature. (Alternate1.2.) Thermal Capacity (aqueous glycol solution as heat transfer fluid): The closed circuit cooling tower(s) shall be warranted by the manufacturer to cool ________l/s of _____% by volume ethylene/propylene glycol solution from ______C to _____C at _____C entering wet-bulb temperature. Coil pressure drop shall not exceed ________ kPa. 1.3. Corrosion Resistant Construction: Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all steel panels and structural members shall be constructed of heavy-gauge Z600 metric hot-dip galvanized steel, with all sheared edges given a protective coating of zinc-rich compound and the exterior protected with the Baltiplus Corrosion Protection. (Alternate1.3.) Corrosion Resistant Construction: Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all steel panels and structural members shall be protected with the BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System. The system shall consist of Z600 metric hot-dip galvanized steel prepared in a four-step (clean, pre-treat, rinse, and dry) process with an electrostatically sprayed, thermosetting hybrid polymer fuse-bonded to the substrate during a thermally activated curing stage and monitored by a 23-step quality assurance program. 1.4. Quality Assurance: The closed circuit cooling tower manufacturer shall have a management system certified by an accredited registrar as complying with the requirements of ISO9001:2000 to ensure consistent quality of its products and services. 1.5. Warranty: The manufacturers standard equipment warranty shall be for a period of not less than one year from date of startup or eighteen months from date of shipment, whichever occurs first.
FXV - C 76
FXV
7.0 Access
7.1 Plenum Access: A large, hinged access door shall be provided for access to the coil, drift eliminators and fan plenum section. The water make-up valve, float ball and suction strainer shall be easily accessible.
8.0 Sound
8.1 Sound Level: To maintain the quality of the local environment, the maximum sound pressure levels (dB) measured 15 m from the cooling tower operating at full fan speed shall not exceed the sound levels detailed below.
63
125
250
500
1000
2000
4000
8000
dB(A)
Baltimore Aircoil
WS - D 1
WS - D 2
General Information
Water saving and hybrid products provide cooling for many types of systems, and the specific application will largely determine which BAC product is best suited for a project. Water saving and hybrid products can be categorised within three different technologies. These are the hybrid wetdry, dry and adiabatic and the Product Line Overview Table indicates the BAC products available under each of these technologies. This overview table is intended as a general guide. Specialised assistance is available through your local BAC Balticare Representative. Refer to the section Advantages of water saving and hybrid wet-dry products for the advantages of each technology.
Overview
Principle of Operation
Water saving and hybrid products are usually of the closed circuit type where the heat load to be rejected is transferred from the process fluid (Fluid to be cooled) to the ambient air through a heat exchange coil. The coil serves to isolate the process fluid from the outside air, keeping it clean and contamination free in a closed loop. The Hybrid wet-dry products cool the liquid to be cooled by efficiently combining dry sensible air cooling with evaporative cooling. These products include two or more distinctive heat transfer surfaces or sections combined into one product optimising the use of the ambient dry and wet bulb temperature. Dry Fluid Coolers cool the liquid in a closed circuit by means of sensible heat transfer from the highdensity finned coil block to the air at ambient dry bulb temperature. Adiabatic Fluid Coolers are dry coolers equipped with an Adiabatic Pre-Cooler section. Before the air is drawn through the high density finned coil however, it is pre-cooled adiabatically as it passes through an evaporative pad where water is evaporated in the air.
Configuration
BAC manufactures two types of water saving and hybrid wet-dry products: combined flow and counterflow.
Combined Flow
Combined flow is the use of a prime surface and a dry finned heat exchange coil in combination with a wet deck surface for heat transfer in a hybrid wet-dry product. The addition of wet deck surface hybrid wet-dry product reduces evaporation in the coil section and is also used as an adiabatic pre-cooler section. BACs combined hybrid wet-dry products utilize parallel flow of air and spray water over the prime surface coil, counterflow of fluid and air in the dry finned coil and crossflow air/water flow through the wet deck surface. In parallel flow, air and water flow over the coil in the same direction. The process fluid travels from the bottom to the top of the coil, increasing efficiency by bringing the coldest spray water and air in contact with the process fluid at its coldest temperature.
Combined Flow: Parallel flow of air and water over the coil
Baltimore Aircoil
WS - D 3
Combined flow: Counterflow of air over the coil and fluid inside the coil.
Counterflow Configuration
Counterflow
In a counterflow water saving and hybrid wet-dry product, the flow of the air is in the opposite direction of the spray water or fluid inside the heat exchange coil. In BACs counterflow dry and adiabatic products, air travels vertically up through the coil while the fluid in the coil travels down.
Fan System
The flow of air through most factory assembled water saving hybrid wet-dry products is provided by one or more mechanically driven fans. The fan(s) may be axial or centrifugal, each type having its own distinct advantages. Centrifugal fan units are capable of overcoming reasonable amounts of external static pressure ( 125 Pa), making them suitable for both indoor and outdoor installations. Centrifugal fans are also inherently quieter than axial fans, although the difference can be overcome through the application of optional fan speed control, low sound fans and/or sound attenuation on axial fan units. Fans can be applied in an induced draft or a forced draft configuration.
Centrifugal Fans
Axial Fans
Induced Draft The rotating air handling components of induced draft equipment are mounted in the top deck of the unit, minimising the impact of fan noise on near-by neighbours. The air being drawn through the unit hereby discharges over the inducing fan. The use of corrosion resistant materials ensures long life and minimises maintenance requirements for the air handling components. Forced Draft Rotating air-handling components are located on the air inlet face at the base of forced draft towers whereby fresh air is blown through the unit. This base fan position facilitates easy access for routine maintenance and service. Additionally, location of these components in the dry entering air stream extends component life by isolating them from the corrosive saturated discharge air when units operate in evaporative mode.
WS - D 4
Capacity Range
In the Product Line Overview Table, product capacities are called out in terms of a fluid flow rate for hybrid wet-dry products and nominal kW of heat rejection capacity for dry and adiabatic products. All capacities shown are for a single cell; multiple cell units can be applied to achieve larger capacities.
Overview
All BAC hybrid wet-dry products are capable of withstanding entering fluid temperatures as high as 82C. All BAC dry and adiabatic products are capable to withstanding entering fluid temperatures as high as 70C.
Typical Applications
A list of typical applications is provided in the Product Line Overview Table for your reference.
Principle of Operation
Technology
Hybrid Wet-Dry closed circuit cooling tower combining sensi- Hybrid Wet-Dry closed circuit cooling tower combining sensible and evaporative heat transfer ble and evaporative heat transfer. Combined Flow Axial Fan, Induced Draft 45 to 150 l/s Counterflow Centrifugal Fan, Forced Draft 9 to 90 l/s
Configuration Fan System Capacity Range (Single Cell) Maximum Entering Fluid Temperature
82C Medium to large HVAC & industrial applications Installations requiring plume abatement Installation requiring water conservation Low energy consumption Easy maintenance
82C Medium to large HVAC & industrial applications Installations requiring plume abatement Installation requiring water conservation Sound sensitive locations Indoor Installations
Typical Applications
1. Air in; 2. Air out; 3. Fluid in; 4. Fluid out; 5. Water, 6.Combined Inlet Shields; 7. Wet deck surface; 8. Cold water basin; 9. Water distribution system; 10. Spray water pump; 11. Coil; 12. Finned coil; 13. Three way valve.
Baltimore Aircoil
WS - D 5
Dry Fluid Coolers equipped with an Adiabatic Pre-Cooler cool the liquid by Dry Fluid Coolers cool the liquid in a closed circuit by means of sensible heat sensible heat transfer only. Before the air is drawn through the high density transfer from the high-density finned coil block to the air at ambient dry bulb finned coil however, it is pre-cooled adiabatically as it passes through an temperature. evaporative pad where water is evaporated in the air. Counterflow Axial Fan, Induced Draft Counterflow Axial Fan, Induced Draft
250 kW 1620 kW at Eurovent Conditions according to EN 1048. 30 kW 1110 kW at Eurovent Conditions according to EN 1048. 1,5 80 l/s 34% Ethylene Glycol Solution at 40 oC / 35 oC / 25 oC dry bulb 13 86 l/s 34% Ethylene Glycol Solution at 40 oC / 35 oC / 25 oC dry bulb temperature temperature 70 oC High temperature execution available, max. 150 oC, max. 10 bar pressure Small to medium HVAC and industrial applications Locations with limited water availability Large range, large approach applications High temperature industrial applications 70 oC
Small to medium HVAC and industrial applications Locations with limited water and limited space availability High temperature industrial applications
1. Dry heat exchanger coil; 2. Fluid Inlet. 3. Fluid Outlet; 4. Axial Fans; 5. High efficient evaporative cooling pad; 6. Water inlet connections; 7. Water outlet connections; 8. Adiabatic cooling of ambient air; 9. Air discharge; 10. Air in.
WS - D 6
Overview
In many European countries water has become an expensive commodity and hence the cost of water often represents a significant portion of the total annual operating cost of conventional evaporative cooling equipment. To significantly reduce operating cost, BAC can offer a variety of intelligent water saving solutions. These solutions include air-cooled products with no water consumption at all, adiabatic coolers and wet-dry hybrid coolers, which consume only water when needed and as much as needed. The broad array of water saving products allows to optimise a choice for each application, including the ones where low cooling temperatures need to be achieved during a hot summer day. The cost premium associated with water saving products is usually offset in short time by the operating cost savings that can be achieved.
Engineering Considerations
Location
Units must have an adequate supply of fresh air to the air inlet(s). When units are located adjacent to building walls or in enclosures, care must be taken to ensure that the warm, saturated discharge air is not deflected off surrounding walls or enclosures and drawn back to the air inlet(s).
Warning: Each unit should be located and positioned to prevent the introduction of the warm discharge air and the associated drift (hybrid and adiabatic products), which may contain chemical or biological contaminants including Legionella, into the ventilation systems of the building on which the unit is located or those of adjacent buildings.
Note: For detailed recommendations on layout, please consult your local BAC Balticare Representative.
For HFL products, bottom screens or solid bottom panels may be desirable or necessary for safety, depending on the location and conditions at the installation site.
Baltimore Aircoil
WS - D 7
Although equalizing lines can be used to balance water levels between multi-cell hybrid wet-dry products, the spray water for each cell must be treated separately, and a separate make-up must be provided for each cell. Note that a common remote sump for multi-cell installations can simplify make-up and water treatment see "Technical Resources, Remote Sump Tank Selection" for details. See the appropriate Operating and Maintenance Instruction Manual for more information on water treatment.
Capacity Control
Variable Frequency Drives (VFD) Installations which are to be controlled by Variable Frequency Drives (VFD) require the use of an inverter duty motor as designed IEC 34.1, which recognizes the increased stresses placed on motors by these drive systems. Inverter duty motors must be furnished on VFD applications in order to maintain the motor warranty. Fan motors must be furnished with thermal protection (either PTC sensors or coil thermostats normally open, or normally closed). The motor protection consists of temperature sensitive cutout devices embedded in the motor windings (minimum 3 per motor).
Warning: When the fan speed is to be changed from the factory-set speed, including through the use of a variable speed control device, steps must be taken to avoid operating at or near fan speeds that cause a resonance with the unit or its supporting structure. At start-up, the variable frequency drive should be cycled slowly between zero and full speed and any speeds that cause a noticeable resonance in the unit should be locked out by the variable speed drive.
Fan Cycling Fan cycling is the simplest method of capacity control. The number of steps of capacity control can be increased using the Baltiguard Fan System, the independent fan motor option, or two-speed fan motors in conjunction with fan cycling (see the Custom Features & Options section of the appropriate product line to determine whether the Baltiguard Fan System or the independent fan motor option are available; two-speed motors are available for all products). These options provide substantial energy savings when compared to simple fan cycling.
Warning: Rapid on-off cycling can cause the fan motor to overheat. It is recommended that controls be set to allow a maximum of 6 on-off cycles per hour. Note: Spray water pump cycling should not be used for capacity control. This method of control often results in short cycling of the pump motor as capacity changes substantially with pump cycling. In addition, alternate wetting and drying of the coil promotes scaling of the heat exchanger coil surface.
Capacity Control Dampers (HFL models only) On centrifugal fan models, modulating capacity control dampers are available to provide close control of the leaving temperature. See Section "Accessories" or contact your local BAC Balticare representative.
WS - D 8
Overview
As water evaporates in the unit, the dissolved solids originally present in the water remain in the system. The concentration of these dissolved solids increases rapidly and can cause scale and corrosion. In addition, airborne impurities and biological contaminants, including Legionella, may be introduced into the circulating water. To control all potential contaminants, a water treatment program must be employed. In many cases, a simple bleed-off may be adequate for control of scale and corrosion. However, biological contamination, including Legionella, can be controlled only through the use of biocides. Such treatment should be initiated at system startup, after periods of equipment shutdown, and continued regularly thereafter. Accordingly, it is strongly recommended a biocide treatment be initiated when the unit is first filled with water and continued regularly thereafter. For more information, consult the appropriate Operating and Maintenance Manual. When a water treatment program is employed, it must be compatible with construction materials. Batch feeding of chemicals into the unit is not recommended. If units are constructed with optional corrosion resistant materials, acid treatment may be considered; however, the water quality must be maintained within the guidelines set forth in the Operating and Maintenance Instructions.
Note: Unless a common remote sump is utilised, each cell of a multi-cell installation must be treated as a separate entity, even if the cold water basins are equalised.
For complete Water Quality Guidelines, see the appropriate Operating and Maintenance Instruction Manual, available at www.baltimoreaircoil.com. For specific recommendations on water treatment, contact a competent water treatment supplier.
Sound Levels
Sound rating data are available for all BAC models. When calculating the sound levels generated by a unit, the designer must take into account the effects of the geometry of the tower as well as the distance and direction from the unit to noise-sensitive areas. Whisper Quiet fans and intake and discharge sound attenuation can be supplied on certain models to provide reduced sound characteristics (see the Custom Features and Options section of the appropriate product line for details). The Baltiguard Fan System, two-speed motors, or variable frequency drives can also be used to reduce sound during periods of non-peak thermal loads. For more information on sound and how it relates to evaporative cooling equipment, see Section "Technical Resources, Fundamentals of Sound". Dry and adiabatic fluid coolers for sound sensitive applications are offered with low speed motors. For detailed low sound selections, please consult your local BAC Balticare Representative.
Baltimore Aircoil
WS - D 9
Note: Axial fan units are not suitable for indoor installations.
Safety
Adequate precautions, appropriate for the installation and location of these products, should be taken to safeguard the public from possible injury and the equipment and the premises from damage. Operation, maintenance and repair of this equipment should be undertaken only by personnel qualified to do so. Proper care, procedures and tools must be used in handling, lifting, installing, operating, maintaining, and repairing this equipment to prevent personal injury and/or property damage.
Fluid Compatibility
The fluid to be cooled must be compatible with the coil material. Fluids not compatible with coil materials can lead to corrosion and tube failure. Certain fluids may require occasional pressure cleaning or mechanical cleaning of the inside of coil tubes. In such cases the coil must be designed to provide this capability. Refer to the appropriate product line section for details of the available coil material.
WS - D 10
Overview
Warranties
Please refer to the Limitation of Warranties applicable to and in effect at the time of the sale/ purchase of these products.
Baltimore Aircoil
HXI - D 11
Product Detail
HXI Hybrid Closed Circuit Cooling Towers ........................................ D12 Benefits ..................................................................................................... D14 Construction Details ................................................................................ D16 Custom Features and Options ................................................................ D18 Accessories ............................................................................................... D21 Engineering Data ..................................................................................... D23 Structural Support .................................................................................. D31 Engineering Specifications ..................................................................... D32 HXI offers Economic Advantages .......................................................... D34
HXI - D 12
General Description
HXI Closed Circuit Hybrid Cooling Towers deliver fully rated thermal performance over a wide range of flow and temperature requirements. Distinct advantages of the HXI include plume abatement, significant water savings over traditional water-cooled equipment. Standard design features satisfy todays environmental concerns, minimize installation costs, maximize year-round operating reliability, and simplify maintenance requirements.
Key Features
Plume abatement Maximum water savings Low energy consumption Low installed cost Easy maintenance Reliable year-round operation Long service life
Baltimore Aircoil
HXI - D 13
HXI - D 14
Benefits
Plume Abatement
The HXI offers a combination of sensible, adiabatic, and evaporative heat transfer to significantly reduce any plume that may occur with conventional evaporative cooling equipment. During the coldest times of the year, when the potential for visible discharge is greatest, the HXI operates 100% dry, completely eliminating plume.
Baltimore Aircoil
HXI - D 15
Easy Maintenance
Access Hinged access doors on each end wall and a standard internal walkway provide easy access to the unit interior. Spacious Interior Provides easy access to the cold water basin, drift eliminators, fan drive system and the prime surface coil. Access to spray Distribution Parallel flow of air and spray water over the coil allows for inspection and access to the top of the coil during full operation.
HXI - D 16
Construction Details
Baltimore Aircoil
HXI - D 17
1. Heavy-Duty Construction
Z600 hot-dip galvanized steel panels
Impervious to rot, decay and biological attack Designed and manufactured by BAC
7. BACross Wet Deck Surface with Integral Drift Eliminators (Not Shown)
Plastic material
HXI - D 18
Finned Coil
Baltimore Aircoil
HXI - D 19
The low sound fan drive system provides the cooling air necessary to reject heat from the system to the atmosphere. The standard fan drive system consists of an independent fan motor and drive assembly per fan with a plenum partition to allow independent operation of each fan. This standard feature provides an extra step of capacity control.
HXI - D 20
Baltimore Aircoil
HXI - D 21
Accessories
Basin Heaters
Although most HXI units will operate dry in the winter, basin heaters are available for freeze protection when required. Basin heaters prevent freezing of the water in the cold water basin when the unit is idle. Factory-installed heaters, which maintain the water temperature at 4C, are a simple and inexpensive way of providing such protection.
Model No. HXI HXI 42X-K HXI 43X-L HXI 44X-M HXI (Q)54X-O HXI (Q)56X-O HXI (Q)64X-O HXI (Q)66X-O Electric Immersion Heaters -18C kW 1x4 1x6 1x6 1x8 2x6 2x6 2x8
HXI - D 22
Internal Ladder
For access to the motor and drive assemblies internal ladders are available on all models.
Baltimore Aircoil
HXI - D 23
Engineering Data
REMARK: Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
1. Inlet Connection; 2. Outlet Connection, 3. Make Up ND15, 4. Overflow ND80; 5. Drain ND50; 6. Access door.
Model No. HXI 420-K 421-K 422-K 430-L 431-L 432-L 440-M 441-M 442-M
Shipping Weight (kg) 2570 2710 2850 3700 3910 4130 4520 4800 5090
Operating Weight (kg) 3810 4020 4230 5560 5870 6190 7010 7420 7850
Heaviest Section (kg) 1110 1260 1400 1660 1870 2090 1960 2240 2530
Airflow (m/s)
Fan Motor (kW) (1) 7,5 (1) 7,5 (1) 7,5 (2) 5,5 (2) 5,5 (2) 5,5 (2) 7,5 (2) 7,5 (2) 7,5
Pump (kW)
Inlet / Outlet Coil Connections (mm) Prime Surface Coil (1) 100 (1) 100 (1) 100 (1) 100 (1) 100 (1) 100 (1) 100 (1) 100 (1) 100 Finned Coil (2) 80 (2) 80 (2) 80 (2) 80 (2) 80 (2) 80 (2) 80 (2) 80 (2) 80
H (mm)
L (mm)
W (mm)
(1) 1,1 (1) 1,1 (1) 1,1 (1) 2,2 (1) 2,2 (1) 2,2 (1) 2,2 (1) 2,2 (1) 2,2
HXI - D 24
1. Inlet Connection; 2. Outlet Connection; 3. Make Up ND25; 4. Overflow ND80; 5. Drain ND50; 6. Access door.
Approx. Ship Weight (kg) 5700 6140 6580 6580 7460 8220 8880 9540 9540 10880
Approx. Operating Weight (kg) 8690 9310 9930 9930 11180 12695 13635 14575 14575 16475
Approx. Heaviest Section (kg) 2400 2840 3280 3280 4160 3360 4090 4740 4740 6090
Airflow (m/s)
Fan Motor (kW) (2) 11 (2) 11 (2) 11 (2) 11 (2) 11 (3) 11 (3) 11 (3) 11 (3) 11 (3) 11
Pump (kW)
Inlet/Outlet Coil Connections (mm) Prime surface coil (2) 100 (2) 100 (2) 100 (1) 150 (1) 150 (2) 100 (2) 100 (2) 100 (1) 150 (1) 150 Finned coil (2) 80 (2) 80 (2) 80 (2) 80 (2) 80 (2) 100 (2) 100 (2) 100 (2) 100 (2) 100
H (mm)
L (mm)
W (mm)
540-O 541-O 542-O Q540-O Q541-O 560-O 561-O 562-O Q560-O Q561-O
35,5 35,1 34,9 34,9 34,6 53,6 53,1 52,7 52,7 52,3
(1) 4,0 (1) 4,0 (1) 4,0 (1) 4,0 (1) 4,0 (1) 5,5 (1) 5,5 (1) 5,5 (1) 5,5 (1) 5,5
6580 6580 6580 6580 6580 6785 6785 6785 6785 6785
3690 3690 3690 3690 3690 5520 5520 5520 5520 5520
2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985
Baltimore Aircoil
HXI - D 25
1. Inlet Connection; 2. Outlet Connection; 3. Make Up ND25; 4. Overflow ND80; 5. Drain ND50; 6. Access door.
Approx. Ship Model No. Weight HXI (kg) 640-O 641-O 642-O Q640-O Q641-O 660-O 661-O 662-O Q660-O Q661-O 6330 6810 7290 7290 8240 9085 9795 10505 10505 11955
Approx. Operating Weight (kg) 10050 10740 11430 11430 12790 14690 15700 16710 16710 18750
Approx. Heaviest Section (kg) 2575 3055 3535 3540 4480 3710 4420 5130 5130 6570
Airflow (m/s)
Pump (kW)
Inlet/Outlet Coil Connections (mm) Prime Surface Coil (2) 100 (2) 100 (2) 100 (1) 150 (1) 150 (2) 100 (2) 100 (2) 100 (1) 150 (1) 150 H (mm) Finned Coil (2) 100 (2) 100 (2) 100 (2) 100 (2) 100 (2) 100 (2) 100 (2) 100 (2) 100 (2) 100 6785 6785 6785 6785 6785 6925 6925 6925 6925 6925 3690 3690 3690 3690 3690 5520 5520 5520 5520 5520 3610 3610 3610 3610 3610 3610 3610 3610 3610 3610 L (mm) W (mm)
39,9 39,2 38,7 38,7 37,8 60,5 59,5 58,6 58,6 57,4
(2) 22 (2) 22 (2) 22 (2) 22 (2) 22 (3) 11 (3) 11 (3) 11 (3) 11 (3) 11
(1) 4,0 (1) 4,0 (1) 4,0 (1) 4,0 (1) 4,0 (1) 5,5 (1) 5,5 (1) 5,5 (1) 5,5 (1) 5,5
HXI - D 26
Serpentine Arrangement
Note: Only available on the finned coi.
Description:
The finned coil on the HXI unit has 6 rows. The serpentine indicates the way in which these rows are circuited internally. The serpentine influences the process fluid velocity (the smaller the serpentine, the higher the flow) and the total pressure drop over the unit ( the smaller the serpentine, the higher the finned coil pressure drop). Hence, the unit flow and pressure drop must be taken into account when the finned coil serpentine is selected to obtain the most suitable HXI selection.
Nomenclature:
Affix 3/4 serpentine 1/1 serpentine 1-1/2 serpentine Double Serpentine A B C D Example HXI 420-K A HXI 420-K B HXI 420-K C HXI 540-O D
Double Serpentine
General Notes
1. Pipe sizes are nominal diameters. All connections have BSP male thread except for the 15 mm vent which has female BSP thread. 2. Dimensional drawings show standard (right hand) arrangements with the standard finned coil arrangement. Left hand arrangement can be furnished by special order. 3. Coil connection locations are approximate. Dimensions should not be used for prefabrication of the connecting piping. 4. For high process flows, the double serpentine finned coil arrangement (HXI D) might be used. For a finned coil bundle with a double serpentine arrangement, the coil inlet connections will be on one side and the outlet on the opposite side. (Refer to serpentine arrangements) 5. All technical information on this page is without manifolds and three-way valve arrangement. (refer to the section "Accessories, Flow control package) 6. The units will be delivered in 3 different pieces, upper, middle and lower section. 7. For HXI Q-5XX and HXI Q-6XX units with single bare coil connections, the connection centreline is located 820 mm from the air inlet face.
Baltimore Aircoil
HXI - D 27
Sound Attenuation
Model No. HXI HXI 42X HXI 43X HXI 44X HXI (Q) 54X HXI (Q) 56X HXI (Q)64X HXI (Q)66X
Weight Sound Attenuator (kg) 100 130 175 150 375 250 375
Modes of Operation
Operation Mode Dry-Wet Mode Adiabatic Mode Dry Mode Dry Finned Coil Fluid Flow 100 % 100 % 100 % Wet Prime Surface Coil Fluid Flow Modulating 0% 100 % Spray Pump ON ON OFF Fans ON ON ON*
HXI - D 28
Water Consumption
1. Water Distribution System; 2. Air In; 3. Air Out; 4. Prime Surface Coil; 5. Wet Deck Surface; 6. Finned Coil; 7. Spray Pump; 8. Sump; 9. Axial Fan.
Adiabatic Mode
The adiabatic mode occurs when the fluid to be cooled completely bypasses the evaporative prime surface coil. No heat is rejected from this coil and the recirculating spray water merely serves to saturate and adiabatically pre-cool the incoming outside air. In most climates, the ambient air still has considerable potential for absorbing moisture. Thus adiabatic cooling of the incoming air results in significantly lower air temperatures, which greatly increases the rate of sensible heat transfer. Compared to conventional evaporative cooling equipment, visible plume and water consumption are greatly reduced while maintaining the low fluid design temperatures required to maximize system efficiency.
Water Consumption
1. Water Distribution System; 2. Air In; 3. Air Out; 4. Prime Surface Coil; 5. Wet Deck Surface; 6. Finned Coil; 7. Spray Pump; 8. Sump; 9. Axial Fan.
Baltimore Aircoil
HXI - D 29
Dry Mode
During the dry operation mode the spray water system is turned off, saving on pump energy. The fluid to be cooled is fed from the finned coil to the prime surface coil. The modulating flow control valve remains fully open to ensure both coils receive the full fluid flow in series; hence the maximum heat transfer surface is available. In this mode no water consumption occurs, and plume is completely eliminated. HXI units can be economically selected for dry bulb switchover points of 10C to 15C or higher, depending on the specific needs of the project. When the equipment operates in the dry mode for prolonged periods, draining the cold water basin is recommended, eliminating the need for freeze protection and water treatment.
Water Consumption
1. Water Distribution System; 2. Air In; 3. Air Out; 4. Prime Surface Coil; 5. Wet Deck Surface; 6. Finned Coil; 7. Spray Pump; 8. Sump; 9. Axial Fan.
HXI - D 30
Winter Operation
Hybrid Evaporative Fluid Cooler coil(s) must be protected from damage by freezing of the fluid inside the coil(s) when exposed to subfreezing conditions. Freeze protection can be obtained by the use of ethylene or propylene glycol or other anti-freeze solutions in appropriate concentrations. If no anti-freeze solution can be used, refer to the heat loss data hereunder and to the section Winter Operation of the HXI operating and maintenance instructions bulletin M290.
HXI Model N 420-K 421-K 422-K 430-L 431-L 432-L 440-M 441-M 442-M 540-O 541-O 542-O Q540-O Q541-O 560-O 561-O 562-O Q560-O Q561-O 640-O 641-O 642-O Q640-O Q641-O 660-O 661-O 662-O Q660-O Q661-O
Heatloss Data (kW) (1) Standard Unit 85 90 95 127 135 143 167 178 189 210 225 240 240 270 318 340 365 365 415 250 265 282 282 315 374 397 421 421 468
Coil Volumes Prime Surface Coil (l) 122 174 226 175 256 337 236 344 452 349 510 671 716 1038 517 762 1052 1542 1562 377 550 723 771 1117 558 821 1084 1132 1658 Finned Coil (l) 150 150 150 214 214 214 277 277 277 349 349 349 349 349 533 533 533 533 533 450 450 450 450 450 644 644 644 644 644
Pan Volume Operating Level (mm) 556 556 556 847 847 847 1137 1137 1137 685 685 685 685 685 1036 1036 1036 1036 1036 785 785 785 785 785 1187 1187 1187 1187 1187
Notes:
1. Heat loss data, based on 10C coil water and -14C with 20 m/s wind velocity (fans and pump off). 2. Electric immersion heaters with thermostat and low level cut out. All components are factory installed in the cooler pan. Heaters are selected to maintain +4C pan water at -18C ambient temperature. In outdoor locations trace heating and insulation of spray pump(s) (by others) may be required for freeze protection. See section "Accessories" for more information on Basin Heaters.
Baltimore Aircoil
HXI - D 31
Structural Support
REMARK: Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
The recommended support arrangement for units consists of parallel I-beams running the full length of the unit, spaced as shown in the following drawing. Besides providing adequate support, the steel also serves to raise the unit above any solid foundation to ensure access to the bottom of the unit. To support units in an alternate steel support arrangement, consult your BAC Balticare Representative.
Model HXI / HXIQ 42X 43X 44X (Q) 54X (Q)-56X (Q)64X (Q)66X
Dimensions (mm) W 2385 2385 2385 2985 2985 3610 3610 L 1860 2775 3690 3690 5520 3690 5520 A 2325 2325 2325 2925 2925 3550 3550 B 2440 2440 C 255 255 255 255 270 255 270
N of 16mm Anchorbolts 4 4 4 4 8 4 8
Notes :
1. Support steel and anchor bolts to be designed and furnished by others. 2. All support steel must be level at the top. 3. Beams must be selected in accordance with accepted structural practice. Maximum deflection of beam under unit see table. 4. If vibration isolation rails are to be used between the unit and supporting steel, be certain to allow for the length of the vibration rails when determining the length of the supporting steel, as vibration rail length and mounting hole locations may differ from those of the unit. 5. If point vibration isolation is used with multi-cell units, the isolators must be located under the support steel, not between the support steel and the towers.
HXI - D 32
Engineering Specifications
1.0 Closed Circuit Hybrid Cooling Tower
1.1 General: Furnish and install _____ factory-assembled, induceddraft, axial fan, closed circuit hybrid cooling tower(s) with vertical air discharge, conforming in all aspects to the specifications, schedules and as shown on the plans. The unit shall be able to operate in combined dry/wet, adiabatic and dry modes for plume abatement and minimum water consumption. Overall dimensions shall not exceed approximately _____ mm long x ______ mm wide x _____ mm high. Operating weight shall not exceed ________kg. The closed circuit hybrid cooling tower(s) shall be Baltimore Aircoil Model ____________. 1.2 Thermal Capacity: The closed circuit hybrid cooling tower(s) shall be warranted by the manufacturer to cool _____ l/s of ________% by volume aqueous ethylene/propylene glycol solution (water) from ______ C to _____C at _____C entering wet-bulb temperature and from ________C to _________C at _________C entering dry bulb temperature. Total coil pressure drop shall not exceed __________kPa. 1.3 Corrosion Resistant Construction (standard): Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all steel panels and structural members shall be constructed of heavy-gauge Z600 metric hot-dip galvanized steel with all edges given a protective coating of zinc-rich compound and the exterior protected with the BALTIPLUS Corrosion Protection. (Alternate 1.3) Corrosion Resistant Construction (optional): Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all steel panels and structural members shall be protected with the BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System. The system shall consist of Z600 metric hot-dip galvanized steel prepared in a four-step (clean, pre-treat, rinse, dry) process with an electrostatically sprayed, thermosetting, hybrid polymer fuse-bonded to the substrate during a thermally activated curing stage and monitored by a 23-step quality assurance program. 1.4 Quality Assurance: The cooling tower manufacturer shall have a Management System certified by an accredited registrar as complying with the requirements of ISO-9001:2000 to ensure consistent quality of products and services. 1.5 Warranty: The manufacturers standard equipment warranty shall be for a period of not less than one year from date of startup or eighteen months from date of shipment, whichever occurs first.
Baltimore Aircoil
HXI - D 33
6.0 Access
6.1. Plenum Access: A large, hinged access door shall be provided on each end wall for access to the prime surface coil, drift eliminators, and fan plenum section. The water make-up valve, float ball, and suction strainer shall be easily accessible.
7.0 Sound
6.1 Sound Level: To maintain the quality of the local environment, the maximum sound pressure levels (dB) measured 15 m from the cooling tower operating at full fan speed shall not exceed the sound levels detailed below.
63
125
250
500
1000
2000
4000
8000
dB(A)
HXI - D 34
Typical annual distribution of ambient temperature with the three operating modes
Baltimore Aircoil
HFL - D 35
Product Detail
HFL Hybrid Closed Circuit Cooling Towers ........................................ D36 Benefits ..................................................................................................... D38 Construction Details ................................................................................ D40 Custom Features and Options ................................................................ D42 Accessories ............................................................................................... D44 Engineering Data ..................................................................................... D45 Structural Support .................................................................................. D55 Engineering Specifications ..................................................................... D57
HFL - D 36
General Description
The HFL combines the air cooled and evaporative technologies in one product providing the benefit of low cooling temperature and high process efficiency in the summer with the water saving advantage of air-cooled equipment in the winter. The HFL features a unique sump concept, which offers next to the principle of intelligent water saving an unprecedented level of operation flexibility. Additional features, such as compactness, ease of maintenance, low height, very low operating weight and effective suppression of plume, make this product your first choice for heat rejection applications.
Key Features
Effective suppression of plume Maximum water savings Operational flexibility Very low operating weight Ease of access and cleanability for superior maintenance Compactness
Baltimore Aircoil
HFL - D 37
HFL - D 38
Benefits
Effective Suppression of Plume
The finned coil(s) installed in the discharge air stream of the HFL Hybrid Closed Circuit Cooling Tower unit will raise the temperature and reduce the relative humidity of the discharge air. During wet operation this suppresses the formation of visible plume even when the relative humidity of the ambient air is high. Installation of the optional three-way valve flow control package will furthermore enhance the plume suppressing effect in that this control package ensures that at any atmospheric condition only as much evaporative cooling is applied as needed to satisfy the load requirement. Therefore the air leaving the wet portion of the equipment is dryer than is the case with conventional evaporative cooling equipment and has a much lower tendency to generate plume. The combination of finned discharge coil and three-way valve flow control package virtually eliminates the formation of visible plume even under extremely humid conditions. It is obvious that during the periods of dry operation no plume formation will occur.
Operational Flexibility
A critical aspect of hybrid products is the switch over from wet operation to dry operation and vice versa. In particular when during dry operation water remains in the sump, the potential danger of ice formation and subsequent damage exists in subfreezing conditions. To prevent this, manufacturers recommend draining the sump during the dry operation period. Depending on the ambient climatic conditions, sump draining may not be possible, because draining and refilling a sump requires at least several hours and hence cannot be conducted on a 24-hour cycle. To cope HFL units have been tested in subfreezing with this problem, installing a conventional conditions remote sump in a heated area inside the building is adequate, but adds complexity, costs and extra space. The HFL Hybrid Closed Circuit Cooling Tower has a unique sump design, which includes a wet and a dry sump. During dry operation all water will drain from the dry sump into the wet sump, which is shielded from the airstream. Heaters in the wet sump are sufficiently sized to prevent freezing at temperatures as low as -25C at full speed of the fan system. Both sumps are compactly integrated into the design of the B.A.C. HFL unit. It is for the first time that the operational flexibility and safety of a remote sump arrangement has been integrated into a factory-assembled product.
Baltimore Aircoil
HFL - D 39
Compactness
The HFL Hybrid Closed Circuit Cooling Tower has a compact design. The models have a low height and up to three fans are operated on a singe shaft with one electrical motor. Double cells can be arranged side by side with no intermediate space requirements, which allows making maximum use of the available floor space. Side by side arrangements are possible due to the fact that the access to the wet sump is at the rear end (connection end) of the equipment and that access to the dry sump only from one side is sufficient.
HFL - D 40
Construction Details
Three distinct changes in air direction to reduce drift loss significantly Assembled in easy to handle sections, which can be removed for access to the equipment interior
Baltimore Aircoil
HFL - D 41
6. Fan Motor
TEFC with IP 55 protection, class F insulation Sized for dry operation as standard Location in protected area beneath the fan housing
8. Access
Rectangular access door(s) at the connection end provide access to the wet sump, even if the fan system is running Rectangular access door(s) provided in the plenum section under the finned discharge coil, for easy access to the water distribution system Circular access door(s) at side(s) provide access to the air distribution plenum (dry sump)
HFL - D 42
Coil Configurations
Standard Serpentine Coil: The standard cooling coil is constructed of continuous lengths of all prime surface steel, hot-dip galvanized after fabrication (HDGAF). The coil is designed for low pressure drop with sloping tubes for free drainage of fluid. Each coil is pneumatically tested at 10 bar and PED certified Optional Stainless Steel Coil: Coils are available in Type 304 L and 316 L stainless steel for specialized applications. The Finned Discharge Coil coil is designed for low pressure drop with sloping tubes for free drainage of fluid. Stainless steel coils must be combined with the stainless steel material options or the Baltibond Corrosion Protection System Finned Discharge Coil (FDC): To enhance the water saving capability of wet-dry HFL units, finned discharge coils are added. These coils consist of copper tubes with corrugated aluminium plate fins, installed in a heavy gauge aluminium casing. All finned discharge coils have minimum four rows providing a significant heat exchange surface for dry operation.
Baltimore Aircoil
HFL - D 43
HFL units are fitted with an electric water level control to allow precise water level control. This package consists of a float switch mounted in the basin and a solenoid activated valve in the make-up water line. The valve is slow closing to minimize water hammer.
HFL - D 44
Accessories
Basin Heaters
HFL units exposed to below freezing ambient temperatures require protection to prevent freezing of the water in the wet sump. Factory-installed heaters, which maintain the water temperature at 4C, are a simple and inexpensive way of providing such protection. The heater package includes the heaters, a thermostat and a low level cut out switch to protect the heaters if the water level is too low. The standard electric heaters are selected for -20C ambient temperature.
Model Number HFL HFL 96 X & HFL 48 X HFL 72 X & HFL 96 X HFL 108 X & HFL 144 X HFL 150 X & HFL 192 X HFL 180 X & HFL 240 X HFL 216 X & HFL 288 X Heaters (-20C) (kW) 2x3 2x4 2x5 4x4 2x4+2x5 4x5
Discharge Hoods
Discharge hoods reduce the risk of re-circulation in tight enclosures by increasing discharge air velocity, and can be used to elevate the unit discharge above adjacent walls to comply with layout guidelines. They can also be fitted with positive closure dampers and damper actuators to minimize heat loss from convection air during idle conditions. Hoods and dampers create external static pressure and fan motors must be sized accordingly.
Capacity Control
To achieve maximum water saving it is recommended to run the fan system always at full speed. There may however be applications where capacity control by a change of fan speed is needed. In such cases several options are available: Two speed motors either as Dahlander or with separate windings Modulating fan damper controls, consisting of an aerofoil damper blade located in the discharge of each fan housing. The control package consists of a 24 Volt transformer, a damper motor actuator with end switches and a temperature controller. All components except the temperature controller are factory installed.
Baltimore Aircoil
HFL - D 45
Engineering Data
REMARK: Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
1. Access; 2. Make-up; 3. Electric Float Switch; 4. Overflow; 5. Drain; 6. Water Treatment Connection; 7.Bare Coil Fluid Inlet ND100; 8. Bare Coil Fluid Outlet ND100; 9. Vent; 10. FDC Fluid Inlet ND80; 11. FDC Fluid Outlet ND80; 12. Three-Way valve; 13. Orifice; 14. Terminal Box; 15. Operating Level; 16. Overflow Level.
Dimensions (mm) Model HFL Fan Pump Air- Spray- Ship. Oper. Heaviest Motor Motor flow flow Weight Weight Section (kW) (kW) (m/s) (l/s) (kg) (kg) (kg) 11 15 15 7,5 15 15 11 11 15 15 0,75 0,75 0,75 0,75 0,75 0,75 1,1 1,1 1,1 1,1 12,7 13,8 13,4 10,8 13,0 12,5 13,6 13,4 14,6 14,3 9 9 9 9 9 9 12,1 12,1 12,1 12,1 2025 2035 2305 2495 2565 2825 2730 3070 3080 3410 2680 2690 3010 3350 3420 3830 4170 4630 4640 5100 2025 2035 2305 2495 2565 2825 2730 3070 3080 3410 F 610 610 845 1080 1080 1315 845 1080 1080 1315 H 2175 2175 2410 2675 2675 2880 2410 2675 2675 2880 L 2730 2730 2730 2730 2730 2730 3650 3650 3650 3650 W 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250
FDC
3-Way Valve Arrangement Oper. Weight (kg) 120 120 120 120 120 120 300 300 300 300 Heaviest Section (kg) 70 70 70 70 70 70 130 130 130 130
Ship. Oper. Ship. Weight Weight Weight (kg) (kg) (kg) 250 250 250 250 250 250 315 315 315 315 315 315 315 315 315 315 400 400 400 400 80 80 80 80 80 80 190 190 190 190
HFL 361-L HFL 361-M HFL 362-M HFL 363-K HFL 363-M HFL 364-M HFL 482-L HFL 483-L HFL 483-M HFL 484-M
HFL - D 46
1. Access; 2. Make-up; 3. Electric Float Switch; 4. Overflow; 5. Drain; 6. Water Treatment Connection; 7.Bare Coil Fluid Inlet ND100; 8. Bare Coil Fluid Outlet ND100; 9. Vent; 10. FDC Fluid Inlet ND80; 11. FDC Fluid Outlet ND80; 12. Three-Way valve; 13. Orifice; 14. Terminal Box; 15. Operating Level; 16. Overflow Level.
Dimension (mm) Model HFL Fan Motor (kW) 18,5 22 11 22 22 30 18,5 22 30 22 30 30 Pump Air- Spray- Ship. Oper. Heaviest Motor flow flow Weight Weight Section (kW) (m/s) (l/s) (kg) (kg) (kg) 1,1 1,1 1,1 1,1 1,1 2,2 2,2 2,2 2,2 2,2 2,2 2,2 22,8 24,0 19,3 23,4 22,9 28,7 24,5 25,9 28,3 25,6 27,9 27,4 17,9 17,9 17,9 17,9 17,9 24,2 24,2 24,2 24,2 24,2 24,2 24,2 4000 4020 4510 4550 5090 4190 4700 4740 4840 5400 5500 6150 5495 5515 6225 6265 6935 5650 6400 6440 6540 7340 7440 8430 4000 4020 4510 4550 5090 4190 4700 4740 4840 5400 5500 6150 F 845 845 1080 1080 1315 610 845 845 845 1080 1080 1315 H 2410 2410 2675 2675 2880 2175 2410 2410 2410 2675 2675 2880 L 2730 2730 2730 2730 2730 3650 3650 3650 3650 3650 3650 3650 W 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400
FDC Ship. Weight (kg) 420 420 420 420 420 525 525 525 525 525 525 525
3-Way Valve Arrangement Heaviest Section (kg) 180 180 180 180 180 220 220 220 220 220 220 220
Oper. Ship. Oper. Weight Weight Weight (kg) (kg) (kg) 555 555 555 555 555 700 700 700 700 700 700 700 270 270 270 270 270 290 290 290 290 290 290 290 420 420 420 420 420 460 460 460 460 460 460 460
HFL 722-N HFL 722-O HFL 723-L HFL 723-O HFL 724-O HFL 961-P HFL 962-N HFL 962-O HFL 962-P HFL 963-O HFL 963-P HFL 964-P
Baltimore Aircoil
HFL - D 47
1. Access; 2. Make-up; 3. Electric Float Switch; 4. Overflow; 5. Drain; 6. Water Treatment Connection; 7.Bare Coil Fluid Inlet ND100; 8. Bare Coil Fluid Outlet ND100; 9. Vent; 10. FDC Fluid Inlet ND100; 11. FDC Fluid Outlet ND100; 12. Three-Way valve; 13. Orifice; 14. Terminal Box; 15. Operating Level; 16. Overflow Level.
Model HFL
Fan Pump Air- SprayShip. Motor Motor flow flow Weight (kW) (m/s) (l/s) (kg) (kW) 22 30 22 30 22 30 30 37 22 30 22 30 37 30 37 2,2 2,2 2,2 2,2 2,2 2,2 2,2 2,2 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 33,3 36,9 32,4 35,9 31,1 34,5 33,8 36,2 33,7 37,3 32,8 36,3 38,9 35,6 38,2 26,9 26,9 26,9 26,9 26,9 26,9 26,9 26,9 36,3 36,3 36,3 36,3 36,3 36,3 36,3 5310 5330 6050 6070 6840 6860 7660 7760 7220 7240 8170 8190 8290 9160 9260
Dimensions (mm) Oper. Heaviest Weight Section (kg) (kg) 7280 7300 8250 8270 9410 9430 10360 10460 10360 10380 11670 11690 11790 13130 13230 5310 5330 6050 6070 6840 6860 7660 7760 7220 7240 8170 8190 8290 9160 9260 F 610 610 845 845 1080 1080 1315 1315 845 845 1080 1080 1080 1315 1315 H 2175 2175 2410 2410 2675 2675 2880 2880 2410 2410 2675 2675 2675 2880 2880 L 2730 2730 2730 2730 2730 2730 2730 2730 3650 3650 3650 3650 3650 3650 3650 W 3605 3605 3605 3605 3605 3605 3605 3605 3605 3605 3605 3605 3605 3605 3605
FDC Ship. Weight (kg) 590 590 590 590 590 590 590 590 760 760 760 760 760 760 760
3-Way Valve Arrangement Heaviest Section (kg) 320 320 320 320 320 320 320 320 340 340 340 340 340 340 340
Oper. Ship. Oper. Weight Weight Weight (kg) (kg) (kg) 805 805 805 805 805 805 805 805 1055 1055 1055 1055 1055 1055 1055 430 430 430 430 430 430 430 430 510 510 510 510 510 510 510 670 670 670 670 670 670 670 670 890 890 890 890 890 890 890
HFL 1081-O HFL 1081-P HFL 1082-O HFL 1082-P HFL 1083-O HFL 1083-P HFL 1084-P HFL 1084-Q HFL 1442-O HFL 1442-P HFL 1443-O HFL 1443-P HFL 1443-Q HFL 1444-P HFL 1444-Q
HFL - D 48
Dimensions (mm) Model HFL Fan Motor (kW) Pump Motor (kW) Air- Spray- Ship. Oper. Heaviest flow flow Weight Weight Section (m/s) (l/s) (kg) (kg) (kg) 45,6 48,0 38,6 46,8 45,8 57,4 49,0 51,8 56,6 51,2 55,8 54,8 35,8 35,8 35,8 35,8 35,8 48,4 48,4 48,4 48,4 48,4 48,4 48,4 8000 8040 9020 9100 10180 8380 9400 9480 9680 10800 11000 12300 10990 11030 12450 12530 13870 11300 12800 12880 13080 14680 14880 16860 4000 4020 4510 4550 5090 4190 4700 4740 4840 5400 5500 6150 F 845 845 1080 1080 1315 610 845 845 845 1080 1080 1315 H 2410 2410 2675 2675 2880 2175 2410 2410 2410 2675 2675 2880 L 2730 2730 2730 2730 2730 3650 3650 3650 3650 3650 3650 3650 W 4840 4840 4840 4840 4840 4840 4840 4840 4840 4840 4840 4840
FDC
3-Way Valve Arrangement Oper. Heaviest Weight Section (kg) (kg) 840 840 840 840 840 920 920 920 920 920 920 920 180 180 180 180 180 220 220 220 220 220 220 220
Ship. Oper. Ship. Weight Weight Weight (kg) (kg) (kg) 840 840 840 840 840 1050 1050 1050 1050 1050 1050 1050 1110 1110 1110 1110 1110 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 1400 540 540 540 540 540 580 580 580 580 580 580 580
HFL 1502-N 18,5+18,5 1,1+1,1 HFL 1502-O 22+22 1,1+1,1 HFL 1503-L 11+11 1,1+1,1 HFL 1503-O 22+22 1,1+1,1 HFL 1504-O 22+22 1,1+1,1 HFL 1921-P 30+30 2,2+2,2 HFL 1922-N 18,5+18,5 2,2+2,2 HFL 1922-O 22+22 2,2+2,2 HFL 1922-P 30+30 2,2+2,2 HFL 1923-O 22+22 2,2+2,2 HFL 1923-P 30+30 2,2+2,2 HFL 1924-P 30+30 2,2+2,2
Baltimore Aircoil
HFL - D 49
Dimensions (mm) Model HFL Fan Motor (kW) Pump Motor (kW) Air- Spray- Ship. flow flow Weight (m/s) (l/s) (kg) Oper. Weight (kg) Heaviest Section (kg)
HFL 1801-P HFL 1802-O HFL 1802-P HFL 1803-P HFL 1804-Q HFL 2402-O HFL 2402-P HFL 2403-P HFL 2403-Q HFL 2404-Q
22+30 18,5+22 22+30 22+30 22+37 18,5+22 22+30 22+30 30+37 30+37
1,1+2,2 1,1+2,2 1,1+2,2 1,1+2,2 1,1+2,2 2,2+4 2,2+4 2,2+4 2,2+4 2,2+4
61,5 55,2 59,9 57,9 59,1 58,2 63,2 61,9 66,8 65,6
44,8 44,8 44,8 44,8 44,8 60,5 60,5 60,5 60,5 60,5
8790 10050 10090 11410 12850 11920 11980 13590 13790 15410
12075 13745 13785 15695 17395 16760 16820 19030 19230 21660
5330 6050 6070 6860 7760 7220 7240 8190 8290 9260
610 845 845 1080 1315 845 845 1080 1080 1315
2175 2410 2410 2675 2880 2410 2410 2675 2675 2880
2730 2730 2730 2730 2730 3650 3650 3650 3650 3650
6045 6045 6045 6045 6045 6045 6045 6045 6045 6045
1010 1010 1010 1010 1010 1285 1285 1285 1285 1285
HFL - D 50
Dimensions (mm) Model HFL Fan Motor (kW) 30+30 22+22 30+30 30+30 37+37 22+22 30+30 22+22 30+30 37+37 37+37 Pump Air- Spray- Ship. Oper. Heaviest Motor flow flow Weight Weight Section (kW) (m/s) (l/s) (kg) (kg) (kg) 2,2+2,2 2,2+2,2 2,2+2,2 2,2+2,2 2,2+2,2 4+4 4+4 4+4 4+4 4+4 4+4 73,8 64,7 71,7 69,0 72,4 67,3 74,6 65,5 72,6 77,9 76,3 53,8 53,8 53,8 53,8 53,8 72,6 72,6 72,6 72,6 72,6 72,6 10660 12100 12140 13720 15520 14440 14480 16340 16380 16580 18520 14600 16500 16540 18860 20920 20720 20760 23340 23380 23580 26460 5330 6050 6070 6860 7760 7220 7240 8170 8190 8290 9260 F 610 845 845 1080 1315 845 845 1080 1080 1080 1315 H 2175 2410 2410 2675 2880 2410 2410 2675 2675 2675 2880 L 2730 2730 2730 2730 2730 3650 3650 3650 3650 3650 3650 W 7250 7250 7250 7250 7250 7250 7250 7250 7250 7250 7250
FDC
Ship. Oper. Ship. Oper. Heaviest Weight Weight Weight Weight Section (kg) (kg) (kg) (kg) (kg) 1180 1180 1180 1180 1180 1520 1520 1520 1520 1520 1520 1610 1610 1610 1610 1610 2110 2110 2110 2110 2110 2110 860 860 860 860 860 1020 1020 1020 1020 1020 1020 1340 1340 1340 1340 1340 1780 1780 1780 1780 1780 1780 320 320 320 320 320 340 340 340 340 340 340
HFL 2161-P HFL 2162-O HFL 2162-P HFL 2163-P HFL 2164-Q HFL 2882-O HFL 2882-P HFL 2883-O HFL 2883-P HFL 2883-Q HFL 2884-Q
General Notes
1. All connections 150 mm and smaller are MPT. Connections 200 mm and larger are bevelled-for-welding. 2. Fan kW is for HFL units without FDC (0 Pa ESP.) and in wet operation. To operate against external static pressure up to 125 Pa, consult your local BAC Balticare representative for size and location. 3. Airflow is for HFL units without FDC. For air flow of units equipped with the FDC consult you local BAC Balticare Representative 4. Unit height is indicative, for precise value refer to certified print. 5. Shipping/operating weights indicated are for units without accessories such as sound attenuators, discharge hoods, etc. Consult factory certified prints to obtain weight additions and the heaviest section to be lifted. 6. The weights for the 3-way valve arrangement are the maximum weights.
Baltimore Aircoil
HFL - D 51
Sound Attenuation
HS and HD Sound Attenuation
1. Access; 2. FDC; 3. Discharge Attenuator; 4. Intake Attenuator HS, 5. Intake Attenuator HD; 6. Three-way valve arrangement.
VS Sound Attenuation
1. Access; 2. FDC; 3. Discharge Attenuator; 4. Intake Attenuator VS, 5. Intake Plenum VS; 6. Three-way valve arrangement.
HFL - D 52
HS attenuator Model HFL Solid Bottom + Intake (kg) 515 515 790 790 1065 1065 1580 1580 1855 1855 2130 2130 Discharge (kg) 255 315 420 510 590 715 840 1020 1010 1225 1180 1430 Total (kg) 770 830 1210 1300 1655 1780 2420 2600 2865 3080 3310 3560 Solid Bottom + Intake (kg) 710 710 1105 1105 1520 1520 2210 2210 2625 2625 3040 3040
HD attenuator Discharge (kg) 275 335 455 550 560 670 910 1100 1015 1220 1120 1340 Total (kg) 985 1045 1560 1655 2080 2190 3120 3310 3640 3845 4160 4380
VS attenuator Total (kg) 880 965 1330 1435 1830 1980 2660 2870 3160 3415 3660 3960
Dimensions "L" (mm) 2730 3650 2730 3650 2730 3650 2730 3650 2730 3650 2730 3650 "W" (mm) 1250 1250 2400 2400 3605 3605 4840 4840 6045 6045 7250 7250
HFL 36X-X HFL 48X-X HFL 72X-X HFL 96X-X HFL 108X-X HFL 144X-X HFL 150X-X HFL 192X-X HFL 180X-X HFL 240X-X HFL 216X-X HFL 288X-X
Baltimore Aircoil
HFL - D 53
The fluid to be cooled is fed to the HFL Hybrid Closed Circuit Cooling Tower. Through a water distribution system installed above the prime surface coil water is sprayed over the coil. From the coil the spray water drops into a plenum with a sloping bottom panel. The spray water is then drained to the wet sump, where it is collected and pumped to the water distribution system for another cycle. The sump is shielded from the air stream by a separation panel, which extends into a water lock. By means of the water lock the pressure difference between the equipment interior (elevated pressure) and the sump (atmospheric pressure) is equalised. The water lock is designed so that the fan(s) can be operated at any fan speed (and pressure) and maintain atmospheric pressure in the sump area. This way access to the sump is possible even if the fan system is in operation.
Dry Operation
During dry operation the spray water pump is shut off. The spray water drains into the wet sump. The sloping bottom of the plenum ensures complete drainage. In subfreezing conditions an electric sump heater located underneath the water lock will ensure that the water in the sump and in particular in the water lock area will not freeze. Air will be moved over the prime surface coil to reject the heat from the fluid fed to this coil. It is possible to consider the use of multi-step fan motors or modulating air flow controls, but if the aim is to achieve the maximum reduction of water consumption, it is recommended to maintain full airflow during wet operation and change fan speed only during dry operation periods.
The fluid to be cooled is first fed to the finned discharge coil, where it is pre-cooled by the discharge air. Subsequently the fluid is fed to the prime surface coil, which is wetted by the spray system. By means of evaporative heat transfer the fluid is cooled to its desired exit temperature. With this arrangement already at peak conditions significant water savings can be achieved. At reduced heat load and/or ambient temperatures the three-way valve (optional), which is controlled by the design fluid outlet temperature, modulates the flow through the wetted prime surface coil. As flow and heat load for the wetted prime surface coil decrease, less and less evaporative heat transfer will occur and a significant amount of water is saved.
Adiabatic Operating Mode
When the fluid to be cooled completely bypasses the wetted prime surface coil, the adiabatic operating mode occurs. In this mode no heat is rejected from the wetted prime surface coil and no water is evaporated for heat rejection purposes. The only water that evaporates is the water needed to humidify the air stream subsequently led over the finned discharge coil. Due to humidification the temperature of this air is reduced and the heat transfer capability of the finned discharge coil is increased.
During this mode the spray water pump is off and the three-way valve is set, so that the full flow of the fluid to be cooled is fed to the prime surface coil. This way it is achieved that full benefit is taken from the heat exchange surfaces of both, the finned discharge coil and the prime surface coil, which in this mode is not wetted. In this mode no water is consumed at all.
Fans ON ON ON*
Baltimore Aircoil
HFL - D 55
Structural Support
REMARK: Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
The recommended support arrangement for units consists of parallel I-beams running the full length of the unit, spaced as shown in the following drawing. Besides providing adequate support, the steel also serves to raise the unit above any solid foundation to ensure access to the bottom of the unit. To support units in an alternate steel support arrangement, consult your BAC Balticare Representative.
HFL - D 56
Model HFL 36X HFL 48X HFL 72X HFL 96X HFL 108X HFL 144X HFL 150 X HFL 192 X HFL 180 X HFL 240 X HFL 216 X HFL 288 X
A 3334 4253 3334 4253 3334 4253 3334 4253 3334 4253 3334 4253
B 1194 1194 2344 2344 3551 3551 1194 1194 3551 3551 3551 3551
Baltimore Aircoil
HFL - D 57
Engineering Specifications
1.0 Hybrid Closed Circuit Cooling Tower
1.0 General: Furnish and install ____factory assembled, forced draft, centrifugal fan, hybrid closed circuit cooling tower(s) with vertical air discharge, conforming in all aspects to the specifications and schedules as shown on the plans. Overall dimensions shall not exceed approximately ____mm long x ____mm wide x ____ mm high. The total connected fan kW shall not exceed ____kW. The total connected pump kW shall not exceed ____kW. The hybrid closed circuit cooling tower(s) shall be Baltimore Aircoil Model(s) ________________. 1.2. Thermal Capacity (water as heat transfer fluid): The hybrid closed-circuit cooling tower(s) shall be warranted by the manufacturer to cool ______lps of _______ water from ____C to ____C at ____C entering wet-bulb temperature and from ____C to ____C at ____C entering dry bulb temperature. (Alternate1.2.) Thermal Capacity (aqueous glycol solution as heat transfer fluid): The hybrid closed circuit cooling tower(s) shall be warranted by the manufacturer to cool ________lps of _____% by volume ethylene/propylene glycol solution from ______C to _____C at _____C entering wet-bulb temperature and from ____C to ____C at ____C entering dry bulb temperature. Coil pressure drop shall not exceed ________bar. 1.3. Corrosion Resistant Construction: Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all steel panels and structural members shall be constructed of heavy-gauge Z600 metric hot-dip galvanized steel, with all sheared edges given a protective coating of zinc-rich compound. (Alternate1.3.) Corrosion Resistant Construction: Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all steel panels and structural members shall be protected with the BALTIBONDCorrosion Protection System. The system shall consist of Z600 metric hot-dip galvanized steel prepared in a four-step (clean, pre-treat, rinse, and dry) process with an electrostatically sprayed, thermosetting hybrid polymer fusebonded to the substrate during a thermally activated curing stage and monitored by a 23-step quality assurance program. 1.4. Quality Assurance: The hybrid closed circuit cooling tower manufacturer shall have a management system certified by an accredited registrar as complying with the requirements of ISO9001:2000 to ensure consistent quality of its products and services. Hybrid closed circuit cooling tower manufacturers that are not ISO9001:2000 certified shall provide an additional year of warranty to the customer at no additional cost. 1.5. Warranty: The manufacturers standard equipment warranty shall be for a period of not less than one year from date of startup or eighteen months from date of shipment, whichever occurs first.
HFL - D 58
4.0 Access
4.1. Access Wet Sump: Large rectangular access door(s) shall be provided on the connection end of the cooling tower for access to the wet sump of the cooling tower, including water make-up valve, float ball and suction strainer. 4.2. Access Dry Sump: Circular access door(s) shall be provided for easy access to the air distribution plenum. 4.3. Acces Water Distribution System: Rectangular acces doors shall be provided in the plenum section under the finned coil for easy acces to the water distribution system.
5.0 Sound
6.1 Sound Level: To maintain the quality of the local environment, the maximum sound pressure levels (dB) measured 15 m from the cooling tower operating at full fan speed shall not exceed the sound levels detailed below.
63
125
250
500
1000
2000
4000
8000
dB(A)
Baltimore Aircoil
DFC - D 59
Product Detail
DFC Dry & Adiabatic Fluid Coolers ..................................................... D60 Benefits ..................................................................................................... D62 Construction Details ................................................................................ D66 Custom Features and Options ................................................................ D68 Accessories ............................................................................................... D70 Engineering Data ..................................................................................... D72 Engineering Specifications DFCH / T ................................................... D81 Engineering Specifications DFCV ......................................................... D82 Engineering Specifications DFCV-AD .................................................. D83
DFC - D 60
General Description
DFC Dry Fluid Coolers are available in horizontal, vertical or V-shaped configuration in a wide capacity and sound level range. The DFC has been designed to deliver maximum thermal performance and longevity while minimising sound pressure, operational and installation costs. A wide range of models is being offered with adiabatic pre-cooling of the air to increase capacity with minimum water consumption.
Key Features
140 standard models 470 models total Available in horizontal, vertical or V-shaped configuration Heavy duty design requiring minimum maintenance Suitable for cooling of all common coolants Unique retractable legs to minimise shipping and installation costs Low maintenance Low sound models available for sound sensitive applications V-shaped models offered with Adiabatic Pre-Cooling of the intake air Optimised primary fluid pressure drops due to the availability of various tube diameters
Baltimore Aircoil
DFC - D 61
DFC - D 62
Benefits
Wide Capacity and Sound Level Range
The DFC Dry Fluid Cooler is available in a broad variety of fan configurations, coil designs and motor types, resulting in a wide and complete range of capacities, optimally satisfying capacity requirements and sound level limitations. Thermal and acoustical performance has been verified according to the Eurovent rating standard 7/C/003-1995 (thermal) and 8/1 (acoustical) for air cooled equipment. This assures guaranteed cooling efficiency and noise levels throughout the life of the equipment. The low speed, dry cooler range, applying a 12-pole motor, is especially designed for very sound sensitive application, such as residential areas. The application of 1/2" as well as 5/8 tubing allows the optimisation of the primary fluid pressure drop.
Baltimore Aircoil
DFC - D 63
Retractable Legs: in
DFC - D 64
Removable Panels
Removable Panels
1. Water in; 2. Water out; 3. Evaporative Cooling Pad; 4. Adiabatic Dry bulb Depression; 5. Dry Coil.
Baltimore Aircoil
DFC - D 65
Safe Operation: - No aerosol formation, no risk of dispersion of contaminated droplets. (Legionella) - Designed as once-through system, without water recirculation or water stagnation. - Complete draining and drying of all water distribution piping after each adiabatic cycle. - Water used usually comes from potable supplies or wells at temperatures between 5 and 20C where Legionella is dormant. The Adiabatic pre-cooler and its evaporative pads can be easily removed during the colder seasons. If kept in place also during the colder seasons however, the adiabatic pre-cooling could be used to enhance energy saving operation and it acts as an air washer protecting the coil year-round from any air borne debris which could cause coil fouling.
DFC - D 66
Construction Details
Baltimore Aircoil
DFC - D 67
4. Retractable Legs
The heat exchanger section is supported by columns which recess into the heat exchanger section to reduce shipping volume, and facilitate installation.
5. Removable Panels
Large removable panels assure ease of access to the heat exchanger for inspection and cleaning.
DFC - D 68
- Aluminium fins with pre-coated hydrophobic anti-corrosion surface treatment. Both sides of the aluminium fin are coated with a layer of epoxy phenolic resin. After thermosetting the high quality and firmly bonded hydrophobic film is highly effective in minimising salt corrosion and has excellent solvent resistance. - Copper fins of 0,2 mm thickness in lieu of aluminium. For the cooling of aggressive fluids incompatible with copper, a heat exchanger is available with stainless steel tubes. Stainless steel tubes are 15,8 mm diameter with 0,7 mm wall thickness, made of TP 304L grade stainless steel with aluminum fins.
Baltimore Aircoil
DFC - D 69
DFC - D 70
Accessories
Wiring to Terminal Box
Each fan can be wired to a terminal box of IP55 enclosure located at the fluid connection end of the cooler, or at the opposite side. The wiring can be specified for single speed fan operation or for dual fan speed operation through delta/star reconnect.
Two-Speed Switch
All motors are suitable for dual speed operation through delta/star re-connect. A two-speed switch can be supplied as an option, installed on the unit for manual changeover.
Safety Switch
If required by local codes a safety switch for each fan can be installed in the wiring to the terminal box, to be used as a maintenance switch.
Safety Switch
Baltimore Aircoil
DFC - D 71
Starter Panels
Starter panel of IP55 enclosure is available with main switch, main fuses, general contactor relay with emergency cut-out switch, control circuit fuse, thermal contactor and coil for each fan, wired to the fan motor thermostatic cut-out switch. Alternatively, starter panels designed for capacity control by fan cycling can be provided, with electronic step controller, as sequence controller with direct entry and setting of all data and immersion temperature sensor with protection pocket made of brass.
Electrical Panel
Sound Attenuation
Low Sound Dry Cooler models with low speed motors are available for installation in sound sensitive and residential areas. Alternatively the dry coolers can be equipped with air outlet silencers.
DFC - D 72
Engineering Data
Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
Baltimore Aircoil
DFC - D 73
DFCH/S80 and DFCT/S80 Standard Sound Level Models Fans 800 mm 6 pole Motor
Model DFCH/T Number of Fans Nominal Capacity kW / S8011-H213B S8011-H313B S8011-L413B S8011-H416B S8012-S213B S8012-L313B S8012-S413B S8012-L416B S8013-S213B S8013-S313B S8013-D413B S8013-S416B S8014-S213B S8014-D413B S8014-D416B S8015-D413B S8015-M516B S8022-S213B S8022-L313B S8022-S413B S8022-L416B S8023-S213B S8023-S313B S8023-D413B S8023-S416B S8024-S213B S8024-D413B S8024-D416B S8025-D413B S8025-M516B 1 o 37/32 51/43 57/47 62/51 74/64 109/91 123/101 128/105 123/104 165/138 177/146 196/161 173/146 247/202 248/206 268/219 301/244 149/128 218/182 247/202 257/210 247/209 331/277 354/292 392/322 346/293 494/404 497/412 536/439 602/489 Airflow m3/s / 6,1/4,6 5,7/4,3 5,3/4,1 5,6/4,3 12,2/9,3 11,4/8,7 10,7/8,2 11,3/8,6 18,3/13,9 17,1/13,0 16,1/12,3 16,9/12,9 24,4/18,6 21,5/16,4 22,6/17,2 24,2/18,5 24,0/18,3 24,4/18,7 22,8/17,4 21,5/16,5 22,6/17,3 36,6/28,0 34,2/26,1 32,3/24,7 33,9/25,9 48,8/37,3 43,1/33,0 45,2/34,6 48,5/37,1 48,0/36,7 Cooling Agent l/s / 1,9/1,7 2,7/2,3 3,0/2,5 3,2/2,7 3,9/3,4 5,7/4,8 6,5/5,3 6,7/5,5 6,5/5,5 8,7/7,3 9,3/7,7 10,3/8,5 9,1/7,7 13,0/10,6 13,1/10,9 14,1/11,6 15,9/12,9 7,8/6,7 11,5/9,6 13,0/10,6 13,5/11,1 13,0/11,0 17,5/14,6 18,7/15,4 20,7/17,0 18,0/15,4 26,1/21,3 26,2/21,8 28,3/23,2 31,8/25,8 p kPa / 12/9 32/23 18/13 18/13 13/10 75/54 53/36 41/29 41/30 96/69 29/21 57/40 92/68 64/44 26/19 74/51 73/50 13/10 75/54 53/36 41/29 41/30 96/69 29/21 57/40 92/68 64/44 26/19 74/51 73/50 Tube Internal Surface Connecm2 tions Volume dm3 12 18 24 37 24 35 47 74 35 53 71 112 47 95 149 95 186 47 71 95 149 71 106 142 223 95 189 298 189 372 97 145 193 173 193 290 386 347 290 435 579 520 386 773 693 773 867 386 579 773 693 579 869 1159 1040 773 1545 1386 1545 1733 Ship. Weight kg 229 246 262 281 368 401 435 473 513 563 613 670 686 820 896 871 1033 637 703 770 846 902 1003 1103 1217 1192 1460 1612 1542 1866 LpA dB(A) / A Dimensions mm B C
2 x ND65
59/56
2012 1300
2 oo
2 x ND80
61/58
3612 2900
3 ooo
2 x ND80
63/60
5212 4500
2 x ND80
63/60
2 x ND80
64/61
4 x ND80
64/61
3612 2900
4 x ND80
66/63
5212 4500
4 x ND80
66/63
4 x ND80
67/64
DFCH/L80 and DFCT/L80 Low Sound Level Models Fans 800 mm 8 pole motor
Model DFCH/T Number of Fans Nominal Capacity kW /Y L8011-H213B L8011-H313B L8011-H413B L8011-H416B L8012-H213B L8012-L313B L8012-S413B L8012-L416B L8013-S213B L8013-S313B L8013-D413B L8013-S416B L8014-S213B L8014-D413B L8014-D416B 1 o 32/29 43/39 50/45 51/46 73/68 90/81 100/91 104/95 105/97 136/125 145/132 160/45 147/136 201/182 205/186 Airflow m3/s /Y 4,7/4,1 4,3/3,7 4,1/3,6 4,3/3,7 9,4/8,2 8,6/7,5 8,2/7,2 8,6/7,5 14,1/12,8 12,9/11,3 12,3/10,8 12,9/11,3 18,8/16,5 16,4/14,4 17,2/15,1 Cooling Agent l/s /Y 1,7/1,5 2,2/2,0 2,6/2,4 2,7/2,4 3,8/3,6 4,7/4,3 5,3/4,8 5,5/5,0 5,5/5,1 7,2/6,6 7,7/6,9 8,4/7,6 7,7/7,2 10,6/9,6 10,8/9,8 p kPa /Y 9,8/8,5 22/19,4 38/32,3 13/11,4 69/60,2 53/44,8 36/30,7 28/24,6 30/26,9 67/57,1 20/17,4 39/33,0 69/60,2 44/36,7 19/15,9 Tube Internal Surface Connecm2 tions Volume dm3 12 18 24 37 24 35 47 74 35 53 71 112 47 95 149 97 145 193 173 193 290 386 347 290 435 579 520 386 773 693 Ship. Weight kg 229 246 262 281 368 401 435 473 513 563 613 670 686 820 896 LpA dB(A) /Y A Dimensions mm B C
2 x ND65
54/51
2012 1300
2 oo
2 x ND80
56/53
3612 2900
3 ooo
2 x ND80
57/54
5212 4500
4 oooo
2 x ND80
58/55
DFC - D 74
Model DFCH/T
Number of Fans
Nominal Capacity kW /Y
Airflow m3/s /Y 22,0/19,3 19,3/16,9 18,8/16,5 17,2/15,1 16,4/14,4 17,2/15,1 28,2/24,7 25,8/22,6 24,6/21,6 25,8/22,6 37,6/33,0 32,8/28,8 34,4/30,2 44,0/38,6 38,7/33,9
Cooling Agent l/s /Y 8,5/7,9 11,8/10,7 7,7/7,2 9,5/8,6 10,6/9,6 11,0/10,0 11,1/10,3 14,4/13,2 15,4/13,9 16,9/15,3 15,5/14,4 21,2/19,2 21,7/19,7 17,1/15,8 23,6/21,5
p kPa /Y 82/71,4 22/18,5 69/60,2 53/44,8 36/30,7 28/24,6 30/26,9 67/57,1 20/17,4 39/33,0 69/60,2 44/36,7 19/15,9 82/71,4 22/18,5
Tube Internal Surface ConnecVolume m2 tions dm3 47 186 47 71 95 149 71 106 142 223 95 189 298 95 372 386 867 386 579 773 693 579 869 1159 1040 773 1545 1386 773 1733 2 x ND80
Ship. Weight kg 737 947 637 703 770 846 902 1003 1103 1217 1192 1460 1612 1275 1694
Dimensions mm B C
L8015-S213B L8015-D416B L8022-H213B L8022-L313B L8022-S413B L8022-L416B L8023-S213B L8023-S313B L8023-D413B L8023-S416B L8024-S213B L8024-D413B L8024-D416B L8025-S213B L8025-D416B
5 ooooo 4 oooo
162/149 223/203 147/136 180/163 201/182 208/190 210/195 273/250 291/263 320/290 294/273 402/364 411/373 325/299 447/406
4 x ND80
59/56
3612 2900
4 x ND80
60/57
5212 4500
4 x ND80
61/58
4 x ND80
62/59
DFCH/R80 and DFCT/R80 Ultra Low Sound Level Models Fans 800 mm 12 pole motor
Model DFCH/T Number of Fans Nominal Capacity kW /Y R8011-H313B R8012-L313B R8013-S313B R8014-S313B 1 o 2 oo 3 ooo 4 oooo 4 oo oo 6 ooo ooo 8 oooo oooo 29/23 60/48 92/75 126/101 Airflow m3/s /Y 2,5/1,8 5,0/3,7 7,5/5,6 10,0/7,5 Cooling Agent l/s /Y 1,5/1,2 3,1/2,5 4,8/3,9 6,6/5,3 p kPa /Y 11/7 25/17 32/22 73/49 Tube Internal Surface Connecm2 tions Volume dm3 18 35 53 71 145 290 435 579 2 x ND65 2 x ND80 2 x ND80 2 x ND80 Ship. Weight kg LpA dB(A) /Y Dimensions mm A B C -
R8022-L313B
120/97
10,0/7,5
6,3/5,1
25/17
71
579
4 x ND80
703
R8023-S313B
184/149
15,0/11,2
9,7/7,8
34/23
106
869
4 x ND80
1003
R8024-S313B
252/202
20,0/15,0
13,3/10,6
73/49
142
1159
4 x ND80
1326
Dry Coolers capacities are tested according to EN 1048. Ratings shown are for clean tubes with 34% ethylene glycol solution by volume, 40C in and 35C out, 25C ambient air temperature. Sound Pressure Levels (LpA) are measured in the horizontal plane at a distance of 10 m from the connection end of the unit, under free field conditions.
Baltimore Aircoil
DFC - D 75
Sound Power Levels for one 800 mm Fan at Nominal Speed Rating
DFCH/T Product Range 50 Hz Fan Motor Conn. 6-pole Standard Sound Level 6-pole 8-pole Low Sound Level 8-pole 12-pole Ultra Low Sound Level 12-pole Star 43 53 55 58 58 56 54 50 65 Star Delta 76 47 77 57 74 59 73 62 72 62 71 60 68 58 62 54 77 69 Star Delta 74 79 77 80 81 77 82 76 77 75 75 74 71 71 62 65 83 80 Delta 63 73 125 82 250 85 500 83 1000 81 2000 79 4000 76 8000 69 LwA 86 Outlet Sound Power Level at Octave Band Center Frequency (Hz) Total
DFC - D 76
2 x ND80
916 1046 1283 1462 1677 1924 2070 2387 2464 2822
2 x ND80
4 x ND80
4 x ND80
4 x ND80
2 x ND80
2 x ND80
Baltimore Aircoil
DFC - D 77
Model DFCV
Number of Fans
Nominal Capacity kW /Y
Tube Internal Surface ConnecVolume m2 tions dm3 243 382 303 478 364 574 1983 1779 2479 2224 2975 2669
Ship. Weight kg
LpA dB(A) /Y
Dimensions mm L W H
2 x ND80
4 x ND80
4 x ND80
287
1335
2 x ND80
1331
S9023-S616B
555/436
39,6/29,6
29,3/23,0
36/23
430
2002
4 x ND80
1887
S9024-M616B
732/582
52,8/39,5
38,6/30,7
29/19
574
2669
4 x ND80
2490
S9025-M616B
937/733
66,0/49,4
49,5/38,7
50/32
717
3336
4x ND100 4x ND100
3124
S9026-D616B
1110/873
79,2/59,3
58,6/46,1
41/26
860
4004
3699
DFCV/R90 Ultra Low Sound Level Models Fans 900 mm 12 pole motor
Model DFCV Number of Fans Nominal Capacity kW /Y R9022-H413B R9022-H416B R9023-L413B R9023-H416B R9024-S413B R9024-L416B R9025-S413B R9025-L416B R9026-D413B R9026-S416B 4 oo oo 6 ooo ooo 8 oooo oooo 10 ooooo ooooo 12 oooooo oooooo 170/145 169/145 255/217 260/221 340/290 341/294 435/368 434/371 501/432 522/444 Airflow m3/s /Y 12/9,9 Cooling Agent l/s /Y 9,0/7,7 8,9/7,6 13,5/11,5 13,7/11,7 18,0/15,3 18,0/15,6 23,0/19,4 22,9/19,6 26,5/22,8 27,6/23,4 p kPa /Y 42/31 14/11 42/31 42/32 38/29 27/21 71/53 51/39 21/16 40/30 Tube Internal Surface Connecm2 tions Volume dm3 121 191 182 287 243 382 303 478 364 574 992 890 1487 1335 1983 1779 2479 2224 2975 2669 Ship. Weight kg LpA dB(A) /Y Dimensions mm L W H
2 x ND80
996 1126 1403 1582 1837 2084 2270 2587 2704 3062
18/14,8
2 x ND80
24/19,8
4 x ND80
30/24,8
4 x ND80
36/29,8
4 x ND80
DFC - D 78
Dry Cooler capacities are tested according to EN 1048 Ratings shown are for clean tubes with 34% ethylene glycol solution by volume, 40C in and 35C out, 25C ambient air temperature. Sound Pressure Levels (LpA ) are measured in the horizontal plane at a distance of 10 m from the connection end of the unit, under free field conditions.
900 mm
DFCV Product Range 50Hz Fan motor Conn 6-pole Standard Sound Level 6-pole 12-pole Ultra Low Sound Level 12-pole Star 48 57 60 63 63 61 57 54 67 Star Delta 55 49 69 58 75 61 78 64 78 64 76 62 73 58 67 55 82 68 Delta 63 62 125 76 250 82 500 85 1000 85 2000 83 4000 80 8000 74 LwA 89 Outlet Sound Power Level at Octave Band Center Frequency (Hz) Total
Baltimore Aircoil
DFC - D 79
287
1335
2 x ND80
S9023-S616B-AD
810/634
36/26
42,8/33,5
73/47
430
2002
4 x ND80
2086
S9024-M616B-AD
1072/843
48/35
56,7/44,6
58/38
574
2669
4 x ND80
2738
S9025-D616B-AD
1340/1047
60/44
70,8/55,3
53/33
717
3336
4x ND100 4x ND100
3421
S9026-D616B-AD
1620/1269
72/53
85,6/67,1
82/53
860
4004
4050
2 x ND80
16,8/13,9
2 x ND80
22,4/18,5
4 x ND80
28,0/23,2
4 x ND80
33,6/27,8
4 x ND80
DFC - D 80
Dry Coolers capacities are tested according to EN 1048 Ratings shown are for clean tubes with 34% ethylene glycol solution by volume, 40C in and 35C out, 25C ambient air temperature. Sound Pressure Levels (LpA) are measured in the horizontal plane at a distance of 10 m from the connection end of the unit, under free field conditions.
Baltimore Aircoil
DFC - D 81
Performance Data The air and sound performance data has been measured in accordance with the following Standards: ISO 5801:1977, type A installation test method for air performance (dual numbered BS 848 Part1: 1997) BS 848 Part 2:1985, type A installation, method of noise testing.
DFC - D 82
B. Fans 900 mm
Motor Poles Motor Rating, kW Y Speed, Rpm Y Full Load Current, A Y Starting Current, A Y 18,4 2,90 3,80 24,0 0,80 3,50 725 5,74 360 1,80 1,10 925 0,12 435 6 Poles 2,10 12 Poles 0,25
Performance Data The air and sound performance data has been measured in accordance with the following Standards: ISO 5801:1977, type A installation test method for air performance (dual numbered BS 848 Part1: 1997) BS 848 Part 2:1985, type A installation, method of noise testing.
Baltimore Aircoil
DFC - D 83
Performance Data The air and sound performance data has been measured in accordance with the following Standards: ISO 5801:1977, type A installation test method for air performance (dual numbered BS 848 Part1: 1997) BS 848 Part 2:1985, type A installation, method of noise testing.
DFC - D 84
The cooler is supplied with an ambient temperature measurement sensor, the controller of which is set at the calculated depressed dry bulb temperature at design conditions. A dead-range differential is built into the controller to avoid hunting, anticipating that the adiabatic system will start and stop only once a day by actuating the main solenoid valve supplying the city water to the distribution manifold. For proper Legionella bacteria control, the system is drained daily, which is feasible because the volume of the piping is very limited. This is accomplished by the opening of the drain solenoid valve, when the city water supply is interrupted by the action of the ambient temperature sensor.
Baltimore Aircoil
HXC - D 85
Hybrid Condenser
Product Detail
HXC Hybrid Condenser ......................................................................... D86 Benefits ..................................................................................................... D88 Construction Details ................................................................................ D90 Custom Features and Options ................................................................ D92 Accessories ............................................................................................... D95 Engineering Specifications ..................................................................... D97
HXC - D 86
General Description
The HXC Hybrid Condenser offers significant water savings versus traditional water-cooled and evaporative condensers. Thanks to the standard design features the HXC satisfies additional environmental concerns by minimising also energy consumption, refrigerant charge and plume. The HXC minimises operating cost, provides year-round operating reliability and simplifies maintenance requirements.
Key Features
Maximum water savings Low energy consumption Low refrigerant charge Low installed cost Easy maintenance Plume abatement Reliable year-round operation Long service life PED 97/23/EC Coil Design
Baltimore Aircoil
HXC - D 87
Principle of Operation
The refrigerant enters the dry (finned) coil at the top, which is to be connected with the wet (prime surface) coil in series. Liquid refrigerant leaves at the bottom outlet of the wet coil. When the dampers are closed, air is induced through the wet sections (coil and fill), where it picks up heat and humidity. The air is then led over the dry (finned) coil, where it picks up additional sensible heat. Due to the sensible heat transfer of the dry (finned) coil, water consumption is reduced, when compared to a conventional evaporative condenser. To save compressor energy and reduce the condensing heat (and water consumption) the HXC hybrid condenser will operate with dampers closed until a given value of condensing temperature is reached and the ambient air is cold enough to contribute to the heat rejection. When the dampers open the air flow increases due to the lower resistance to air flow and the air distribution will shift, so that less air is induced through the evaporative sections, both of which enhances the sensible heat transfer and further reduces water consumption. If the ambient air temperature is low enough to allow dry operation, the spray pump is shut off and no water is consumed at all.
1. Air in; 2. Air out; 3. Vapour in; 4. Liquid out; 5. Wet deck surface; 6. Cold water basin; 7. Water distribution system; 8. Coil; 9. Spray Water Pump; 10. Eliminators; 12. Dry finned coil; 13. Modulating air inlet dampers; 14. Servo motor; 15. Pressure transmitter.
HXC - D 88
Benefits
Maximum Water Savings
Water savings are achieved throughout the year with different operating modes of the HXC. In some areas, the water cost savings alone can pay for the equipment in as little as two years! During the dry/wet operating mode, a significant amount of heat is removed by sensible heat transfer, providing reduced water consumption versus conventional evaporative cooling When the heat load and/or ambient temperatures drop, the condensing pressure is lowered to a set value, hence saving energy and water. When temperature of the ambient air is low enough, dampers in the back of the condenser open, hereby introducing an increased flow of colder ambient air, which enhances the heat transfer on the dry coil and further reduces water consumption Water consumption is totally eliminated in the dry operating mode
Modular Design Units ship in three pieces to minimize the size and weight of the heaviest lift, allowing for the use of smaller, less costly cranes. Coil Connections Single prime surface coil reduces costs of pipe, valves, purgers and labour.
Baltimore Aircoil
HXC - D 89
Easy Maintenance
Access Hinged access doors and a standard internal walkway provide easy access to the unit interior. Spacious Interior Provides easy access to the cold water basin, drift eliminators, fan drive system, the prime surface coil and the modulation fan dampers. Access to spray Distribution Parallel flow of air and spray water over the coil allows for inspection and access to the top of the coil during full operation.
Plume Abatement
The HXC offers a combination of sensible, adiabatic, and evaporative heat transfer to significantly reduce any plume that may occur with conventional evaporative cooling equipment. During the coldest times of the year, when the potential for visible discharge is greatest, the HXC operates 100% dry, completely eliminating plume.
HXC - D 90
Construction Details
Baltimore Aircoil
HXC - D 91
1. Heavy-Duty Construction
Z600 hot-dip galvanized steel panels
7. BACross Wet Deck Surface with Integral Drift Eliminators (Not Shown)
Plastic material Impervious to rot, decay and biological attack Designed and manufactured by BAC
HXC - D 92
Multiple Refrigerant Circuit Coils (Split Coils): In general, multiple circuit coils are required primarily on halocarbon refrigerant systems where it is common practice to maintain individual compressor systems. Also, a circuit can be isolated to provide cooling of a water or glycol loop for compressor jacket cooling. A wide range of multiple circuit arrangements is available. All coils are designed for low pressure drop with sloping tubes for free drainage of fluid.
Baltimore Aircoil
HXC - D 93
HXC - D 94
Low NoiseFans
The low sound levels generated by HXC Hybrid Condensers are thanks to the use of high efficiency low noise axial fans making them suitable for installation in most environments. For extremely sound sensitive installations, factory designed, tested and rated sound attenuation is available for both the air intake and discharge.
Baltimore Aircoil
HXC - D 95
Accessories
External Service Platform
For external service, platforms can be added to the unit.
Internal Ladder
For access to the motor and drive assemblies internal ladders are available on all models.
External Service Platform, Ladder and Safety Cage
Basin Heaters
Units exposed to below freezing ambient temperatures require protection to prevent freezing of the water in the cold water basin when the unit is idle. Factory-installed heaters, which maintain the water temperature at 4C, are a simple and inexpensive way of providing such protection. The heater package includes the heaters, a thermostat and a low level cut out switch to protect the heaters if the water level is too low. Standard electric heaters are selected for -18C ambient temperature.
HXC - D 96
Stand-by Pump
A factory mounted stand-by pump is available, including non-return valves in each pump piping line. In case of a pump failure, there can be switched over to the stand-by pump, eliminating the unit shut down period as much as possible.
Baltimore Aircoil
HXC - D 97
Engineering Specifications
General
A. General: Furnish and install, _____ factory assembled hybrid condenser(s) of induced draft design, with single side air entry and vertical air discharge. Overall dimensions shall not exceed approximately _____ mm x _____ mm, with an overall height not exceeding approximately _____mm. Operating weight shall not exceed _____ kg. The hybrid condenser shall be Baltimore Aircoil Model ____________. B. Capacity: The hybrid condenser(s) shall be warranted by the manufacturer to have condensing capacity of _____ kW heat rejection, operating with ____ refrigerant at ___C condensing temperature and ___C entering wet-bulb temperature. C. Warranty: The manufacturers standard equipment warranty shall be for a period of one year from the date of startup or eighteen months from the date of shipment, whichever ends first. D. Quality Assurance: The manufacture shall have Management System certified by an accredited registrar as complying with the requirements of ISO-9001:2000 to ensure consistent quality of products and services.
Products
1.0 Evaporative Condenser Materials and Components
1.1 Baltiplus Corrosion Resistant Construction: Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all steel panels and structural elements shall be constructed from heavy-gauge, Z600 hot-dip galvanized steel, with all sheared edges given a protective coating of zinc-rich compound and the exterior protected with the Baltiplus Corrosion Protection. (Alternate 1.1) Baltibond Corrosion Resistant Construction: Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all steel panels and structural members shall be protected with the BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System. The system shall consist of Z600 hot dip galvanised steel prepared in a four-step (clean, pre-treat, rinse and dry) process with an electrostatically sprayed, thermosetting hybrid polymer fuse-bonded to the substrate during a thermally activated curing stage monitored by a 23-step quality assurance program.
Baltibond. Basin shall include a depressed section with drain/ cleanout connection. The basin area under the wet deck surface shall be sloped toward the depressed section to facilitate cleaning. 3.2 The cold water basin shall include a drain/clean-out connection; a steel strainer; a brass make-up valve; over flow connection; and a water recirculation pump assembly.
HXC - D 98
a. Cold water basin shall be designed so that the strainer, makeup valve and float, and pump assembly are easily accessible without removing any of the unit panels or other components. b. Lift-out steel strainer shall be supplied with perforated openings sized smaller than the water distribution nozzle orifices and an integral anti-vortexing hood to prevent air entrainment. c. Water recirculation pump shall be a close-coupled, bronze-fitted centrifugal pump equipped with a mechanical seal, mounted on the basin and piped from the suction strainer to the water distribution system. i. The pump shall be installed with adequate drains so that it may drain freely when the basin is drained. ii. The pump assembly shall include an integral metering valve and bleed line to control the bleed rate from the pump discharge to the overflow connection. iii. The pump motor shall be totally enclosed fan cooled (TEFC) type suitable for _____ volt, ____ phase, ______ Hz electrical service. d. On installations requiring a remote sump, the hybrid condenser shall be modified to accommodate the use of an independent sump and pump for recirculating water (by others). i. The recirculating water pump, steel strainer, make-up valve, and integral bleed line assemblies shall be omitted from the hybrid condenser scope of supply. ii. The hybrid condenser shall be supplied with a cold water basin outlet sized and located as indicated on the drawings for gravity drain to the remote sump. iii. The water distribution system shall have a design operating pressure of 14 kPa at the hybrid condenser spray water inlet connection. 3.3 The heat transfer section shall consist of BACross wet deck surface with integral drift eliminators for cooling the spray water leaving the coil to optimize the thermal performance of the hybrid condenser as well as saturate and pre-cool the incoming ambient air. a. The wet deck surface and integral drift eliminators shall be formed from plastic material. b. The wet deck surface and integral drift eliminators shall be impervious to rot, decay, fungus, and biological attack. 3.4 Combined Inlet Shields: Combined inlet shields shall be separate from the wet deck surface and removable to allow easy access for inspection of the air/water interface at the air inlet side of the equipment. Combined inlet shields shall prevent UV-light and debris from entering the unit, as well as prevent water splash out during fan cycling. They shall be constructed of maintenance free, corrosion and UV resistant material. 3.5 Hinged Access Door: A large, hinged access door shall be provided for access to the coil, drift eliminators and fan plenum section. The water make-up valve, float ball and suction strainer shall be easily accessible. 3.6. Internal walkway: The hybrid condenser shall be provided with an internal walkway at the access door to facilitate servicing of the unit.
5.0 Sound
Sound Level: To maintain the quality of the local environment, the maximum sound pressure levels (dB) measured 15 m from the hybrid condenser operating at full fan speed shall not exceed the sound levels detailed below.
63
125
250
500
1000
2000
4000
8000
dB(A)
Baltimore Aircoil
EC - E 1
Evaporative Condensers
Overview
Evaporative Condensers
EC - E 2
Evaporative condensers provide heat rejection for many types of systems, and the specific application will largely determine which BAC Evaporative Condenser is best suited for a project. The product line overview table in this section is intended as a general guide. Evaporative condensers are used to provide lower condensing temperatures and compressor kilowatts savings of up to 15 percent when compared with traditional systems.
Principle of Operation
Overview
The vapor to be condensed is circulated through a condensing coil, which is continually wetted on the outside by a re-circulating water system. Air is pulled over the coil, causing a small portion of the re-circulating water to evaporate. The evaporation removes heat from the vapor in the coil, causing it to condense.
Configuration
BAC manufactures three types of evaporative condensers: combined flow, counter flow and hybrid products.
Combined Flow
Combined flow is the use of both a condensing coil and wet deck surface for heat transfer in an evaporative condenser. The addition of wet deck surface to the traditional evaporative condenser design reduces evaporation in the coil section, reducing the potential for scaling and fouling. BACs combined flow evaporative condensers utilize parallel flow of air and spray water over the coil, and crossflow air/water flow through the wet deck surface. In parallel flow, air and water flow over the coil in the same direction. In the wet deck section of BACs combined flow evaporative condensers, air and water interact in a crossflow configuration: water flows vertically down the wet deck as air flows horizontally across it.
Combined Flow: Parallel flow of air and water over the coil
Baltimore Aircoil
EC - E 3
Counterflow
In a counterflow evaporative condenser design, the flow of the air is in the opposite direction of the spray water. In BACs counterflow evaporative condensers, air travels vertically up through the unit while the spray water travels vertically down over the coil.
Hybrid Products
Evaporative Condensers
Counterflow Configuration
Fan System
The flow of air through most factory assembled evaporative cooling equipment is provided by one or more mechanically driven fans. The fan(s) may be axial or centrifugal, each type having its own distinct advantages. Axial fan units require approximately half the fan motor kilowatt of comparably sized centrifugal fan units, offering significant life-cycle cost savings. Centrifugal fan units are capable of overcoming reasonable amounts of external static pressure ( 125 Pa), making them suitable for both indoor and outdoor installations. Centrifugal fans are also inherently quieter than axial fans, although the difference is minimal and can often be overcome through the application of optional low sound fans and/or sound attenuation on axial fan units. Fans can be applied in an induced draft or a forced draft configuration.
Centrifugal Fans
Axial Fans
Induced Draft The rotating air handling components of induced draft equipment are mounted in the top deck of the unit, minimizing the impact of fan noise on near-by neighbors and providing maximum protection from fan icing with units operating in sub-freezing conditions. The air being drawn through the unit hereby discharges over the inducing fan. The use of corrosion resistant materials ensures long life and minimizes maintenance requirements for the air handling components. Forced Draft Rotating air-handling components are located on the air inlet face at the base of forced draft towers whereby fresh air is blown through the unit. This base fan position facilitates easy access for routine maintenance and service. Additionally, location of these components in the dry entering air stream extends component life by isolating them from the corrosive saturated discharge air.
Capacity Range
All capacities shown are for a single unit; multiple units can be applied to achieve larger capacities.
EC - E 4
Typical Applications
A list of typical applications is provided in the Product Line Overview Table for your reference.
Overview
Principle of Operation
Counterflow Centrifugal Fan, Forced Draft 60 to 6930 kW Sound sensitive industrial refrigeration projects Installations with limited plan area Indoor Installations
Counterflow Centrifugal Fan, Forced Draft 180 to 1380 kW Sound sensitive industrial refrigeration projects. Installations with extremely low height requirements Indoor Installations Skid packages
Typical Applications
1. Air in; 2. Air out; 3. Vapour in; 4. Liquid out; 5. Wet deck surface; 6. Cold water basin; 7. Water distribution system; 8. Coil; 9. Spray Water Pump; 10. Eliminators; 11. Optional Extended Surface. 12. Dry finned coil; 13. Modulating air inlet dampers; 14. Servo motor; 15. Pressure transmitter.
Baltimore Aircoil
EC - E 5
CXV
CXV-D
HXC (For more information refer to Section Hybrid Water Saving Products)
Evaporative Condensers
Industrial refrigeration applications in Very large industrial refrigeration and process projects requiring geographical regions where water cost is low energy consumption and low sound high
EC - E 6
Engineering Considerations
Location
Units must have an adequate supply of fresh air to the air inlet(s). When units are located adjacent to building walls or in enclosures, care must be taken to ensure that the warm, saturated discharge air is not deflected off surrounding walls or enclosures and drawn back to the air inlet(s).
Warning: Each unit should be located and positioned to prevent the introduction of the warm discharge air and the associated drift, which may contain chemical or biological contaminants including Legionella, into the ventilation systems of the building on which the unit is located or those of adjacent buildings.
Overview
Note: For detailed recommendations on layout, please consult your local BAC Balticare Representative.
For VL and VX products, bottom screens or solid bottom panels may be desirable or necessary for safety, depending on the location and conditions at the installation site.
Capacity Control
Variable Frequency Drives (VFD) Installations which are to be controlled by Variable Frequency Drives (VFD) require the use of an inverter duty motor as designed IEC 34.1, which recognizes the increased stresses placed on motors by these drive systems. Inverter duty motors must be furnished on VFD applications in order to maintain the motor warranty. Fan motors must be furnished with thermal protection (either PTC sensors or coil thermostats normally open, or normally closed). The motor protection consists of temperature sensitive cutout devices embedded in the motor windings (minimum 3 per motor). BAC offers factory installed motor control packages including VFD drives. Refer to the section "Technical Resources, Motor Controls". Check with your local BAC Balticare representative for availability.
Warning: When the fan speed is to be changed from the factory-set speed, including through the use of a variable speed control device, steps must be taken to avoid operating at or near fan speeds that cause a resonance with the unit or its supporting structure. At start-up, the variable frequency drive should be cycled slowly between zero and full speed and any speeds that cause a noticeable resonance in the unit should be locked out by the variable speed drive.
Baltimore Aircoil
EC - E 7
Fan Cycling Fan cycling is the simplest method of capacity control. The number of steps of capacity control can be increased using the Baltiguard Fan System, the independent fan motor option, or two-speed fan motors in conjunction with fan cycling (see the Custom Features & Options section of the appropriate product line to determine whether the Baltiguard Fan System or the independent fan motor option are available; two-speed motors are available for all products). These options provide substantial energy savings when compared to simple fan cycling.
Warning: Rapid on-off cycling can cause the fan motor to overheat. It is recommended that controls be set to allow a maximum of 6 on-off cycles per hour. Note: Spray water pump cycling should not be used for capacity control. This method of control often results in short cycling of the pump motor as capacity changes substantially with pump cycling. In addition, alternate wetting and drying of the coil promotes scaling of the heat exchanger coil surface.
Evaporative Condensers
Capacity Control Dampers On centrifugal fan models, modulating capacity control dampers are available to provide close control of head pressure. See Section "Accessories" or contact your local BAC Balticare representative.
Water Treatment
As water evaporates in the unit, the dissolved solids originally present in the water remain in the system. The concentration of these dissolved solids increases rapidly and can cause scale and corrosion. In addition, airborne impurities and biological contaminants, including Legionella, may be introduced into the circulating water. To control all potential contaminants, a water treatment program must be employed. In many cases, a simple bleed-off may be adequate for control of scale and corrosion. However, biological contamination, including Legionella, can be controlled only through the use of biocides. Such treatment should be initiated at system startup, after periods of equipment shutdown, and continued regularly thereafter. Accordingly, it is strongly recommended a biocide treatment be initiated when the unit is first filled with water and continued regularly thereafter. For more information, consult the appropriate Operating and Maintenance Manual. When a water treatment program is employed, it must be compatible with construction materials. Batch feeding of chemicals into the unit is not recommended. If units are constructed with optional corrosion resistant materials, acid treatment may be considered; however, the water quality must be maintained within the guidelines set forth in the Operating and Maintenance Instructions.
Note: Unless a common remote sump is utilised, each cell of a multi-cell installation must be treated as a separate entity, even if the cold water basins are equalised.
For complete Water Quality Guidelines, see the appropriate Operating and Maintenance Instruction Manual, available at www.baltimoreaircoil.com. For specific recommendations on water treatment, contact a competent water treatment supplier.
Sound Levels
Sound rating data are available for all BAC models. When calculating the sound levels generated by a unit, the designer must take into account the effects of the geometry of the tower as well as the distance and direction from the unit to noise-sensitive areas. Whisper Quiet fans and intake and discharge sound attenuation can be supplied on certain models to provide reduced sound characteristics (see the Custom Features and Options section of the appropriate product line for details). The Baltiguard Fan System, two-speed motors, or variable frequency drives can also be
EC - E 8
used to reduce sound during periods of non-peak thermal loads. For more information on sound and how it relates to evaporative cooling equipment, see Section "Technical Resources, Fundamentals of Sound". For detailed low sound selections, please consult your local BAC Balticare Representative.
Winterization
When a unit is shut down in freezing weather, the basin water must be protected by draining to an indoor auxiliary remote sump tank or by providing supplementary heat to the cold water basin. Supplementary heat can be provided by electric immersion heaters or in some cases, hot water, steam coils, or steam injectors. All exposed water piping, make-up lines, and spray pumps (if applicable) that do not drain at shutdown should be traced with electric heater tape and insulated. When dry operation is planned for low ambient conditions, centrifugal fan units should be supplied with oversized fan motors to prevent motor overload when the spray water is not operating. For remote sump applications, the spray water pump must be selected for the required flow at a total head which includes the vertical lift, pipe friction (in supply and suction lines) plus the required pressure at the inlet header of the water distribution system (14 kPa). A valve should always be installed in the discharge line from the pump to permit adjusting flow to the unit requirement. Inlet water pressure should be measured by a pressure gauge installed in the water supply riser at the spray water inlet, and adjusted to the specified inlet pressure.
Overview
Note: Axial fan units are not suitable for indoor installations.
Safety
Adequate precautions, appropriate for the installation and location of these products, should be taken to safeguard the public from possible injury and the equipment and the premises from damage. Operation, maintenance and repair of this equipment should be undertaken only by personnel qualified to do so. Proper care, procedures and tools must be used in handling, lifting, installing, operating, maintaining, and repairing this equipment to prevent personal injury and/or property damage.
Code Requirement
All evaporative condenser coils supplied from Europe, including desuperheater coils, are certified according to the European Pressure Equipment Directive 97/23/EC. Since November 1999 this Pressure Equipment Directive has been adopted by the national legislation of all EU and EFTA member states. The PED 97/23/EC specifies the design, manufacturing, quality and documentation requirements for pressure vessels and replaces previous national code requirements. BAC evaporative condenser coils fall under Category IV of the PED 97/23/EC reglementation and require a CE Declaration of Conformity which is supplied by BAC at time of shipment.
Baltimore Aircoil
EC - E 9
Standard PED Coil design (hot-dip galvanised) All BAC evaporative condenser coils, including bare serpentine coils, split circuit coils, extended surface coils and desuperheater coils are designed as standard for a maximum operating pressure of 23 bar (minimum -1 bar). Design temperatures are minimum: -20C and maximum +120C. All standard PED coils are pneumatically tested at 34 bar after fabrication. Optional High pressure PED coil design (hot dip galvanised) For specific refrigerants or applications requiring higher operating pressures (> 23 bar), the high pressure coil option is available for all hot-dip galvanised condenser coil types (see above under standard PED coil design). The high pressure coils are designed for a maximum operating pressure of 28 bar (min. -1 bar) and are pneumatically tested at 40 bar. Design temperatures are minimum -20C and maximum +120C. Optional Stainless Steel PED coil design Bare serpentine coils only (with or without split) are available in stainless steel AISI 304 or AISI 316 execution. All stainless steel coils are designed for a maximum operating pressure of 23 bar (min. -1 bar) and are pneumatically tested at 34 bar. Design temperature limits are minimum -20C and maximum +120C.
Evaporative Condensers
Check the system for non-condensable gases is done during system operation. First close the valve (V3) in the liquid line running from the receiver to the evaporator (king valve).
EC - E 10
Keep the compressor running and start pumping down the system. The compressor pressure will drop as the ammonia supply has been shut off and will finally cause the compressor to fall out (security). When this happens, simultaneously close the discharge valve V1 of the compressor. The condenser is now fully pumped up with the ammonia refrigerant (which is captured between valves V1 and V3 and cannot escape). Operate the evaporative condenser for at least two hours and measure the 5 temperatures (listed below) every 10 minutes until the pan water temperature is equal to the entering wet bulb temperature (T pan = WB in). When this happens, an equilibrium has been reached in the condenser and all 5 measured temperatures should be identical to each other. If the temperature (T1, T2) corresponding to the pressure in the evaporative condenser is higher than the entering wet bulb temperature by more than 1C, the system has an excessive amount of non-condensables (make sure that all gauges are accurate when checking for non-condensables). Five temperatures to be measured : 4. Entering wet bulb temperature at the condenser air inlet (WB in). 5. Discharge wet bulb temperature at the condenser outlet (WB out). 6. Pan (or remote sump) water temperature (T pan). 7. Temperature (T1) equivalent to refrigerant inlet pressure of the condenser. 8. Temperature (T2) equivalent to refrigerant discharge pressure of the condenser. Purge Connections The several recommended piping arrangements each show purge valves at two different locations, i.e. at the high point of the system and at each condensing coil outlet. Purging at the high point of the system can only be effective when the system is down. During normal operation the non-condensables are dispersed throughout the high velocity refrigerant vapour and too much refrigerant would be lost when purging from this high point. However, purging at the condenser coil outlet can be effectively accomplished during system operation. The non-condensables will carry through the condenser coil with the refrigerant liquid and vapour and tend to accumulate in the condensing coil outlet header and connection where the temperature and velocity are relatively low. Purge Piping All of the purge connections on the condenser coils plus the purge connection in the receiver may be cross connected to a single purge line, connected to an automatic purger. However, only one purge valve should be open at a time. Opening two or more valves tied together equalises the coil outlet pressures and the effect of the vertical drop legs is lost.
Overview
Desuperheaters
The discharge gas from ammonia reciprocating compressors is highly superheated. A desuperheater removes a portion of this superheat prior to the gas entering the condensing coil, and thereby reduces the load on the evaporative condenser. Within the normal range of singlestage compressor operation, discharge gas temperatures at 13 bar discharge pressure (36C) may run from 120C to 150C depending on the compression ratio, amount of suction gas superheat, and the compressor design. This represents up to 15% of the total heat rejection load. Other refrigerants and compressor types generally have much lower discharge gas temperatures than the ammonia reciprocating system so a desuperheater is usually impractical for these applications.
Baltimore Aircoil
EC - E 11
Evaporative Condensers
The desuperheater coil is located on top of the condenser, above the drift eliminators.
An enhanced surface coil encased by galvanised steel panels will be fitted onto the evaporative condenser in the discharge air stream. The coil has a design for low pressure drop and is in complete compliance to the PED code requirements for a 23 bar design pressure. Optional high pressure PED coils are available designed for 28 bar operating pressure. The coil is a two pass arrangement with the entering and leaving gas connections at the same end; thus keeping all coil connections at the same end of the evaporative condenser. The coil is hot dip galvanised after fabrication and mounted into a completely enclosed plenum with access doors to allow inspection and maintenance of the drift eliminators and spray section. The piping between the desuperheater coil and the condenser coil is to be field fabricated and installed by the contractor.
EC - E 12
Low temperature, multistage ammonia (R-717) refrigeration systems often use liquid subcooling between stages for more economical operation. However, subcooling coils in an evaporative condenser are seldom, if ever, used with an ammonia refrigeration system for several reasons and are not available from BAC: 1. Design condensing temperatures are generally lower with ammonia, thus limiting the amount of subcooling that can be obtained. 2. The density of ammonia liquid is approximately 37 pounds per cubic foot, less than half that of the normally used halocarbons, and static head losses are proportionately less. 3. The expansion devices and system designs normally used for ammonia systems are less sensitive to small amounts of flash gas. 4. The high latent heat of ammonia (approximately 480 Btu/lb versus 70 Btu/lb for R-22) results in comparatively small amounts of flash gas with a liquid line properly sized for low pressure drop.
Note: Subcooling coils are not available from BAC.
Overview
Warranties
Please refer to the Limitation of Warranties applicable to and in effect at the time of the sale/ purchase of these products.
Baltimore Aircoil
VXC - E 13
Evaporative Condensers
Product Detail
VXC Evaporative Condensers ............................................................... E14 Benefits ..................................................................................................... E16 Construction Details ................................................................................ E18 Custom Features and Options ................................................................ E20 Accessories ............................................................................................... E22 Engineering Data ..................................................................................... E24 Structural Support .................................................................................. E31 Engineering Specifications ..................................................................... E33
VXC - E 14
General Description
VXC Evaporative Condensers deliver fully rated thermal performance over a wide range of heat rejection and temperature requirements for various refrigerants. VXC and VXC-C models can be installed indoors and minimize sound levels. VXC-C models are designed to fit in standard dry van containers to minimize ocean freight costs. The Series VX occupies minimum floor space, provides year-round operating reliability and is ideal for sound sensitive applications.
Key Features
Suitable for indoor and outdoor installations Low sound Low ocean freight costs (VXC-C) Single side air inlet Low energy consumption Low installed cost Easy maintenance Reliable year-round operation Long service life Wide capacity range PED 97/23/EC coil design
Baltimore Aircoil
VXC - E 15
VXC - E 16
Benefits
Wide Capacity Range
Evaporative condenser capacity - The evaporative condensers are available in a broad range of unit capacities, with small capacity increments to permit close matching of unit size to design load. The VX line offers the widest selection of evaporative condensers in the industry to meet virtually every installation and application need.
Low Sound
Centrifugal Fan - Centrifugal fans have inherently low sound characteristics. Single Side Air Inlet - Particularly sound-sensitive areas can be accommodated by facing the quiet side (back panel) to the sound-sensitive direction.
Baltimore Aircoil
VXC - E 17
Easy Maintenance
Internal Access - The interior of the unit is easily accessible for adjusting the float valve, cleaning the strainer or flushing the basin.
The water level control is easily reached from the access door.
VXC - E 18
Construction Details
Upper Section
Lower Section
Baltimore Aircoil
VXC - E 19
3. Coil
Coil according to European Pressure Equipment Directive 97/23/EC Continuous serpentine, steel tubing Hot-dip galvanized after fabrication (HDGAF) Pneumatically tested at 34 bar standard coil Sloped tubes for free drainage of fluid
4. Drift Eliminators
UV resistant non-corrosive material, impervious to rot, decay and biological attack Three distinct changes in air direction to reduce drift loss significantly Assembled in easy to handle sections, which can be removed for access to the equipment interior
6. Centrifugal Fan(s)
Quiet Operation
8. Access Door
Circular access door
VXC - E 20
Coil Configurations
Each coil is manufactured according to the European Pressure Equipment Directive (PED) 97/23/EC (For more details, refer to the Evaporative Condenser "Overview" section) BAC condenser coils are standard available at a design pressure of 23 bar, and are pneumatically tested at 34 bar. Standard Serpentine Coil: The standard condensing coil is constructed of continuous lengths of all prime surface steel, hot-dip galvanised after fabrication (HDGAF).
Hot Dip Galvanised Coil
Multiple Circuit Coils (Split Coils): In general, multiple circuit coils are required primarily on halocarbon refrigerant systems where it is common practice to maintain individual compressor systems. Also, a circuit can be isolated to provide cooling of a water or glycol loop for compressor jacket cooling. A wide range of multiple circuit arrangements are available. Optional Extended Surface Coil: Coils are available with selected rows finned at 3 to 5 fins per inch for wet/dry applications. The coil is hot-dip galvanised after fabrication (HDGAF). Optional Stainless Steel Coil: Coils are available in Type 304L or 316L stainless steel for specialised applications. Optional High Pressure Coil: Coils are available with a design pressure of 28 bar and pneumatically tested at 40 bar. The Coil is hot-dip galvanised after fabrication (HDGAF). All coils are designed for low pressure drop with sloping tubes for free drainage of fluid.
Baltimore Aircoil
VXC - E 21
VXC - E 22
Accessories
Ladder, Safety Cage and handrails
In the event the owner requires easy access to the top of the unit, the unit can be furnished with ladders extending from the base of the unit to the top, as well as safety cages, and handrail packages.
Note: When these access options are employed, the unit must be equipped with steel drift eliminators.
Basin Heaters
Units exposed to below freezing ambient temperatures require protection to prevent freezing of the water in the cold water basin when the unit is idle. Factory-installed heaters, which maintain the water temperature at 4C, are a simple and inexpensive way of providing such protection. The heater package includes the heaters, a thermostat and a low level cut out switch to protect the heaters if the water level is too low. Standard electric heaters are selected for -18C ambient temperature.
Model No. VXC 14-28 36-65 72-97 110-135 150-205 221-454 495-516 562-680 715-908 990-1032 1124-1360 1430-1608 S288-S350 S403-S504 S576-S700
Heater -18C (kW) 1 x 1,5 1 x 1,5 1 x 2,5 1x3 1x4 1x6 2x4 2x5 2x6 4x4 4x5 4x6 1x6 2x4 2x6
Baltimore Aircoil
VXC - E 23
Discharge Hoods
Discharge hoods reduce the risk of re-circulation in tight enclosures by increasing discharge air velocity, and can be used to elevate the unit discharge above adjacent walls to comply with layout guidelines.
Desuperheater
Desuperheaters can be used in R-717 systems with reciprocating compressors. They increase the capacity of the standard model and extend the dry operation capacity. They are also effective in reducing the occurrence of visible plumes.
Steel Eliminators
Steel eliminators with Baltibond Corrosion Protection System are available for specific applications.
VXC - E 24
Engineering Data
REMARK: Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
1. Refrigerant in ND 100; 2. Refrigerant out ND 100; 3. Make-up; 4. Overflow; 5. Drain; 6. Access (models 14 through 135 have the access door at the back); For VXC 14 through VXC 135 : make-up ND 25; overflow ND 50; drain ND 50.; For VXC 150 through VXC 265 : make-up ND 50; overflow ND 80; drain ND 50.
Model
Operating Weight (kg) 660 740 830 900 1050 1170 1310 1330 1500 1810 1820 2080 2240 2510 2540 3210 3240 3670 3980 5860 6390 6435
Shipping Weight (kg) 600 670 760 830 920 1030 1160 1180 1330 1490 1500 1730 1800 2050 2080 2640 2670 2950 3255 4250 4770 4815
Heaviest Section Coil (kg) 580* 660* 480 540 920* 1030* 700 700 860 1000 1000 1200 1200 1440 1440 1720 1720 1980 2240 2630 3150 3150
Air Flow (m3/s) 2,3 2,2 2,5 2,4 4,6 5,0 4,8 5,3 5,5 5,8 7,5 7,1 10,4 9,9 10,9 13,3 15,8 15,7 16,9 21,9 21,2 22,7
Fan Motor (kW) (1x) 1,5 (1x) 1,5 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 4,0 (1x) 4,0 (1x) 4,0 (1x) 5,5 (1x) 5,5 (1x) 4,0 (1x) 7,5 (1x) 7,5 (1x) 7,5 (1x) 7,5 (1x) 11,0 (1x) 7,5 (1x) 11,0 (1x) 11,0 (1x) 15,0 (1x) 15,0 (1x) 15,0 (1x) 18,5
Water Flow (l/s) 2,2 2,2 2,2 2,2 4,7 4,7 4,7 4,7 4,7 7,1 7,1 7,1 9,5 9,5 9,5 13,9 13,9 13,9 13,9 19,2 19,2 19,2
Pump Motor (kW) (1x) 0,25 (1x) 0,25 (1x) 0,25 (1x) 0,25 (1x) 0,37 (1x) 0,37 (1x) 0,37 (1x) 0,37 (1x) 0,37 (1x) 0,75 (1x) 0,75 (1x) 0,75 (1x) 0,75 (1x) 0,75 (1x) 0,75 (1x) 1,5 (1x) 1,5 (1x) 1,5 (1x) 1,5 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2
L (mm) 914 914 914 914 1829 1829 1829 1829 1829 2737 2737 2737 3658 3658 3658 3645 3645 3645 3645 3550 3550 3550
W (mm) 1207 1207 1207 1207 1207 1207 1207 1207 1207 1207 1207 1207 1207 1207 1207 1438 1438 1438 1438 2397 2397 2397
H (mm) 2035 2245 2467 2683 2035 2245 2467 2467 2683 2578 2578 2813 2578 2813 2813 3093 3093 3328 3563 3585 3820 3820
VXC 14 VXC 18 VXC 25 VXC 28 VXC 36 VXC 45 VXC 52 VXC 59 VXC 65 VXC 72 VXC 86 VXC 97 VXC 110 VXC 125 VXC 135 VXC 150 VXC 166 VXC 185 VXC 205 VXC 221 VXC 250 VXC 265
Baltimore Aircoil
VXC - E 25
1. Refrigerant in ND 100; 2. Refrigerant out ND 100; 3. Make-up ND 50; 4. Overflow ND 80; 5. Drain ND 50; 6. Access
Model
Operating Weight (kg) 7600 7630 7705 8320 10225 10285 11270 11320 12500 15120 15220 15400 16655 20555 20755 22570 22770 25035
Shipping Weight (kg) 5525 5555 5630 6180 7170 7230 8125 8175 9260 10880 10980 11100 12355 14415 14615 16420 16550 18505
Heaviest Section (coil) (kg) 3850 3850 3850 4470 4710 4710 5700 5700 6690 3840 3840 3840 4470 5120* 5120* 5700 5700 6690
Air Flow (m3/s) 22,8 24,2 26,7 26,2 36,6 38,9 34,9 37,5 36,6 45,6 48,4 53,4 52,4 73,2 77,8 69,8 75,0 73,2
Fan Motor (kW) (1x) 18,5 (1x) 22,0 (1x) 30,0 (1x) 30,0 (1x) 30,0 (1x) 37,0 (1x) 30,0 (1x) 37,0 (1x) 37,0 (2x) 18,5 (2x) 22,0 (2x) 30,0 (2x) 30,0 (2x) 30,0 (2x) 37,0 (2x) 30,0 (2x) 37,0 (2x) 37,0
Water Flow (l/s) 25,2 25,2 25,2 25,2 38,5 38,5 38,5 38,5 38,5 50,4 50,4 50,4 50,4 77,0 77,0 77,0 77,0 77,0
Pump Motor (kW) (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (2x) 2,2 (2x) 2,2 (2x) 2,2 (2x) 2,2 (2x) 4 (2x) 4 (2x) 4 (2x) 4 (2x) 4
R717 Charge (kg) 163 163 163 195 197 197 245 245 293 327 327 327 390 395 395 490 490 585
L (mm) 3550 3550 3550 3550 5385 5385 5385 5385 5385 7226 7226 7226 7226 10903 10903 10903 10903 10903
W (mm) 2397 2397 2397 2397 2397 2397 2397 2397 2397 2397 2397 2397 2397 2397 2397 2397 2397 2397
H (mm) 4248 4248 4248 4483 4013 4013 4248 4248 4483 4248 4248 4248 4483 4013 4013 4248 4248 4483
VXC S288 VXC S300 VXC S328 VXC S350 VXC S403 VXC S429 VXC S455 VXC S482 VXC S504 VXC S576 VXC S600 VXC S656 VXC S700 VXC S806 VXC S858 VXC S910 VXC S964 VXC S1010
VXC - E 26
1. Refrigerant in ND 100; 2. Refrigerant out ND 100; 3. Make-up; 4. Overflow ND 80; 5. Drain ND 50; 6. Access; For VXC 357 through VXC 908: make-up ND 50; For VXC 1124 through VXC 1360 Make-up ND 80.
Model
Operating Weight (kg) 6940 8290 9580 11490 12680 14100 14430 16590 19140 22740 25240 28090
Shipping Weight (kg) 5300 6600 7860 8990 10200 11530 10600 13200 15700 17940 20380 23100
Heaviest Section (coil) (kg) 3940 4730 5510 5810 7010 8200 3940 4730 5510 5810* 7010 8200
Air Flow (m3/s) 34,3 31,6 34,4 51,2 50,0 52,0 68,6 63,2 68,8 102,4 100,1 104,0
Fan Motor (kW) (1x) 22,0 (1x) 22,0 (1x) 30,0 (2x) 18,5 (2x) 18,5 (2x) 22,0 (2x) 22,0 (2x) 22,0 (2x) 30,0 (4x) 18,5 (4x) 18,5 (4x) 22,0
Water Flow (l/s) 30,8 30,8 30,8 46,7 46,7 46,7 61,6 61,6 61,6 93,4 93,4 93,4
Pump Motor (kW) (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (2x) 4 (2x) 4 (2x) 4 (2x) 4 (2x) 4 (2x) 4
R717 Charge (kg) 181 218 250 250 349 390 362 435 499 581 699 780
L (mm) 3550 3550 3550 5388 5388 5388 7226 7226 7226 10903 10903 10903
W (mm) 3000 3000 3000 3000 3000 3000 3000 3000 3000 3000 3000 3000
H (mm) 4075 4310 4545 4075 4310 4545 4075 4310 4545 4075 4310 4545
VXC 357 VXC 399 VXC 454 VXC 562 VXC 620 VXC 680 VXC 714 VXC 798 VXC 908 VXC 1124 VXC 1240 VXC 1360
Baltimore Aircoil
VXC - E 27
1. Refrigerant in ND 100; 2. Refrigerant out ND 100; 3. Make-up; 4. Overflow ND 80; 5. Drain ND 50; 6. Access. For VXC 495 through VXC 1032 : Make-up ND50; For VXC 1430 through VXC 1608: Make-up ND 80.
Model
Heat Rejection (kW) 2133 2223 3081 3326 3464 4265 4446 6161 6652 6928
Operating Weight (kg) 12040 13030 17555 17735 19290 24185 26095 35200 35560 38665
Shipping Weight (kg) 8210 9170 11855 12035 13435 16520 18280 23680 23770 26845
Heaviest Section (coil) (kg) 5610 6550 8300 8300 9710 5610 6550 8300 8300 9710
Air Flow (m3/s) 40,0 39,4 56,1 62,3 60,4 80,0 78,8 112,2 124,6 120,8
Fan Motor (kW) (1x) 37,0 (1x) 37,0 (2x) 22,0 (2x) 30,0 (2x) 30,0 (2x) 37,0 (2x) 37,0 (4x) 22,0 (4x) 30,0 (4x) 30,0
Water Flow (l/s) 39,1 39,1 56,8 56,8 56,8 78,2 78,2 113,6 113,6 113,6
Pump Motor (kW) (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (2x) 4 (2x) 4 (2x) 4 (2x) 4 (2x) 4
R717 Charge (kg) 250 297 374 374 449 499 594 748 748 898
L (mm) 3550 3550 5388 5388 5388 7226 7226 10903 10903 10903
W (mm) 3607 3607 3607 3607 3607 3607 3607 3607 3607 3607
H (mm) 4310 4545 4310 4310 4545 4310 4545 4310 4310 4545
VXC 495 VXC 516 VXC 715 VXC 772 VXC 804 VXC 990 VXC 1032 VXC 1430 VXC 1544 VXC 1608
VXC - E 28
1. Refrigerant in ND 100; 2. Refrigerant out ND 100; 3. Make-up ND 50; 4. Overflow ND 80; 5. Drain ND 50; 6. Access Fan covers are shipped loose.
Model
Operating Weight (kg) 5940 6415 6440 7450 8730 8735 9430 9470 10260
Shipping Weight (kg) 4250 4770 4795 5315 6135 6145 6945 7030 7830
Heaviest Section (coil) (kg) 2630 3150 3150 3665 3885 3885 4685 4685 5485
Air Flow (m3/s) 20,6 20,1 21,7 22,5 31,5 33,5 32,2 35,5 34,7
Fan Motor (kW) (1x) 15,0 (1x) 15,0 (1x) 18,5 (1x) 22,0 (1x) 18,5 (1x) 22,0 (1x) 22,0 (1x) 30,0 (1x) 30,0
Water Flow (l/s) 19,2 19,2 19,2 19,2 29,0 29,0 29,0 29,0 29,0
Pump Motor (kW) (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4
R717 Charge (kg) 104 129 129 154 156 156 195 195 234
L (mm) 3550 3550 3550 3550 5385 5385 5385 5385 5385
W (mm) 2245 2245 2245 2245 2245 2245 2245 2245 2245
H (mm) 3585 3820 3820 4055 3585 3585 3820 3820 4055
VXC C220 VXC C250 VXC C265 VXC C287 VXC C325 VXC C340 VXC C380 VXC C408 VXC C426
General Notes
1. Standard refrigerant connection sizes are ND 100 BSP MPT inlet and outlet (for models VXC 14 through 28 refrigerant connection sizes are ND 80 BSP MPT), consult your local BAC representative for size and location. Other connection sizes are available on special order. Refrigerant connections are standard bevelled for welding. 2. Make up, overflow, suction, drain connections and access door can be provided on side opposite to that shown; consult your BAC Balticare representative. 3. Unit height is indicative, for precise value refer to certified print. 4. Shipping/operating weights indicated are for units without accessories such as sound attenuators, discharge hoods, etc. Consult factory certified prints to obtain weight additions and the heaviest section to be lifted. 7. Fan kW is at 0 Pa ESP. To operate against external static pressure up to 125 Pa, increase each fan motor one size. 8. Refrigerant charge listed is R 717 operating charge. To determine operating charge of R22 refrigerants, multiply by: 1,93. For R134A, multiply by: 1,98. 5. The standard right hand arrangement as shown has the air inlet side on the right when facing the connection end (for double pump units there is no difference between right and left hand arrangement; make-up connection only at one side). Left hand can be furnished by special order. Water and refrigerant connections are always located on the same end of the unit. 6. For indoor applications of evaporative condensers, the room may be used as a plenum with ductwork attached to the discharge only. If inlet ductwork is required, an enclosed fan section must be specified; consult your BAC representative for details.
Baltimore Aircoil
VXC - E 29
Sound Attenuation
XA + XB Sound Attenuation
1. Access Door; L= Unit Length; W= Unit Width; H.= Unit Height (see Engineering Data).
XC Sound Attenuation
1. Access Door; L= Unit Length; W= Unit Width; H.= Unit Height (see Engineering Data).
VXC - E 30
VXC
Dimensions (mm) H1 W1 L1 L2 Intake + solid bottom XA 902 1816 2731 3645 3645 3645 3645 5480 140 225 300 400 500 690 690 XB 160 270 370 470 XC N.A. N.A. N.A. N.A.
Weights (kg) Discharge XA 130 175 280 360 XB 150 220 350 420 XC N.A. N.A. N.A. N.A. XA 270 400 580 760 Total XB 310 490 720 890 XC N.A. N.A. N.A. N.A.
XA, XB, XC Disch. Att. Int. Att. XA, XB XC 14 - 28 36 - 65 72 - 97 110 - 135 150 - 205 221 - 265 S288 - S350 S403 - S504 S576 - S700 S806 - S1010 357 - 454 562 - 680 714 - 908 1124 - 1360 495 - 516 715 - 804 990 - 1032 1430 - 1608 4(1) 4(1) 4 4 4 4 4 4 7 7 4 4 7 7 4 4 7 7 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 2 4 1 2 2 4 1 2 2 4 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2352 2352 2352 2352 2583 3542 3542 3542 3542 3542 4145 4145 4145 4145 4752 4752 4752 4752
N.A. 1090 1030 1829 N.A. 1090 1030 2737 N.A. 1090 1030 3658 3728 1600 1420 3645 4687 2070 1955 3550 4687 2070 2365 3550 4687 2070 2365 5385 4687 2070 2365 7226
520 1070 940 1120 2270 650 1330 1220 1470 2940 800 1640 1350 1620 3250
7322 1380 1640 3220 1320 1600 3280 2700 3240 6500
4687 2070 2365 10903 10998 1920 2320 4540 1660 2180 4480 3580 4500 9020 5290 2560 2965 3550 5290 2560 2965 5388 5290 2560 2965 7226 3645 790 940 1850 710 880 1820 1500 1820 3670
5480 1080 1330 2590 900 1210 2490 1980 2540 5080 7322 1580 1880 3700 1420 1760 3640 3000 3640 7340
5290 2560 2965 10903 10994 2160 2660 5180 1800 2420 4980 3960 5080 10160 5897 2560 3575 3550 5897 2560 3575 5388 5897 2560 3575 7226 3645 840 990 1900 810 1030 2130 1650 2020 4030
5480 1150 1400 2660 1020 1410 2920 2170 2810 5580 7322 1680 1980 3800 1620 2060 4260 3300 4040 8060
5897 2560 3575 10903 10994 2300 2800 5320 2040 2820 5840 4340 5620 11160
(1)
VXC 14, VXC 18, VXC-36 and VXC-45 + Attenuator are shipped in 3 pieces
(2) Intake Attenuator: Access opening is 775 mm high, 405 mm wide and is located at each end of the unit. Discharge Attenuator : Access opening is 405 mm high, 1170 mm wide and is located at blank off side of the unit (VXC14-28 has 650 mm width)
Baltimore Aircoil
VXC - E 31
Structural Support
REMARK: Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
The recommended support arrangement for units consists of parallel I-beams running the full length of the unit, spaced as shown in the following drawing. Besides providing adequate support, the steel also serves to raise the unit above any solid foundation to ensure access to the bottom of the unit. To support units in an alternate steel support arrangement, consult your BAC Balticare Representative.
Model
A Unit Length (mm) 914 1829 2737 3658 3645 3550 3550 5385 7226
B Unit width (mm) 1207 1207 1207 1207 1438 2397 2397 2397 2397
C D Center dis. Center dis. Length Width (mm) (mm) 750 1664 2572 3492 3492 3238 3238 5074 6914 1153 1153 1153 1153 1378 2397 2327 2327 2327
G (mm) -
Mounting holes 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 8 8
VXC 14-28 VXC 36-65 VXC 72-97 VXC 110-135 VXC 150-205 VXC 221-265 VXC S288-S350 VXC S403-S504 VXC S576-S700
VXC - E 32
Model
A Unit Length (mm) 10903 3550 5388 7226 10903 3550 5388 7226 10903 3550 5385
B Unit width (mm) 2397 3000 3000 3000 3000 3607 3607 3607 3607 2245 2245
C D Center dis. Center dis. Length Width (mm) (mm) 10586 3238 5074 6914 10586 3238 5074 6914 10586 3238 5074 2327 2934 2934 2934 2934 3537 3537 3537 3537 2175 2175
Mounting holes 16 4 8 8 16 4 8 8 16 4 8
VXC S806-S1010 VXC 357-454 VXC 562-680 VXC 714-908 VXC 1124-1360 VXC 495-516 VXC 715-804 VXC 990-1032 VXC 1430-1608 VXC C220-C287 VXC C325-C426
1. Outline of Unit; 2. Mounting Holes 22 mm; 3. Outline of attenuator (optional XA or XB);4. Support Channel attached to optional XA or XB attenuator; 5.+3. Outline of Attenuator (optional XC); 6.+4. Support Channels attached to optional XC attenuator; 7. Unit; 8. Sound Attenuator; 9. Air Intake.
Notes:
1. The recommended support arrangement for VX units consists of parallel I-beams extending the full length of the unit. Supports and anchor bolts are to be designed and furnished by others. 2. All supporting beams are to be flush and level at top and must be oriented relative to gage line as shown. 3. Recommended design loads for each unit support beam should be 70% of the total unit operating weight applied as a uniform load to each of the unit beams. The support beam(s) for the optional intake attenuator(s) needs to carry attenuator only, uniform load of 250 kg/m. Beams should be designed in accordance with standard structural practice. For the maximum allowable deflection of beams under the unit refer to above table. 4. All mounting holes have a diameter of 22 mm at the locations shown. 5. If vibration isolators are used, a rail or channel must be provided between the unit (and optional attenuator) and the isolators to provide continuous unit support. Additionally the support beams must be designed to accommodate the overall length and mounting hole location of the isolators that may differ from those of the unit. Refer to vibration isolator drawings for these data.
Baltimore Aircoil
VXC - E 33
Engineering Specifications
General
A. General: Furnish and install, _____ factory assembled evaporative condenser(s) of counterflow blow-through design, with single side entry, conforming in all aspects to the specifications and schedule as shown on the plans. B. Capacity: The evaporative condenser(s) shall be warranted by the manufacturer to have condensing capacity of _____ kW heat rejection, operating with ____ refrigerant and ___C condensing temperature and ___C entering wet-bulb temperature. C. Warranty: The manufacturers standard equipment warranty shall be for a period of one year from the date of startup or eighteen months from the date of shipment, whichever ends first. D. Quality Assurance: The manufacture shall have Management System certified by an accredited registrar as complying with the requirements of ISO-9001:2000 to ensure consistent quality of products and services.
Products
1.0 Evaporative Condenser Materials and Components
General: All steel panels and structural elements shall be constructed from heavy-gauge, Z600 hot-dip galvanized steel, with cut edges given a protective coating of zinc-rich compound.
Baltimore Aircoil
VCL - E 35
Evaporative Condensers
Product Detail
VCL Evaporative Condensers ............................................................... E36 Benefits ..................................................................................................... E38 Construction Details ................................................................................ E40 Custom Features and Options ................................................................ E41 Accessories ............................................................................................... E43 Engineering Data ..................................................................................... E44 Structural Support .................................................................................. E48 Engineering Specifications ..................................................................... E49
VCL - E 36
General Description
VCL Evaporative Condensers deliver fully rated thermal performance over a wide range of heat rejection and temperature requirements for various refrigerants. VCL models can be installed indoors, minimize sound levels, and are available to accommodate limited ceiling or enclosure heights. The Series VL minimizes installation costs, provides year-round operating reliability, and is ideal for sound sensitive applications.
Key Features
Suitable for indoor and outdoor installations Suitable for locations with limited ceiling or enclosure heights and roof top installations Low sound Single side air inlet Low energy consumption Low installed cost Easy maintenance Reliable year-round operation Long service life PED 97/23/EC coil design
Baltimore Aircoil
VCL - E 37
VCL - E 38
Benefits
Installation and Application Flexibility
Indoor Installations Centrifugal fans can overcome the static pressure imposed by external ductwork, allowing this type of unit to be installed indoors. Low Profile Models The fan section of low profile units is adjacent to the casing section to yield models suitable for use in height sensitive installations. Low profile models are available in heights of 1585 mm up to 2560 mm.
Low Sound
Centrifugal Fan - Centrifugal fans have inherently low sound characteristics.
Single Side Air Inlet - Particularly sound-sensitive areas can be accommodated by facing the quiet side (back panel) to the sound-sensitive direction.
Easy Maintenance
Internal Access - The interior of the unit is easily accessible for adjusting the float valve, cleaning the strainer or flushing the basin.
Modular Design
Baltimore Aircoil
VCL - E 39
VCL - E 40
Construction Details
Three distinct changes in air direction to reduce drift loss significantly Assembled in easy to handle sections, which can be removed for access to the equipment interior
3. Coil
Coil according to European Pressure Equipment Directive 97/23/EC Continuous serpentine, steel tubing Hot-dip galvanized after fabrication (HDGAF)
6. Centrifugal Fan(s)
Quiet Operation
Pneumatically tested at 34 bar standard coil Sloped tubes for free drainage of fluid Bleed line with metering valve installed from pump discharge to overflow
4. Drift Eliminators
UV resistant non-corrosive material, impervious to rot, decay and biological attack
8. Access Door
Circular access door
Baltimore Aircoil
VCL - E 41
Coil Configurations
Each coil is manufactured according to the European Pressure Equipment Directive (PED) 97/23/ EC (For more details, refer to the Evaporative Condenser "Overview" section) BAC condenser coils are standard available at a design pressure of 23 bar, and are pneumatically tested at 34 bar. Standard Serpentine Coil: The standard condensing coil is constructed of continuous lengths of all prime surface steel, hot-dip galvanised after fabrication (HDGAF). Multiple Circuit Coils (Split Coils): In general, multiple circuit coils are required primarily on halocarbon refrigerant systems where it is common practice to maintain individual compressor systems. Also, a circuit can be isolated to provide cooling of a water or glycol loop for compressor jacket cooling. A wide range of multiple circuit arrangements are available. Optional Extended Surface Coil: Coils are available with selected rows finned at 3 to 5 fins per inch for wet/dry applications. The coil is hot-dip galvanised after fabrication (HDGAF). Optional Stainless Steel Coil: Coils are available in Type 304L or 316L stainless steel for specialised applications. Optional High Pressure Coil: Coils are available with a design pressure of 28 bar and pneumatically tested at 40 bar. The Coil is hot-dip galvanised after fabrication (HDGAF). All coils are designed for low pressure drop with sloping tubes for free drainage of fluid.
VCL - E 42
Remote Sump
The use of an auxiliary sump within a heated space is the most satisfactory way to protect sump water from freezing. When the circulating pump is shut off, all the water in the water distribution, in suspension and in the sump will drain freely to the auxiliary sump.
Note: For detailed information on the calculation of the remote sump tank, please refer to the section "Technical Resources, Selection of Remote Sump Tank".
Baltimore Aircoil
VCL - E 43
Accessories
Electric Water Level Control Package
The electric water level control replaces the standard mechanical make-up valve when a more precise water level control is required. This package consists of a float switch mounted in the basin and a solenoid activated valve in the make-up water line. The valve is slow closing to minimize water hammer.
Basin Heaters
Units exposed to below freezing ambient temperatures require protection to prevent freezing of the water in the cold water basin when the unit is idle. Factory-installed heaters, which maintain the water temperature at 4C, are a simple and inexpensive way of providing such protection. The heater package includes the heaters, a thermostat and a low level cut out switch to protect the heaters if the water level is too low. Standard electric heaters are selected for -18C ambient temperature.
Model No. VCL VCL 042 - 079 VCL 084 - 119 VCL 131 VCL 133 VCL 140 - 159 VCL 167-235 VCL 239 - 257 VCL 258 VCL 285 - 321 Heaters -18C (kW) 3 4 5 4 5 2x4 2x5 2x4 2x5
Desuperheater
Desuperheaters can be used in R-717 systems with reciprocating compressors. They increase the capacity of the standard model and extend the dry operation capacity. They are also effective in reducing the occurrence of visible plumes.
Steel Eliminators
Steel eliminators with Baltibond Corrosion Protection System are available for specific applications.
VCL - E 44
Engineering Data
REMARK: Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
1. Refrigerant in ND 100; 2. Refrigerant out ND 100; 3. Access; 4. Make-up ND 25; 5. Overflow: ND 50 on VCL 042-119 & 133, ND 80 on VCL 131 & 140-159; 6. Drain ND 50; 7. Spray Pump; 8. Fan Motor.
Model VCL042-H VCL048-G VCL054-H VCL058-G VCL065-H VCL071-J VCL073-H VCL079-J VCL084-K VCL096-J VCL102-K VCL111-L VCL115-K VCL119-M VCL133-M VCL131-L VCL140-M VCL148-L VCL159-M
Operating Weight (kg) 1610 1800 1810 1990 2005 2025 2190 2220 2530 2810 2820 2840 3090 2845 3120 3560 3570 3930 3940
Shipping Weight (kg) 1100 1270 1280 1440 1460 1490 1640 1670 1750 2010 2020 2080 2280 2090 2350 2490 2500 2830 2840
Air Flow (m3/s) 7,9 6,7 7,6 6,4 7,4 8,1 7,2 7,9 11,4 10,2 11,2 12,3 10,8 12,4 13,0 13,6 14,8 13,4 14,6
Fan Motor (kW) (1x) 4,0 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 4,0 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 4,0 (1x) 5,5 (1x) 4,0 (1x) 5,5 (1x) 7,5 (1x) 5,5 (1x) 7,5 (1x) 11 (1x) 7,5 (1x) 15 (1x) 15 (1x) 11 (1x) 15 (1x) 11 (1x) 15
Water Flow (l/s) 5,9 5,9 5,9 5,9 5,9 5,9 5,9 5,9 9,0 9,0 9,0 9,0 9,0 9,0 9,0 12,1 12,1 12,1 12,1
Pump Motor (kW) (1x) 0,55 (1x) 0,55 (1x) 0,55 (1x) 0,55 (1x) 0,55 (1x) 0,55 (1x) 0,55 (1x) 0,55 (1x) 0,75 (1x) 0,75 (1x) 0,75 (1x) 0,75 (1x) 0,75 (1x) 0,75 (1x) 0,75 (1x) 1,1 (1x) 1,1 (1x) 1,1 (1x) 1,1
L1 (mm) 3350 3350 3350 3350 3350 3350 3350 3350 4560 4560 4560 4560 4560 4560 4560 5480 5480 5480 5480
L2 (mm) 1820 1820 1820 1820 1820 1820 1820 1820 2730 2730 2730 2730 2730 2730 2730 3650 3650 3650 3650
W (mm) 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250 1250
H (mm) 1585 1855 1855 2015 2015 2015 2230 2230 1855 2090 2090 2090 2350 2090 2350 2090 2090 2350 2350
Baltimore Aircoil
VCL - E 45
1. Refrigerant in ND 100; 2. Refrigerant out ND 100; 3. Access; 4. Make-up ND 50; 5. Overflow: ND 80. 6. Drain ND 50; 7. Spray Pump; 8. Fan Motor.
Model VCL167-K VCL171-N VCL185-L VCL208-N VCL209-L VCL219-L VCL235-N VCL258-O VCL239-L VCL257-M VCL285-O VCL286-N VCL299-O VCL321-P
Operating Weight (kg) 5260 4740 5290 5310 5860 6420 5880 6570 7270 7280 7300 7990 8010 8110
Shipping Weight (kg) 3650 3170 3680 3700 4210 4750 4240 4790 5030 5040 5060 5690 5710 5810
Air Flow (m3/s) 17,4 23,3 19,6 22,8 19,3 18,9 22,3 23,0 20,7 22,6 25,6 23,9 25,3 27,5
Fan Motor (kW) (1x) 7,5 (1x) 18,5 (1x) 11,0 (1x) 18,5 (1x) 11,0 (1x) 11,0 (1x) 18,5 (1x) 22,0 (1x) 11,0 (1x) 15,0 (1x) 22,0 (1x) 18,5 (1x) 22,0 (1x) 30,0
Water Flow (l/s) 17,9 17,9 17,9 17,9 17,9 17,9 17,9 17,9 24,2 24,2 24,2 24,2 24,2 24,2
Pump Motor (kW) (1x) 1,1 (1x) 1,1 (1x) 1,1 (1x) 1,1 (1x) 1,1 (1x) 1,1 (1x) 1,1 (1x) 1,1 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2
R-717 Charge (kg) 110 85 110 110 143 165 143 165 183 183 183 219 219 219
L1 (mm) 4560 4560 4560 4560 4560 4560 4560 4560 5480 5480 5480 5480 5480 5480
L2 (mm) 2730 2730 2730 2730 2730 2730 2730 2730 3650 3650 3650 3650 3650 3650
W (mm) 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400 2400
H (mm) 2090 1855 2090 2090 2350 2560 2350 2560 2350 2350 2350 2560 2560 2560
General Notes
1. All models are single coil section units. Fan cycling results only in on-off operation. For additional steps of control, the Baltiguard Drive System and two-speed fan motors are available. More precise capacity control can be obtained with modulating fan discharge dampers. 2. Make up, overflow, suction, drain connections and access door can be provided on side opposite to that shown; consult your BAC representative. 3. Unit height is indicative, for precise value refer to certified print. 4. Shipping/operating weights indicated are for units without accessories such as sound attenuators, discharge hoods, etc. Consult factory certified prints to obtain weight additions and the heaviest section to be lifted. 5. For indoor applications of evaporative condensers, the room may be used as a plenum with ductwork attached to the discharge only. If inlet ductwork is required, an enclosed fan section must be specified; consult your BAC representative for details. 6. Fan kW is at 0 Pa ESP. To operate against external static pressure up to 125 Pa, increase each fan motor one size. 7. Refrigerant charge listed is R 717 operating charge. To determine operating charge of R22 refrigerants, multiply by: 1,93. For R134A, multiply by: 1,98. 8. Refrigerant connections are standard bevelled for welding.
VCL - E 46
Sound Attenuation
HS Horizontal Intake Sound Attenuation
1.Discharge attenuator, 2. Access Door, 3. Intake Attenuator; W & H = Unit Dimensions (See Engineering Data).
1.Discharge attenuator, 2. Access Door, 3. Intake Attenuator; W & H = Unit Dimensions (See Engineering Data).
Baltimore Aircoil
VCL - E 47
1.Discharge attenuator, 2. Access Door, 3. Intake Attenuator, 4. Plenum; W & H = Unit Dimensions (See Engineering Data).
Dimensions (mm) Model No HS VCL 042-079 VCL 084-133 VCL 131-159 VCL 167-258 VCL 239-321 2390 2640 2640 2640 2640 L2 HD 3125 3375 3375 3375 3375 VS 2010 2010 2010 2010 2010 L1 HS,HD,V S 1820 2730 3650 2730 3650 HS 430 465 465 665 665 Intake Attenuator HD 625 660 660 980 980 VS 548 541 566 756 761
Maximum Weight (kg) Discharge Attenuator HS 210 295 365 465 565 HD 230 315 385 500 605 VS 192 264 334 419 529 HS 640 760 830 1130 1230 Total HD 855 975 1045 1480 1585 VS 740 805 900 1175 1290
Note: All units with HS or VS attenuator ship in 2 pieces. All units with HD attenuator ship in 3 pieces.
VCL - E 48
Structural Support
REMARK: Do not use for construction. Refer to factory certified dimensions & weights. This brochure includes data current at time of publication, which should be reconfirmed at the time of purchase. In the interest of product improvement, specifications, weights and dimensions are subject to change without notice. Up-to-date engineering data and more can be found at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com.
The recommended support arrangement for units consists of parallel I-beams running the full length of the unit, spaced as shown in the following drawing. Besides providing adequate support, the steel also serves to raise the unit above any solid foundation to ensure access to the bottom of the unit. To support units in an alternate steel support arrangement, consult your BAC Balticare Representative.
Model No VCL VCL 042-079 VCL 084-119 VCL 131 VCL 133 VCL 140-159 VCL 167-235 VCL 239-257 VCL 258 VCL 285-321
A (mm) 2426 3334 4255 3334 4255 3334 4255 3334 4255
B (mm) 1193 1193 1193 1193 1193 2343 2343 2343 2343
Notes:
1. The recommended support arrangement for VL units consists of two parallel I-beams extending the full length of the unit. Supports and anchor bolts are to be designed and furnished by others. 2. All supporting beams are to be flush and level at top and must be oriented relative to gage line as shown. 3. Recommended design loads for each unit support beam should be 70% of the total unit operating weight applied as a uniform load to each of the unit beams. Beams should be designed in accordance with standard structural practice. For the maximum allowable deflection of beams under the unit refer to above table. 4. All mounting holes have a diameter of 22 mm at the locations shown. 5. If vibration isolators are used, a rail or channel must be provided between the unit and the isolators to provide continuous unit support. Additionally the support beams must be designed to accommodate the overall length and mounting hole location of the isolators that may differ from those of the unit. Refer to vibration isolator drawings for these data.
Baltimore Aircoil
VCL - E 49
Engineering Specifications
General
A. General: Furnish and install, _____ factory assembled evaporative condenser(s) of counterflow blow-through design, with single side entry, conforming in all aspects to the specifications and schedule as shown on the plans. The condenser shall be of unitary design with all moving parts factory mounted and aligned. B. Capacity: The evaporative condenser(s) shall be warranted by the manufacturer to have condensing capacity of _____ kW heat rejection, operating with ____ refrigerant and ___C condensing temperature and ___C entering wet-bulb temperature. C. Warranty: The manufacturers standard equipment warranty shall be for a period of one year from the date of startup or eighteen months from the date of shipment, whichever ends first. B. Quality Assurance: The manufacture shall have Management System certified by an accredited registrar as complying with the requirements of ISO-9001:2000 to ensure consistent quality of products and services.
Products
1.0 Evaporative Condenser Materials and Components
General: All steel panels and structural elements shall be constructed from heavy-gauge, Z600 hot-dip galvanized steel, with cut edges given a protective coating of zinc-rich compound.
Baltimore Aircoil
CXV - E 51
Evaporative Condensers
Product Detail
CXV Evaporative Condensers ............................................................... E52 Benefits ..................................................................................................... E54 Construction Details CXV Models ........................................................ E56 Construction Details CXV-D Models ..................................................... E57 Custom Features and Options ................................................................ E58 Accessories ............................................................................................... E61 Engineering Data CXV Models .............................................................. E63 Structural Support CXV Models ........................................................... E67 Engineering Data CXV-D Models .......................................................... E68 Structural Support CXV-D Models ....................................................... E70 Engineering Specifications ..................................................................... E71
CXV - E 52
General Description
CXV Evaporative Condensers deliver fully rated thermal performance over a wide range of heat rejection and temperature requirements for various refrigerants. Standard design features directly address todays environmental concerns by minimizing refrigerant charge and energy consumption. The Series 1500 minimizes installation costs, provides year-round operating reliability, and simplifies maintenance requirements.
Key Features
Low energy consumption Easy maintenance Reduced refrigerant charge Low installed cost Application flexibility Reliable year-round operation Long service life PED 97/23/ EC coil design
Baltimore Aircoil
CXV - E 53
CXV - E 54
Benefits
Low Energy Consumption
Evaporative Cooling Equipment minimizes the energy consumption of the entire system because it provides lower operating temperatures. The owner saves money while conserving natural resources and reducing environmental impact. Evaporative Condensers provide lower condensing temperatures and can offer significant horsepower savings over conventional air-cooled and water-cooled condensing systems. CXV provides heat rejection at the lowest possible energy input and maintenance requirements via: - High efficiency, low kW axial fans - Patented combined flow technology, which reduces evaporation directly off the coil, minimizing the potential for scaling and fouling - Parallel flow of air and spray water, which eliminates scale-promoting dry spots - Multiple Fan Motor System: independent fan motor and drive assembly per fan, which allows for extra steps of capacity control.
Easy Maintenance
Access - Hinged access doors provide easy access to the unit interior. In addition, all CXV models are provided with an internal walkway as standard. An internal walkway is available as an option on CXV-D models. Spacious Interior Provides easy access to the cold water basin, drift eliminators, fan drive system and condensing coil. Access to Spray Distribution Parallel flow of air and spray water over the coil allows for inspection and access to the top of the coil during full operation.
Baltimore Aircoil
CXV - E 55
Application Flexibility
The unit shown ships in two pieces to minimise shipping and rigging costs
Replacement applications Single air inlet models are designed to mount directly on existing support steel of both crossflow and counterflow units. Coil configurations Alternate coil configurations and materials available. Highest capacity in the industry CXV-D models offer the highest single cell capacity of any evaporative condenser in the industry. Projects benefit from fewer required cells, lower overall fan kW, and fewer piping connections.
CXV - E 56
1. Heavy-Duty Construction
Z600 hot-dip galvanized steel panels
6. BACross Wet Deck Surface with Integral Drift Eliminators (Not Shown)
Plastic material Impervious to rot, decay and biological attack Designed and manufactured by BAC
Baltimore Aircoil
CXV - E 57
1. Heavy-Duty Construction
Heavy-gauge Z600 galvanized steel frame
Pneumatically tested at 34 bar standard coil Sloped tubes for free drainage of fluid Multiple circuit coils are possible
6. Coil Section
Coil according to European Pressure Equipment Directive 97/23/EC, standardized at 23 bar design pressure. Continuous serpentine, steel tubing
CXV - E 58
Coil Configurations
Each coil is manufactured according to the European Pressure Equipment Directive (PED) 97/23/ EC (For more details, refer to the Evaporative Condenser "Overview" section) BAC condenser coils are standard available at a design pressure of 23 bar, and are pneumatically tested at 34 bar. Standard Serpentine Coil: The standard condensing coil is constructed of continuous lengths of all prime surface steel, hot-dip galvanized after fabrication (HDGAF) Optional Stainless Steel Coil: Coils are available in Type 304L and 316L stainless steel for specialized applications. Optional High Pressure Coil: Coils are available with a design pressure of 28 bar, with a test pressure of 40 bars. The Coil is hot-dip galvanised after fabrication (HDGAF). Multiple Refrigerant Circuit Coils (Split Coils): In general, multiple circuit coils are required primarily on halocarbon refrigerant systems where it is common practice to maintain individual compressor systems. Also, a circuit can be isolated to provide cooling of a water or glycol loop for compressor jacket cooling. A wide range of multiple circuit arrangements is available. All coils are designed for low pressure drop with sloping tubes for free drainage of fluid.
Baltimore Aircoil
CXV - E 59
CXV - E 60
Baltimore Aircoil
CXV - E 61
Accessories
External Service Platform with Ladder, Safety Cage and Handrails
In the event the owner requires easy access to the top of the unit, the unit can be furnished with a platform and ladders extending from the base of the unit to the platform, as well as safety cages, and handrail packages.
Note: Top air inlet screens are recommended with this option.
Internal Ladder(s)
For access to the motor and drive assemblies internal ladders are available on all models.
For access to the motor and drive assemblies on models CXV-207 thru -481, and all CXV-D models, an upper service platform with ladder and handrails is available. Safety gates are available for handrail openings.
Basin Heaters
Units exposed to below freezing ambient temperatures require protection to prevent freezing of the water in the cold water basin when the unit is idle. Factory-installed heaters, which maintain the water temperature at 4C, are a simple and inexpensive way of providing such protection. The heater package includes the heaters, a thermostat and a low level cut out switch to protect the heaters if the water level is too low. Standard electric heaters are selected for -18C ambient temperature.
Model No. CXV CXV 074 - 093 CXV 117 - 147 CXV 153 - 193 CXV 207 - 296 CXV 338 - 435 CXV 283 - 327 CXV 416 - 481 CXV D645 - D792 CXV D791 - D944 Heater -18C (kW) 1x4 1x6 1x6 1x8 2x6 2x6 2x8 2 x 14 2 x 14
CXV - E 62
Stand-by Pump
A factory mounted stand-by pump is available, including non-return valves in each pump piping line. In case of a pump failure, there can be switched over to the stand-by pump, eliminating the unit shut down period as much as possible.
Baltimore Aircoil
CXV - E 63
1. Refrigerant in ND 100; 2. Refrigerant out ND 100; 3. Make-up ND 15; 4. Overflow ND 80; 5. Drain ND 50; 6. Access.
Model No. CXV CXV 74 CXV 80 CXV 84 CXV 89 CXV 93 CXV 117 CXV 123 CXV 131 CXV 137 CXV 147 CXV 153 CXV 164 CXV 173 CXV 184 CXV 193
Operating Weight (kg) 3400 3410 3420 3590 3600 4960 4980 5000 5240 5260 6290 6310 6320 6650 6660
Shipping Weight (kg) 2350 2360 2370 2520 2530 3370 3390 3410 3610 3640 4150 4180 4190 4480 4490
Air Flow (m3/s) 12,5 14,3 15,7 13,9 15,3 20,0 22,0 25,1 21,4 24,5 25,6 29,2 32,1 28,6 31,4
Fan Motor (kW) (1x) 4 (1x) 5,5 (1x) 7,5 (1x) 5,5 (1x) 7,5 (2x) 4 (2x) 4 (2x) 5,5 (2x) 4 (2x) 5,5 (2x) 4 (2x) 5,5 (2x) 7,5 (2x) 5,5 (2x) 7,5
Water Flow (l/s) 12,0 12,0 12,0 12,0 12,0 18,0 18,0 18,0 18,0 18,0 24,0 24,0 24,0 24,0 24,0
Pump Motor (kW) (1x) 1,1 (1x) 1,1 (1x) 1,1 (1x) 1,1 (1x) 1,1 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2 (1x) 2,2
L (m) 1861 1861 1861 1861 1861 2775 2775 2775 2775 2775 3690 3690 3690 3690 3690
W (mm) 2385 2385 2385 2385 2385 2385 2385 2385 2385 2385 2385 2385 2385 2385 2385
H (mm) 3980 3980 3980 3980 3980 3980 3980 3980 3980 3980 3980 3980 3980 3980 3980
CXV - E 64
1. Refrigerant in ND 100; 2. Refrigerant out ND 100; 3. Make-up ND 25; 4. Overflow ND 80; 5. Drain ND 50; 6. Access.
Model No. CXV CXV 207 CXV 214 CXV 229 CXV 241 CXV 253 CXV 258 CXV 269 CXV 280 CXV 288 CXV 296 CXV 338 CXV 354 CXV 369 CXV 379 CXV 396 CXV 411 CXV 424 CXV 435
Operating Weight (kg) 6970 6980 7450 7450 7480 7490 7950 7980 7990 8500 10810 10820 10870 10880 11590 11640 11650 12410
Shipping Weight (kg) 4560 4570 4960 4970 5000 5010 5410 5440 5450 5890 7070 7090 7140 7150 7760 7810 7820 8490
Air Flow (m3/s) 38,0 40,4 31,7 34,9 37,6 39,9 33,9 36,5 38,8 38,1 47,9 52,7 56,7 60,3 51,2 55,1 58,6 57,5
Fan Motor (kW) (2x) 11 (2x) 11 (2x) 5,5 (2x) 7,5 (2x) 11 (2x) 11 (2x) 7,5 (2x) 11 (2x) 11 (2x) 11 (3x) 5,5 (3x) 7,5 (3x) 11 (3x) 11 (3x) 7,5 (3x) 11 (3x) 11 (3x) 11
Water Flow (l/s) 45,0 45,0 45,0 45,0 45,0 45,0 45,0 45,0 45,0 45,0 54,0 54,0 54,0 54,0 54,0 54,0 54,0 54,0
Pump Motor (kW) (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 5,5 (1x) 5,5 (1x) 5,5 (1x) 5,5 (1x) 5,5 (1x) 5,5 (1x) 5,5 (1x) 5,5
L (m) 3690 3690 3690 3690 3690 3690 3690 3690 3690 3690 5520 5520 5520 5520 5520 5520 5520 5520
W (mm) 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985 2985
H (mm) 4790 4790 4790 4790 4790 4790 4790 4790 4790 4790 4935 4935 4935 4935 4935 4935 4935 4935
Baltimore Aircoil
CXV - E 65
1. Refrigerant in ND 100; 2. Refrigerant out ND 100; 3. Make-up ND 25; 4. Overflow ND 80; 5. Drain ND 50; 6. Access.
Model No. CXV CXV 283 CXV 297 CXV 309 CXV 327 CXV 416 CXV 437 CXV 454 CXV 468 CXV 481
Operating Weight (kg) 9050 9080 9100 9650 13230 13270 13320 13330 14150
Shipping Weight (kg) 5850 5880 5900 6380 8400 8440 8490 8500 9220
Air Flow (m3/s) 35,0 38,5 41,5 43,1 53,0 58,3 62,8 66,7 65,3
Fan Motor (kW) (2x) 5,5 (2x) 7,5 (2x) 11 (2x) 11 (3x) 5,5 (3x) 7,5 (3x) 11 (3x) 11 (3x) 11
Water Flow (l/s) 45,0 45,0 45,0 45,0 54,0 54,0 54,0 54,0 54,0
Pump Motor (kW) (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 4 (1x) 5,5 (1x) 5,5 (1x) 5,5 (1x) 5,5 (1x) 5,5
L (m) 3690 3690 3690 3690 5520 5520 5520 5520 5520
W (mm) 3610 3610 3610 3610 3610 3610 3610 3610 3610
H (mm) 4790 4790 4790 4790 4935 4935 4935 4935 4935
CXV - E 66
1. Intake Attenuator; 2. Discharge Attenuator; Ht = H (unit height) + 735 mm; W = Unit Width, see general Engineering data.
Model No CXV 74 - 93 117 - 147 153 - 193 207 - 296 338 - 435 283 - 327 416 - 481 D 1345 1345 1345 1500 1500 2005 2005
Dimensions (mm) Ht 4715 4715 4715 5525 5665 5525 5665 Intake 100 130 175 250 375 250 375
Weight (kg) Discharge 140 210 255 270 385 310 440
Baltimore Aircoil
CXV - E 67
Model CXV CXV 074 - 093 CXV 117 - 147 CXV 153 - 193 CXV 207 - 296 CXV 283 - 327 CXV 338 - 435 CXV 416 - 481
Dimensions (mm) A 2325 2325 2325 2925 3550 2925 3550 B 2400 2400 C 255 255 255 255 255 270 270
No of 16 mm Anchorbolts 4 4 4 4 4 8 8
Notes:
1. The recommended support arrangement for the units consists of parallel I-beams extending the full length of the unit. Supports and anchor bolts are to be designed and furnished by others. 2. All supporting beams are to be flush and level at top and must be oriented relative to gage line as shown. 3. Recommended design loads for each unit support beam should be 70% of the total unit operating weight applied as a uniform load to each of the unit beams. Beams should be designed in accordance with standard structural practice. For the maximum allowable deflection of beams under the unit see table. 4. All mounting holes have a diameter of 22 mm at the locations shown. 5. If vibration isolators are used, a rail or channel must be provided between the unit (and optional attenuator) and the isolators to provide continuous unit support. Additionally the support beams must be designed to accommodate the overall length and mounting hole location of the isolators that may differ from those of the unit. Refer to vibration isolator drawings for these data.
CXV - E 68
1. Refrigerant in ND100; 2. Refrigerant out ND100; 3. Make-Up ND40, Overflow ND80; 5. Drain ND50; 6. Access at both ends.
Weight Model No. CXV-D Shipping (kg) 12710 12785 12790 14045 14050 14150 14560 14570 14670 16055 16155 16200 Operating (kg) 18555 18625 18630 19990 19990 20090 21780 21785 21885 23395 23495 23540 Heaviest Section (kg) 3650 3650 3650 4280 4280 4280 4259 4259 4259 5003 5003 5003 Air flow (m3/s) Fan Motor (kW) Pump Motor (kW) (2) 5,5 (2) 5,5 (2) 5,5 (2) 5,5 (2) 5,5 (2) 5,5 (2) 5,5 (2) 5,5 (2) 5,5 (2) 5,5 (2) 5,5 (2) 5,5 R717 Charge (kg) 298 298 298 354 354 354 342 342 342 410 410 410 W (mm) 7328 7328 7328 7328 7328 7328 8013 8013 8013 8013 8013 8013
Dimensions L (mm) 3632 3632 3632 3632 3632 3632 4245 4245 4245 4245 4245 4245 H (mm) 5767 5767 5767 5767 5767 5894 5869 5869 5869 5869 5996 5996
CXV-D645L CXV-D686L CXV-D717L CXV-D729L CXV-D763L CXV-D792L CXV-D791L CXV-D827L CXV-D857L CXV-D876L CXV-D906L CXV-D944L
83,6 92,2 99,6 91,2 98,4 104,7 106,4 115,7 123,1 113,3 120,6 131,2
22 30 37 30 37 45 30 37 45 37 45 55
Baltimore Aircoil
CXV - E 69
1. Intake Attenuator; 2. Discharge Attenuator; W = Unit Width, see general Engineering data.
Weight (kg) Both Intake Sides 685 808 Discharge 477 563
CXV - E 70
No of 16 mm Anchorbolts 12 12
Notes:
1. The recommended support arrangement for the units consists of parallel I-beams extending the full length of the unit. Supports and anchor bolts are to be designed and furnished by others. 2. All supporting beams are to be flush and level at top and must be oriented relative to gage line as shown. 3. Recommended design loads for each unit support beam should be 70% of the total unit operating weight applied as a uniform load to each of the unit beams. Beams should be designed in accordance with standard structural practice. For the maximum allowable deflection of beams under the unit see table. 4. All mounting holes have a diameter of 22 mm at the locations shown. 5. If vibration isolators are used, a rail or channel must be provided between the unit (and optional attenuator) and the isolators to provide continuous unit support. Additionally the support beams must be designed to accommodate the overall length and mounting hole location of the isolators that may differ from those of the unit. Refer to vibration isolator drawings for these data.
Baltimore Aircoil
CXV - E 71
Engineering Specifications
General
A. General: Furnish and install, _____ factory assembled evaporative condenser(s) of induced draft design, with single side air entry and vertical air discharge. Overall dimensions shall not exceed approximately _____ mm x _____ mm, with an overall height not exceeding approximately _____mm. Operating weight shall not exceed _____ kg. The evaporative condenser shall be Baltimore Aircoil Model ____________. (Alternate) General: Furnish and install, _____ factory assembled evaporative condenser(s) of induced draft design, with dual side air entry and vertical air discharge. Overall dimensions shall not exceed approximately _____ mm x _____ mm, with and overall height not exceeding approximately _____mm. Operating weight shall not exceed _____ kg. The evaporative condenser shall be Baltimore Aircoil Model ____________. B. Capacity: The evaporative condenser(s) shall be warranted by the manufacturer to have condensing capacity of _____ kW heat rejection, operating with ____ refrigerant at ___C condensing temperature and ___C entering wet-bulb temperature. C. Warranty: The manufacturers standard equipment warranty shall be for a period of one year from the date of startup or eighteen months from the date of shipment, whichever ends first. D. Quality Assurance: The manufacture shall have Management System certified by an accredited registrar as complying with the requirements of ISO-9001:2000 to ensure consistent quality of products and services.
Products
1.0 Evaporative Condenser Materials and Components
1.1 Baltiplus Corrosion Resistant Construction: Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all steel panels and structural elements shall be constructed from heavy-gauge, Z600 hot-dip galvanized steel, with all sheared edges given a protective coating of zinc-rich compound and the exterior protected with the Baltiplus Corrosion Protection. (Alternate 1.1) Baltibond Corrosion Resistant Construction: Unless otherwise noted in this specification, all steel panels and structural members shall be protected with the BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System. The system shall consist of Z600 hot dip galvanised steel prepared in a four-step (clean, pre-treat, rinse and dry) process with an electrostatically sprayed, thermosetting hybrid polymer fuse-bonded to the substrate during a thermally activated curing stage monitored by a 23-step quality assurance program. Or for CXV-D models: General: Casing panels shall be constructed of corrosion resistant, fiberglass, reinforced polyester (FRP).
CXV - E 72
(Alternate 3.1) The cold water basin shall be constructed of heavygauge Type 304 or 316 stainless steel panels and structural members. Basin shall include a depressed section with drain/ cleanout connection. The basin area under the wet deck surface shall be sloped toward the depressed section to facilitate cleaning. 3.2 The cold water basin shall include a drain/clean-out connection; a steel strainer; a brass make-up valve; over flow connection; and a water recirculation pump assembly. a. Cold water basin shall be designed so that the strainer, makeup valve and float, and pump assembly are easily accessible without removing any of the unit panels or other components. b. Lift-out steel strainer shall be supplied with perforated openings sized smaller than the water distribution nozzle orifices and an integral anti-vortexing hood to prevent air entrainment. c. Water recirculation pump shall be a close-coupled, bronze-fitted centrifugal pump equipped with a mechanical seal, mounted on the basin and piped from the suction strainer to the water distribution system. i. The pump shall be installed with adequate drains so that it may drain freely when the basin is drained. ii. The pump assembly shall include an integral metering valve and bleed line to control the bleed rate from the pump discharge to the overflow connection. iii. The pump motor shall be totally enclosed fan cooled (TEFC) type suitable for _____ volt, ____ phase, ______ Hz electrical service. d. On installations requiring a remote sump, the evaporative condenser shall be modified to accommodate the use of an independent sump and pump for recirculating water (by others). i. The recirculating water pump, steel strainer, make-up valve, and integral bleed line assemblies shall be omitted from the evaporative condenser scope of supply. ii. The evaporative condenser shall be supplied with a cold water basin outlet sized and located as indicated on the drawings for gravity drain to the remote sump. iii. The water distribution system shall have a design operating pressure of 14 kPa at the evaporative condenser spray water inlet connection. 3.3 The heat transfer section shall consist of BACross wet deck surface with integral drift eliminators for CXV and BACrossII wet deck surface with integral drift eliminators for CXV-D for cooling the spray water leaving the coil to optimize the thermal performance of the evaporative condenser. a. The wet deck surface and integral drift eliminators shall be formed from plastic material. b. The wet deck surface and integral drift eliminators shall be impervious to rot, decay, fungus, and biological attack. 3.4 Combined Inlet Shields: Combined inlet shields shall be separate from the wet deck surface and removable to allow easy access for inspection of the air/water interface at the air inlet side of the equipment. Combined inlet shields shall prevent UV-light and debris from entering the unit, as well as prevent water splash out during fan cycling. They shall be constructed of maintenance free, corrosion and UV resistant material. 3.5 Plenum Access: A large, hinged access door shall be provided for access to the coil, drift eliminators and fan plenum section. The water make-up valve, float ball and suction strainer shall be easily accessible.
5.0 Sound
5.1 Sound Level: To maintain the quality of the local environment, the maximum sound pressure levels (dB) measured 15 m from the condenser operating at full fan speed shall not exceed the sound levels detailed below.
63
125
250
500
1000
2000
4000
8000
dB(A)
Baltimore Aircoil
TSU - F 1
Product Detail
ICE CHILLER Thermal Storage Products .......................................... F2 Benefits ........................................................................................................ F4 Proven Technology ..................................................................................... F7 Construction Details TSU-M - Internal Melt Application ..................... F9 Engineering Data TSU-M ........................................................................ F10 Engineering Specifications TSU-M ........................................................ F18 Construction Details TSU-C/D - External Melt Application ............... F19 Engineering Data TSU-C/D ..................................................................... F20 Engineering Specifications TSU-C/D ..................................................... F27 Engineering Considerations ICE CHILLER Products ..................... F28
TSU - F 2
Key Features
Lowest first cost Reduced energy cost Variable capacity Improved system reliability Reduced maintenance Environmentally friendly Proven technology
Baltimore Aircoil
TSU - F 3
TSU - F 4
Benefits
Lowest First Cost
Systems with ice thermal storage can be installed at the same or lower first cost than traditional systems when designed with the colder supply water available from ice. The savings that result from the use of smaller chillers and cooling towers, reduced pump and pipe sizes and less connected horsepower, offset the cost of the ice thermal storage equipment. Additional savings can be found when using lower temperature air distribution, which allows reduced ductwork and fan sizes. Smaller Chillers and Heat Rejection Equipment: By designing the system around 24-hour per day chiller operation, the size of the chillers and cooling towers or air-cooled condensers required for an ice system is significantly reduced, when compared to conventional chillers and heat rejection equipment sized for the instantaneous peak load. A typical thermal storage design includes chillers that provide 50 to 60% of the peak cooling load. The balance of the cooling requirement is provided from the ice storage system. Reduced Pump and Pipe Sizes: Pump and pipe sizes are also reduced in a properly designed ice storage system. Substantial savings in the chilled water distribution loop are realized when the system design incorporates reduced flow rates that result from using a larger temperature range in the water loop. Use of a larger temperature range, for example 10C instead of the more traditional 5.5C temperature range results in a reduction of pipe size. Condenser water pipe sizes are reduced due to lower flow requirements for the smaller chiller. Pump savings due to reduced chilled water and condenser water flow rates are also realized.
Reduced Cooling Coil and Supply Air Fan Sizes: Cooling coils sized using lower supply water temperatures and traditional supply air temperatures are generally smaller due to fewer rows. The reduction in rows leads to lower supply fan kW.
Baltimore Aircoil
TSU - F 5
Reduced Air Handling Equipment: When the air distribution is designed with lower supply air temperatures, the size of the ductwork, fans and fan motors are reduced. Reduced Electrical Distribution: Smaller chillers, heat rejection equipment and pumps require less horsepower than a traditional system, which results in smaller transformers, switchgear, wire sizes and starter panels. Reduced Generator Size: If a facility has a generator for daily or back-up power, the size of the generator will be significantly reduced when the peak electrical load of the facility is reduced using ice storage.
TSU - F 6
Variable Capacity
The ice thermal storage system will maintain a constant supply temperature regardless of the variations in instantaneous cooling demand. The flow and entering water temperature set the instantaneous capacity.
Reduced Maintenance
The ice thermal storage coils have no moving parts so very little maintenance is required. Because the chillers, pumps and heat rejection equipment are smaller, ice storage systems will have less maintenance than a traditional system. The ice thermal storage system also allows a chiller to undergo routine maintenance during the day when the ice storage can handle the system load.
Environmentally Friendly
Reducing energy consumption and using electricity at night will reduce global warming. Electricity generated at night generally has a lower heat rate (lower fuel use per power output), and therefore lower carbon dioxide and greenhouse gas emissions resulting in less global warming. The California Energy Commission concluded that the use of electricity at night created a 31% reduction in air emissions over the use of electricity during the day. With smaller chillers, an ice thermal storage system reduces the amount of refrigerant in a system. Most refrigerants in use today are slated to be banned in the future under the Montreal Protocol because they contribute to global warming. Using smaller amounts of refrigerant helps to save the ozone and reduce global warming.
Baltimore Aircoil
TSU - F 7
Proven Technology
BAC has successfully applied ice thermal storage technology to thousands of installations worldwide. BAC has the application and system experience to assist you in the design, installation and operation of your ice storage system. BAC has supplied ICE CHILLER Thermal Storage Products for projects that range in size from 90 to 125,000 ton-hours (0,3 to 441,3 MWh). Installations include office buildings, hospitals, manufacturing processes, schools, universities, sports arenas, produce storage facilities, hotels and district cooling applications. The ICE CHILLER Product line includes a variety of factory-assembled units. For large applications, where space is limited or factory-assembled units are not cost effective, ICE CHILLER Thermal Storage Coils are available for installation in field-erected tanks. The BAC product offering provides system design flexibility. Ice can be built using ammonia or various glycols on steel coils and is used to provide either chilled water or glycol to the cooling system. This flexibility, combined with a broad range of application experiences, allows B.A.C. to provide a cost-effective product to meet your specific requirements.
CNES
TSU - F 8
Academic Hospital
Granada Centre
Baltimore Aircoil
TSU - F 9
1. Covers
Watertight Heavy-gauge Z600 Hot-dip galvanized steel panels Insulated with 50 mm extruded polystyrene insulation
3. Glycol Connections
Threaded connections Flanged connections (optional)
8. Wall Panel
Heavy-gauge glavanised steel with double brake flanges Extruded polystyrene insulation Contributes to total insulating value of 3,1mC/W
9. Sight Tube
Visual indicator of the amount of ice remaining in unit
5. Primary Liner
Single piece 48-hour integrity test before shipment
TSU - F 10
Tank Water Coil Glycol Connection Volume Volume Size ND (l) (l) (mm) 11320 22110 28250 34640 985 1875 2320 2990 50 80 80 80
Tank Water Coil Glycol Connection Volume Volume Size ND (l) (l) (mm) 8820 17250 22030 27020 770 1460 1810 2280 80 80 80 80
General Notes
1. All dimensions are in mm. Weights are in kg. 2. Unit should be continuously supported on a flat level surface. 3. All connections are threaded 4. H1 = installed height. Coils are capped for shipping and storage. Add 75 mm for shipping height.
Baltimore Aircoil
TSU - F 11
Load Profile
A daily load profile is the hourbyhour representation of cooling loads for a 24hour period. Most HVAC applications use a daily load profile to determine the amount of storage required. Some HVAC systems apply a weekly load profile. For conventional airconditioning systems, chillers are selected based on the peak cooling load. For ice storage systems, the chillers are selected based on the kWh of cooling required and a defined operating strategy. Typical HVAC Load Profile Thermal storage systems provide much flexibility for varying operating strategies as long as the total kWh selected are not exceeded. This is why an accurate load profile must be provided when designing an ice storage system. Load profiles take many different shapes based on the application. Figure 1 illustrates a typical HVAC load profile for an office building with a 1750 kW peak cooling load and a 12hour cooling requirement. The shape of this curve is representative of most HVAC applications. For preliminary equipment selections, BAC's ICE CHILLER Thermal Storage Unit Selection Program can generate a similar load profile. Information required is the estimated building peak cooling load and duration of the cooling load.
TSU - F 12
The AirConditioning & Refrigeration Institute (ARI) has published Guideline T, "Specifying the Thermal Performance of Cool Storage Equipment." The purpose of Guideline T is to establish the minimum user specified data and supplier specified performance data. Design data provided by the engineer includes: System Loads, Flow Rates and Temperatures. Table 1 shows all necessary Ice Storage system data needed for a Thermal Storage selection.
Operating Strategies
Once the load profile is generated, the next step in selecting Thermal Storage equipment is to define an operating strategy or in other words, determine the hours per day during which the glycol chiller is allowed to operate. Which operating strategy to use is dependent upon the load profile (application), the utility rate structure, the energy cost and the equipment first cost. In other words, the economical balance between the system installation and operating cost or the payback period must be calculated. There are 2 different operating strategies, either full or partial storage. Full Storage Systems store all the cooling capacity required during the off peak periods and eliminate the need to operate the chiller(s) during the utility on-peak period. This strategy shifts the largest amount of electrical demand and results in the lowest operating cost. However, the equipment first cost is considerably higher than partial storage systems due to larger chiller and storage requirement and full storage is therefore seldom used. Partial Storage Systems require that the chiller(s) operate also during the on-peak period. The partial storage system allowing the glycol chiller to run for 24 hours per day at its full capacity is most commonly used as it results in the smallest chiller selection. In many cases, the smaller chiller selection is the driving force for an ice storage system because of lower installed electrical kW, smaller refrigerant charge, smaller cooling towers or other heat rejection equipment (lower noise), smaller standby chillers (if required), lower capital and maintenance cost, ... Other partial storage operating strategies stop the chiller a few hours per day when electricity cost are high and/or where non-cooling electricity usage are important (so when the chiller operation would increase the electrical demand). It is however important to know that the more hours the chiller is stopped during the day, the larger its size will be. Furthermore, if the chiller is stopped during the cooling period, the size of the storage equipment needs to be increased. If the chiller is stopped during the non-cooling period, the ice build time is reduced and therefore lower glycol temperatures are required and the chiller COP is reduced. Besides determining when the chiller should run or be stopped, an other aspect of operating strategy is if during melt-out, priority is given to the chiller or to the ice to cover the presented cooling load. In a chiller priority system the chiller always operates at full capacity. When the cooling load exceeds the chiller performance, the excess is covered by the melting ice. A constant portion of the load is covered by the chiller while the variation in load is covered by the ice. In an ice priority system, a constant part of the load is covered by the ice, where the variation in load is taken by the chiller. Because the chiller does not continuously operate at its maximum capacity, it will be oversized versus the chiller priority system. Ice priority systems result in oversized ice and chiller selections and are therefore seldom used. Normal practice is that partial storage systems using chiller priority with 24h chiller operation are most commonly used.
Baltimore Aircoil
TSU - F 13
Modes of Operation
The modular ICE CHILLER Thermal Storage Unit can operate in any of five distinct operating modes. These modes of operation provide the flexibility required by building operators to meet their daily HVAC cooling requirements. Ice Build: In this operating mode, ice is built by circulating a 25% solution (by weight) of inhibited ethylene glycol at negative temperatures through the coils contained in the ICE CHILLER Thermal Storage Unit. During this operating mode, the chiller's operating conditions are monitored and the chiller is turned off when the minimum supply glycol temperature off the chiller is reached. Optionally, the ICE LOGIC Ice Quantity Meter is available to control the chiller operation. The Figure below illustrates typical chiller supply Chiller Supply Temperatures temperatures for 8, 10 and 12 hour build cycles. For a typical 10hour build time, the supply glycol temperature is never lower than -5,5C. As the graph illustrates, for build times exceeding 10 hours, the minimum glycol temperature is greater than -5,5C. For build times less than 10 hours, the minimum glycol temperature will be lower than -5,5C at the end of the build cycle. This performance is based on a chiller flow rate associated with a 3T range. When a larger temperature range is the basis of the chiller selection, the chiller supply temperatures will be lower than shown in the figure below. Ice Build with Cooling: When cooling loads exist during the ice build period, some of the cold ethylene glycol used to build ice is diverted to the cooling load to provide the required cooling. The amount of glycol diverted is determined by the building loop set point temperature. BAC recommends that this mode of operation be applied on systems using primary/secondary pumping (See page 5, figure 4). This reduces the possibility of damaging the cooling coil or heat exchanger by pumping cold glycol, lower than 0C, to this equipment. Cooling Ice only: In this operating mode the chiller is off. The warm return ethylene glycol solution iscooled to the desired set point temperature by melting ice stored in the modular ICE CHILLER Thermal Storage Unit. Cooling Chiller only: In this operating mode the chiller supplies all the building cooling requirements. Glycol flow is diverted around the thermal storage equipment to allow the cold supply glycol to flow directly to the cooling load. Temperature set points are maintained by the chiller. Cooling Ice with Chiller: In this operating mode, cooling is provided by the combined operation of the chiller and thermal storage equipment. The glycol chiller pre-cools the warm return glycol. The partially cooled glycol solution then passes through the ICE CHILLER Thermal Storage Unit where it is cooled by the ice to the design temperature.
TSU - F 14
System Schematics
Two basic flow schematics are applied to select ICE CHILLER Thermal Storage Units. The below figure illustrates a single piping loop with the chiller installed upstream of the thermal storage equipment. This design allows the thermal storage system to operate in four of the five possible operating modes. They are Ice Build, Cooling-Ice Only, Cooling-Chiller Only and CoolingIce with Chiller. For this figure the following control logic is applied:
Single Loop Chiller Upstream
MODE Ice Build Cooling Ice Only Cooling Chiller Only Cooling Ice with Chiller
CHILLER On Off On On
P-1 On On On On
Valve V-1 modulates in response to temperature sensor, TS-1. Valve V-2 could be positioned to either maintain a constant flow, less than P-1, or modulate in response to the return glycol temperature from the cooling load. When the building loop contains chilled water, a heat exchanger must be installed to separate the glycol loop from the buildings chilled water loop. On applications where an existing water chiller is available, it can be installed in the chilled water loop to reduce the load on the thermal storage system.
Baltimore Aircoil
TSU - F 15
This design should not be used when there is a requirement to build ice and provide cooling. This would require the cold return glycol from the thermal storage equipment be pumped to the cooling load or heat exchanger. Since the glycol temperature is below 0C, the cooling coil or heat exchanger is subject to freezing. The flow schematic illustrated in the below figure details a primary/secondary pumping loop with the chiller located upstream of the thermal storage equipment. This design allows the system to operate in all five operating modes.
Valve V-1 and Valve V-2 modulate, depending on the operating mode, in response to temperature sensor, TS-1. The benefit provided by the primary/secondary pumping loop is that the system can build ice and provide cooling without fear of freezing a cooling coil or heat exchanger. This system design also allows for different flow rates in each of the pumping loops. When the flow rates in the pumping loops are different, the glycol flow rate in the primary loop should be greater than or equal to the glycol flow rate in the secondary loop. If not, colder supply glycol temperatures from the primary loop are needed to guarantee the design TS-1 set point (because there is always a mix with warm return glycol from the secondary loop. This reduces the chiller COP. At very large flow rate differences, negative glycol temperatures out of the TSU would be needed to obtain TS-1 (which is impossible) As in the single loop schematic, a heat exchanger and a base water chiller can be added to the system schematic. Variations to these schematics are possible but these are the most common for thermal storage systems. One common variation positions the chiller downstream of the thermal storage equipment. This design is used when the glycol temperatures off the ice cannot be maintained for the entire cooling period. By positioning the chiller downstream of the ice, the chiller is used to maintain the required supply temperature. In both of the above figures, the chiller is installed upstream of the ice. This offers two significant advantages compared to system designs that locate the chiller downstream of the ice. First, the chiller operates at higher glycol temperatures to precool the return glycol. This enables the chiller to operate at a higher capacity, which reduces the amount of ice required. Second, since the chiller is operating at higher evaporator temperatures, the efficiency of the chiller is improved.
TSU - F 16
Chiller Performance
Most packaged chillers can provide a wide range of glycol discharge temperatures and are suited for thermal storage applications. Chiller types applied to thermal storage applications include reciprocating, rotary screw and centrifugal. The chiller type used depends on capacity, glycol discharge temperature, efficiency, condenser type, and refrigerant. Chiller capacity and glycol discharge temperature must be evaluated when designing a thermal storage system. Different glycol discharge temperatures are required for various operating modes that affect the chiller capacity. The chiller capacity provided at -5,5C is considerably less than the chiller capacity with a 6C glycol discharge temperature. Chillers selected for use with the BAC's ICE CHILLER Thermal Storage Units should be able to provide -5,5C glycol when applied to a 10-hour build cycle. Longer build times result in higher glycol temperatures at the end of the build period while shorter build times require the chiller to supply glycol colder than -5,5C. The chiller capacity required could limit the use of a specific chiller type on small applications. The nominal capacity range for each chiller type is shown in the table below.
Nominal Capacity (kW) Range 50 850 kW 450 4200 kW 600 7000 kW+
Centrifugal and rotary screw chillers have the highest efficiencies with COPs from 5,9 to 4,7 at 6C chiller discharge temperature and 4,0 to 3,2 when providing -5,5C glycol. Reciprocating chillers are less efficient and have COPs ranging from 4,1 to 3,2 when providing 6C glycol and 3,2 to 2,7 when making ice at -5,5C. The heat rejection function of an ice storage system can be handled by any of three types of refrigerant condensers: aircooled, water-cooled or evaporative. An aircooled condenser removes heat from the refrigerant and condenses it by forcing air over an extended surface coil through which the refrigerant vapour is circulated. The latent heat of the refrigerant is removed by sensibly heating the air. The condenser capacity is determined by the ambient dry bulb temperature. A water-cooled condenser with a cooling tower rejects heat from a refrigeration system in two steps. First, the refrigerant is condensed by the water flow in the condenser. Second, heat is rejected to the atmosphere as the condenser water is cooled by a cooling tower. The evaporative condenser combines a watercooled condenser and cooling tower in one piece of equipment. It eliminates the sensible heat transfer step of the condenser water. This allows a condensing temperature substantially closer to the design wetbulb temperature. Variations in condensing temperatures should be considered when evaluating chiller performance. Reduced night-time ambient dry bulb and wet bulb temperatures offer lower condensing temperatures which help offset the reduction in chiller capacity and chiller efficiency.
Baltimore Aircoil
TSU - F 17
The percent of nominal chiller capacity at various glycol discharge temperatures are shown below.
Glycol Discharge Temperature 6,0 C 2,0 C -5,5 C Percent of Nominal Capacity* 97 % 85 % 66 %
Nominal capacity ratings are based on: 30C condenser water or 46C condensing temperature for cooling operation 26,5C condenser water or 40,5C condensing temperature for ice build operation The refrigerant types for chillers also vary. Centrifugal chillers are available for use with R-134a, R-123 and R-22. Reciprocating and rotary screw chillers are available for use with R134a, R-22 and R-717 (ammonia).
TSU - F 18
Baltimore Aircoil
TSU - F 19
1. Tank
The tank is constructed of heavy-gauge, Z600 hot-dip galvnised steel, reinforced with full-length structural steel angles beneath and on all for sides. All seams are welded to ensure watertight construction. A zinc rich coating is applied to all exposed edges and welds.
5. Covers
Sectional insulated tank covers are proided with B.A.C.s exclusive BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System.
2. Insulation
Extruded polystyrene insulation is provided between the tank and the exterior panels. The insulation is 80 mm thick on the tank sides and ends, and 50 mm thick on the bottom and inside the covers
3. Exterior Panels
Exterior panels sealed at all seams provide a complete vapor barrier and protect the insulation. They are furnished with B.A.C.s exclusive BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System.
4. Air Pump
Centrifugal regenerative blower for field mounting to supply low pressure air for agitation of the water. Pump is complete with a weather protected inlet air filter and is suitable for outdoor applications.
8. Air Distribution
Low pressure air from the air pump is distributed below the coils through multiple perforated PVC pipes.
TSU - F 20
1. Coil Connections; 2. Make-up ND50; 3. Overflow ND50; 4. Water Out; 5. Water In; 6. Drain ND50; 7. ICE LOGIC.
Model TSU
Op. Sh. Weight Air Pump Weight (kg) (kW) (kg) 9370 10560 10980 13070 15240 17460 19550 2550 2780 2860 3270 3860 4225 4635 0,75 0,75 0,75 0,75 0,75 1,1 1,1
Water Volume (l) 6520 7440 7760 9390 11020 12640 14270
Pull Down Volume (l) 165 208 227 265 303 341 379
Coil Volume (l) 297 340 368 453 510 566 657
R-717 Charge (kg) 128 147 159 196 220 244 281
Water Conn. In ND (mm) 80+2x40 80+2x40 80+2x40 80+2x40 80+2x40 100+2x50 100+2x50
Water Conn. H Out (mm) ND (mm) 80 80 80 80 80 100 100 2160 2160 2160 2160 2160 2160 2160
H1 mm
L (mm)
W (mm)
Model TSU
Op. Weight (kg) 16935 20205 23475 26970 30240 250105 29145 33505 37545
Sh. Weight (kg) 4045 4635 5180 5950 6495 5495 6130 7085 7765
Water Volume (l) 12270 14880 17450 20020 22640 18700 21960 25120 28470
Pull Down Volume (l) 341 416 454 530 606 492 606 681 757
Coil Volume (l) 595 680 821 906 1020 878 1020 1161 1275
R-717 Charge (kg) 257 294 354 391 440 379 440 501 550
Water Conn. In ND (mm) 100+2x50 100+2x50 100+2x50 100+2x50 150+2x80 150+2x80 150+2x80 150+2x80 150+2x80
Water Conn. H Out (mm) ND (mm) 100 100 100 100 150 150 150 150 150 2160 2160 2160 2160 2160 2160 2160 2160 2160
H1 (mm)
L (mm)
W (mm)
Baltimore Aircoil
TSU - F 21
1. Coil Connections; 2. Make-up ND50; 3. Overflow ND50; 4. Water Out; 5. Water In; 6. Drain ND50; 7. ICE LOGIC.
Model TSU
Water Conn. Pull Down R-717 Water Coil Volume H Volume Charge Conn. In ND Out (l) (mm) ND (l) (kg) (mm) (mm) 833 1022 1173 1363 1514 1779 1529 1784 2067 2322 2605 3115 660 770 892 1002 1125 1345 150+2x80 150+2x80 150+2x80 200+2x80 200+2x80 200+2x80 150 150 150 200 200 200 2160 2160 2160 2160 2160 2160
H1 (mm)
L (mm)
W (mm)
Model TSU
Water Pull Down R-717 Water Conn. Coil Volume H Volume Charge Conn. In ND Out (l) (mm) (l) (kg) (mm) ND (mm) 1510 1630 1780 1890 2230 2750 3115 3455 3795 4330 1187 1345 1492 1638 1869 200+2x80 200+2x80 200+2x80 200+2x80 200+2x80 200 200 200 200 200 2415 2415 2415 2415 2415
H1 (mm)
L (mm)
W (mm)
TSU - F 22
Data Per Coil Model TSC TSC-95C TSC-115C TSC-120C TSC-145C TSC-170C TSC-200C TSC-225C TSC-185C TSC-230C TSC-270C TSC-310C TSC-350C TSC-290C TSC-340C TSC-400C TSC-450C TSC-480C TSC-590C TSC-700C TSC-800C TSC-910C TSC-1050C TSU-790D TSU-940D TSU-1080D TSU-1220D TSU-1440D No Coils Sh. Weight (kg) 1065 1205 1315 1500 1635 1950 2135 1065 1205 1340 1590 1725 1500 1635 1950 2135 1365 1545 1680 2000 2180 1680 2065 2315 2720 2950 3310 Coil Volume (l) 297 340 368 453 510 566 651 297 340 410 453 510 453 510 566 651 380 462 519 574 660 520 687 779 864 950 1084 R-717 Charge (kg) 128 147 159 196 220 244 281 128 147 177 196 220 196 220 244 281 164 199 224 248 285 225 297 336 373 410 468 H (mm) 1912 1912 1912 1912 1912 1912 1912 1912 1912 1912 1912 1912 1912 1912 1912 1912 1912 1912 1912 1912 1912 1912 2102 2102 2102 2102 2102 H1 (mm) 2260 2260 2260 2260 2260 2260 2260 2260 2260 2260 2260 2260 2260 2260 2260 2260 2260 2260 2260 2260 2260 2260 2448 2448 2448 2448 2448 L (mm) 2654 3258 2654 3258 3861 4464 5070 2654 3258 3861 4464 5070 3258 3861 4464 5070 2721 3327 3928 4534 5137 4030 3327 3931 4534 5140 6045 W (mm) 1055 1055 1350 1350 1350 1350 1350 1055 1055 1055 1055 1055 1350 1350 1350 1350 1350 1350 1350 1350 1350 1350 1645 1645 1645 1645 1645
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 4 4 4 4 4 6 4 4 4 4 4
General Notes
1. All dimensions are in mm. Weights are in kg. 2. Unit should be continuously supported on a flat levelsurface. 3. All connections are threaded 4. H1 = installed height. Coils are capped for shipping and storage. Add 75 mm for shipping height. 5. Refrigerant charge listed is operating charge for pump recirculated bottom feed. For other feed systems, consult your BAC Balticare Representative.
Baltimore Aircoil
TSU - F 23
Modes of Operation
The ICE CHILLER Thermal Storage Unit operates in two main operating modes or cycles. A possible combination of these cycles of operation provides the flexibility to meet the daily HVAC or cooling requirements. Long periods of simultaneously circulating glycol or ammonia through the coil tubes and circulating water through the ICE CHILLER should however be avoided to optimise system performance. Ice Build: In this operating cycle, ice is built by circulating ammonia or a 30% solution (by weight) of inhibited ethylene/propylene glycol through the coils contained in the ICE CHILLER Thermal Storage Unit. The below table illustrates typical temperatures for 8, 10, 12 and 14 hour build cycles. At the start of the ice build cycle, the temperature will be higher while at the end of the ice build cycle, the temperatures will be lower.
TSU - F 24
Unit Capacity & Average Temperatures for Glycol Applications Build Time (h) & Glycol Temperature (C) Model TSU Nominal Capacity (kWh) 325 404 422 510 597 703 791 650 808 949 1090 1230 1020 1195 1406 1582 1688 2075 2462 2813 3200 3692 2776 3303 3795 4287 5060 Flow (l/s) p In TSU-95C TSU-115C TSU-120C TSU-145C TSU-170C TSU-200C TSU-225C TSU-185C TSU-230C TSU-270C TSU-310C TSU-350C TSU-290C TSU-340C TSU-400C TSU-450C TSU-480C TSU-590C TSU-700C TSU-800C TSU-910C TSU-1050C TSU-790D TSU-940D TSU-1080D TSU-1220D TSU-1440D 2,4 2,4 2,8 2,8 2,8 5,4 5,4 4,7 4,7 8,5 8,5 8,5 5,7 5,7 10,7 10,7 10,7 10,7 11,4 21,5 21,5 17,0 27,4 27,4 27,4 27,4 27,4 111,0 130,3 100,7 117,9 134,4 71,0 78,6 111,0 130,3 63,4 71,0 78,6 117,9 134,4 71,0 78,6 93,8 108,2 135,8 72,4 79,3 137,3 73,1 82,7 91,7 100,7 114,5 -8,8 -9,4 -9,0 -9,5 -10,0 -8,7 -9,0 -8,8 -9,4 -8,4 -8,7 -8,9 -9,5 -10,0 -8,7 -9,0 -9,2 -9,7 -10,1 -8,7 -9,0 -10,1 -8,2 -8,6 -8,8 -9,1 -9,6 8h Out -4,4 -3,8 -4,2 -3,7 -3,2 -4,4 -4,2 -4,4 -3,8 -4,8 -4,5 -4,3 -3,7 -3,2 -4,4 -4,2 -4,1 -3,4 -3,1 -4,4 -4,2 -3,1 -5,0 -4,6 -4,4 -4,1 -3,6 In -6,9 -7,4 -7,1 -7,5 -7,9 -6,9 -7,1 -6,9 -7,4 -9,6 -6,8 -7,1 -7,5 -7,9 -6,9 -7,1 -7,2 -7,7 -8,0 -6,9 -7,1 -8,0 -6,5 -6,7 -7,0 -7,2 -7,6 10 h Out -3,4 -2,9 -3,2 -2,8 -2,4 -3,4 -3,2 -3,4 -2,9 -3,7 -3,5 -3,3 -2,8 -2,4 -3,4 -3,2 -3,1 -2,6 -2,3 -3,4 -3,2 -2,4 -3,8 -3,6 -3,3 -3,1 -2,7 In -5,8 -6,2 -5,9 -6,3 -6,6 -5,8 -5,9 -5,8 -6,2 -5,6 -5,7 -5,9 -6,3 -6,6 -5,8 -5,9 -6,1 -6,4 -6,7 -5,8 -5,9 -6,7 -5,4 -5,7 -5,8 -6,1 -6,3 12 h Out -2,8 -2,4 -2,7 -2,4 -2,1 -2,9 -2,7 -2,8 -2,4 -3,1 -2,9 -2,8 -2,4 -2,1 -2,9 -2,7 -2,6 -2,2 -1,9 -2,9 -2,7 -2,0 -3,2 -3,0 -2,8 -2,6 -2,3 IN -5,0 -5,3 -5,1 -5,4 -5,7 -4,9 -5,1 -5,0 -5,3 -4,8 -4,9 -5,1 -5,4 -5,7 -4,9 -5,1 -5,2 -5,6 -5,8 -4,9 -5,1 -5,7 -4,7 -4,8 -5,0 -5,2 -5,4 14 h Out -2,4 -2,1 -2,3 -2,1 -1,8 -2,5 -2,3 -2,4 -2,1 -2,7 -2,5 -2,4 -2,1 -1,8 -2,5 -2,3 -2,2 -1,9 -1,7 -2,5 -2,3 -1,7 -2,8 -2,6 -2,4 -2,3 -2,0
Unit Capacity for Ammonia Applications Pump Recirculation Refrigerant Feed Nominal Capacity kWh 318 389 404 492 580 661 735 636 777 Gravity Flooded Refrigerant Feed Nominal Capacity kWh 1322 1470 1656 2015 2356 2683 2982 3576 2748
Model TSU
Model TSU
Baltimore Aircoil
TSU - F 25
Unit Capacity for Ammonia Applications Pump Recirculation Refrigerant Feed Nominal Capacity kWh 910 1037 1157 984 1160 Gravity Flooded Refrigerant Feed Nominal Capacity kWh 3247 3728 4227 4940
Model TSU
Model TSU
Temperatures for Ammonia Applications Design Evaporator Temperature Pump Recirculation Refrigerant Feed C Storage Factor 1,00 1,05 1,10 1,15 1,20 1,25 1,30 Build Tuime 8h -6,1 -5,7 -5,3 -5,0 -4,7 -4,5 -4,3 10 h -4,9 -4,6 -4,3 -4,1 -3,9 -3,7 -3,5 12 h -4,1 -3,9 -3,7 -3,5 -3,3 -3,1 -3,0 14 -3,6 -3;4 -3,2 -3,0 -2,8 -2,7 -2,6 Storage Factor 1,00 1,05 1,10 1,15 1,20 1,25 1,30 Design Evaporator Temperature Gravity Flooded Refrigerant Feed C Build Time 8h -5,8 -5,5 -5,2 -5,0 -4,7 -4,5 -4,3 10 h -4,8 -4,6 -4,3 -4,1 -3,9 -3,8 -3,6 12 h -4,2 -3,9 -3,7 -3,6 -3,4 -3,3 -3,1 14 h -3,7 -3,5 -3,3 -3,2 -3,0 -2,9 -2,8
Ice Melt: In this operation cycle the warm return water is cooled by direct contact between the water and the ice, melting ice stored in the modular ICE CHILLER Thermal Storage Unit.
System Schematics
The basic ice storage system includes an ICE CHILLER Thermal Storage Unit, a refrigeration system and ice water pump as shown below. The ICE CHILLER Unit consists of a multiple tube serpentine coil submerged in an insulated tank of water. Both the coil and tank are constructed from hot-dip galvanized steel for corrosion protection. When no cooling load exists, the refrigeration system operates to build ice on the outside surface of the coil. This refrigeration effect is provided by feeding refrigerant directly into the coil. To increase the heat transfer during the ice build cycle the water is agitated by air bubbles from a low pressure distribution system beneath the coil. When the ice has reached design thickness, BACs exclusive ICE-LOGIC Ice Thickness Controller sends a signal to turn off the refrigeration system. When chilled water is required for cooling, the chilled water pump is started, and the meltout cycle begins. Warm water returning from the load circulates through the ICE CHILLER tank and is cooled by direct contact with the melting ice. During this cycle, the tank water is also agitated to enhance heat transfer and provides a constant supply water temperature of 1C or less.
TSU - F 26
For a closed chilled water loop see figure below. With this system, warm retrun water from the load is pumped through a heat exchanger and cooled by the ice water circuit from the ICE CHILLER Unit. For more detailed information on the design and operation of BAC ICE CHILLER Thermal Storage Units, contact your local BAC Balticare Representative.
Baltimore Aircoil
TSU - F 27
TSU - F 28
Baltimore Aircoil
TSU - F 29
Unit Piping
Piping to the ICE CHILLER Thermal Storage Unit should follow established piping guidelines. The coil connections on the unit are galvanized steel and are grooved for mechanical coupling. For single tank applications, each pair of manifolded coil connections should include a shut off valve so the unit can be isolated from the system. Below figure illustrates the valve arrangement for a single unit. It is recommended that the piping include a bypass circuit to allow operation of the system without the ICE CHILLER Thermal Storage Unit in the piping loop. This bypass can be incorporated into the piping design by installing a three-way/modulating valve. This valve can also be used to control the leaving glycol temperature from the thermal storage unit. Temperature and pressure taps should be installed to allow for easier flow balancing and system troubleshooting. A relief valve, set at a maximum of 10 bar, must be installed between the shut off valves and the coil connections to protect the coils from excessive pressures due to hydraulic expansion. The relief valve should be vented to a portion of the system, which can accommodate expansion.
CAUTION: The system must include an expansion tank to accommodate changes in fluid volume. Adequately sized air vents must be installed at the high points in the piping loop to remove trapped air from the system. In cases where the piping to the storage tanks is at the highest elevation in the loop, purge valves must be installed in the piping on top of the units to remove excess air from the system.
Below figure illustrates reverse return piping for multiple units installed in parallel. The use of reverse return piping is recommended to ensure balanced flow to each unit. Shut off valves at each unit can be used instead of balancing valves. When large quantities of ICE CHILLER Thermal Storage Units are installed, the system should be divided into groups of units. Then, balancing of each unit can be eliminated and a common balancing valve for each group of units installed. Shut off valves for isolating individual units should be installed but not used for balancing glycol flow to the unit.
Controls
An inventory control that provides a 4 20 mA signal is available. This control should be used for determining the amount of ice in inventory and to terminate the ice build cycle. Compolete operating control details are provided in the Operating and Maintenance Manual.
Glycol
ICE CHILLER Thermal Storage Units typically use a 25% (by weight) solution of industrially inhibited ethylene glycol for both corrosion protection and freeze protection. Industrial grade inhibited ethylene glycol is specifically designed to prevent corrosion in HVAC and heat transfer equipment. Inhibitors are used to prevent the ethylene glycol from becoming acidic and to protect the metal components in the thermal storage system. The systems lowest operating temperature should be 3C to 4C above the glycol freeze point. The freeze point for a system with 25% (by weight) ethylene glycol is -12C.
TSU - F 30
CAUTION: 1. Uninhibited ethylene glycol and automotive antifreeze solutions are NOT to be used on thermal storage applications. 2. Ethylene glycol solutions are NOT compatible with galvanised steel parts. Therefore glycol piping should only be galvanised at the outside.
Water Treatment
In the near freezing temperatures of the ICE CHILLER Thermal Storage Unit, scale and corrosion are naturally minimized. Therefore, water treatment for these two conditions may not be required or may require minimal attention unless the water is corrosive in nature. To control biological growth, a biocide may be needed to prevent the spread of iron bacteria or other organisms. For specific recommendations, consult a reputable local water treatment company and follow the guidelines below:
Property of Water PH Hardness as CaCo3 Alkalinity as CaCO3 Total Dissolved Solids Chlorides Sulfates Conductivity
Range 7.0 to 9.0 (1) 30 to 50 mg/l 500 mg/l max. 1000 mg/l max. 125 mg/l max. as Cl 125 mg/l max. 700 S/cm at 0C (2)
Notes: 1. A water pH of 8.3 or higher will require periodic passivation of the galvanised steel to prevent white rust, the accumulation of white, waxy, non-protective zinc corrosion products on galvanised steel surfaces. 2. Maximum conductivity of 700 S/cm at 0C is important for proper operation of the ICE LOGIC ice quantity controller.
If water treatment is implemented to the system, to assure full capacity of the ICE CHILLER Thermal Storage Unit, the water treatment should not alter the freeze point of water.
Winterization
Precautions must be taken to protect the unit and associated piping from freezing conditions. Heat tracing and insulation should be installed on all piping connected to the unit. The sight tube, operating controls and optional inventory sensor must be heat traced and insulated. It is not necessary to drain the unit during cold weather. Freezing of the water contained in the unit during the winter will not damage the coil or unit.
Pressure Drop
The ICE CHILLER Thermal Storage Unit is designed for low pressure drop. Pressure drops, for different flow rates and for alternative fluids, are available by contacting the local BAC Balticare Representative.
Warranties
Please refer to the Limitation of Warranties applicable to and in effect at the time of the sale/ purchase of these products.
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 1
Content
Connection Guide ...................................................................................... G2 Materials of Construction ......................................................................... G4 Selection Software ..................................................................................... G5 The Value of Standards ............................................................................. G6 Selection of Remote Sump Tank .............................................................. G7 Filtration Options .................................................................................... G13 Sound Reduction Options ....................................................................... G14 Fundamentals of Sound .......................................................................... G22 Motor Controls ........................................................................................ G47 Plume Abatement .................................................................................... G49 Formulas .................................................................................................. G51 Replacement Parts .................................................................................. G52 Application Guidelines ............................................................................ G53 Glossary .................................................................................................... G61
TR - G 2
Connection Guide
Introduction
A summary of connection types used by BAC follows. The specific connection type for a particular BAC model can be found on the unit print drawing or from your local BAC Balticare Representative.
Weld Details
1. Weld Material, 2. Beveled edge of field-installed piping, 3.Beveled Edge of BAC connection.
Grooved Connection
1. Grooved for mechanical coupling
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 3
Flat Face Flange pattern is shown on this cold water basin panel to suit a EN 1092 flange
Flat Fac Flange pattern with mounting bolts is shown on this hot water basin panel to suit a EN 1092 flange
MPT Connection
TR - G 4
Materials of Construction
Introduction
Operating environment, desired life expectancy, and budget all influence the materials of construction selected for an evaporative cooling unit. BAC products are available in a variety of materials and BAC designs focus on long life and easy maintenance. As a result, owners can maximize their operational goals. This section describes the materials of construction available for BAC products. To determine the best material options for your specific project, consult your local BAC Balticare Representative.
Galvanized Steel
Z-600 hot-dip galvanized steel is the heaviest commercially available galvanized steel, universally recognized for its strength and corrosion resistance. To assure long-life, Z-600 hot-dip galvanized steel is used as the base material for all steel products and parts, and all exposed cut edges are protected with a zinc-rich coating after fabrication. With good maintenance and proper water treatment, Z-600 galvanized steel products will provide excellent service life under the operating conditions normally encountered in comfort cooling and industrial applications.
Stainless Steel
In certain critical applications the use of stainless steel is preferred. BAC offers stainless steel as an optional material on most of its product lines. Two types of stainless steel are available, AISI 304 (DIN Werkst. Nr. 1.4301) or AISI 316 (DIN Werkst. Nr. 1.4401 or 1.4404). Stainless steel AISI 316 is recommended for applications with chloride concentrations of more than 500 ppm in the circulating water.
Component Construction
In addition to the various materials available for the structure of its units, BAC carefully selects the materials used for all components of its products. Additional materials such as corrosion resistant fiberglass reinforced polyester (FRP), polyvinyl chloride (PVC), aluminum and copper are used for components when necessary to provide the corrosion resistance required of a unit providing evaporative cooling service.
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 5
Selection Software
Easy-to-Use Selection Software
BAC has developed comprehensive selection software, which simulates the performance of evaporative cooling equipment for a broad range of climatic and operating conditions. The programme provides all technical data relevant to the selected model(s).
Accessories
The selection program evaluates the use of accessories that may impact capacity (i.e., low-sound fans, sound attenuation, etc.)
Performance Curves
The selection program generates performance curves based on flow rates ranging from 80% to 120% of the design flow rate. Performance curves are a graphical representation of the leaving water temperature versus the entering wet-bulb temperature, and are typically evaluated at a number of ranges.
Sound Data
The selection program provides sound ratings for standard selections at any distance for your reference. For extremely sound sensitive installations, sound ratings are also available for units with low sound fans and sound attenuation.
TR - G 6
ISO9001:2000
This fundamental belief is demonstrated first and foremost by ISO 9001:2000 Certification of BACs design, engineering, and manufacturing of evaporative cooling products. Compliance with ISO 9001:2000 standards offers BAC customers better, more consistent quality, reliable performance, and confidence that the product can be delivered on time and per the specifications. Consistent quality also reduces the potential for installation and operational problems. Any problems reported from the field receive swift corrective and preventative actions to prevent reoccurrence. This level of performance is assured through frequent internal training and audits, backed by rigorous external audits by an independent, ISO-accredited Registrar. ISO 9001:2000 also requires demonstrating continuous improvement of products, processes, and systems over time, benefiting both BAC and its many customers.
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 7
Safety Factor
When designing a remote sump tank, make sure that your basin has a net available volume that is 5% greater than the total volume required. The net available volume is the volume between the operating level and the overflow level in the remote sump tank The minimum operating level must be maintained in the remote sump tank to prevent vortexing of air through the tank's suction connection.
Example
A VTL-059-H will be installed on a cooling tower/heat exchanger system that will utilize a remote sump tank. The tower side volume contained in the heat exchanger is 95 liters The system has been designed with 10 meter of DN 100 pipe that will be above the operating level of the remote sump tank. What is the correct remote sump tank volume? Solution: From Table 4, the cold water basin volume at overflow for the VTL-059-H is 555 liters. From Table 6, the DN 100 pipe will contain 8,2 liters of water per linear meter pipe. The total volume contained in the DN 100 pipe is 82 liters. The tower side volume of the heat exchanger is 95 liters. The total volume required is: Cooling Tower Volume at Overflow (555 liters) + System Piping Volume (82 liters) + System Components Volume (95 liters) = Total Volume 732 liters 732 liters x 1.05 (safety factor) = 770 liters required. From the above calculation the minimum volume of the remote sump tank must be 770 liters.
TR - G 8
Table 2 : TXV
TXV Cold Water Basin Volumes Model No. TXV 109 - TXV 154 TXV 177 - TXV 193 TXV 292 - TXV 237 TXV 354 - TXV 500 TXV 310 - TXV 425 at Operating Level (l) 508 679 720 1090 820 at Overflow Level (l) 2659 3565 4103 6213 5341
Table 3 : FXT
FXT Cold Water Basin Volumes Model No. FXT 27 - FXT 32 FXT 43 - FXT 51 FXT 60 - FXT 68 FXT 74 - FXT 88 FXT 97 FXT 133 FXT 160 FXT 173 FXT 211 FXT 250 FXT 194 FXT 266 FXT 320 FXT 346 FXT 422 FXT 500 at Operating Level (l) 106 155 208 310 477 636 636 954 1272 1272 at Overflow Level (l) 428 553 746 1033 1590 2112 2521 3180 4224 5042
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 9
Table 4 : VTL
VTL Cold Water Basin Volumes Model No. VTL 039 VTL 079 VTL 076 VTL 095 VTL 086 VTL 137 VTL 139 VTL 215 VTL 225 VTL 227 VTL 238 VTL 272 at Operating Level (l) 290 435 580 875 1170 875 1170 at Overflow Level (l) 555 815 1090 1655 2175 1655 2175
Table 5 : VXT
VXT Cold Water Basin Volumes Model No. VXT VXT 10 VXT 25 VXT 30 VXT 55 VXT 65 VXT 85 VXT 95 VXT 135 VXT 150 VXT 185 VXT N215 VXT N265 VXT N310 VXT N395 VXT 315 VXT 400 VXT N430 VXT N535 VXT 470 VXT 600 VXT 630 VXT 800 VXT 870 VXT 1200 at Operating Level (l) 45 100 150 205 275 850 1220 1400 1630 2125 2850 4300 at Overflow Level (l) 100 210 325 435 580 1850 2810 2300 3765 3490 4680 7060
TR - G 10
Application Notes
The standard close-coupled centrifugal pump normally furnished with BAC units is designed and selected specifically for the pump head and flow rate required when the pump is mounted on the unit. This pump cannot be used for remote sump applications and is therefore omitted. The following factors should be considered when selecting remote pumps: Total static head from the remote sump tank operating level to the inlet of the evaporative equipment. Pipe and valve friction losses. For all Closed Circuit Cooling Towers and all Evaporative Condensers, 14 kPa water pressure is required at the inlet of the water distribution system. Required spray flow rate as shown in Tables 1 through 4. A valve should always be installed in the pump discharge line so that the water flow can be adjusted to the proper flow rate and pressure. Inlet water pressure should be measured with a pressure gauge installed in the water supply riser near the equipment inlet. The valve should be adjusted to permit the specified inlet pressure, which results in the design water flow rate. Accurate inlet water pressure and flow rate are important for proper evaporative equipment operation. Higher pressure (in excess of 70 kPa) can cause leaks in the spray distribution system. Lower pressure or low flow may cause improper wetting of the coils, which will negatively affect thermal performance, promote scaling, and may also cause excessive drift. On remote sump applications, the standard float valve(s) and strainer(s) are omitted from the cold water basin and a properly sized outlet connection is added. The remote sump outlet connection is located on the bottom of most units. On smaller Series VL and VX units, the connection is located on the end or back side of the unit. To clarify the location of the remote sump outlet connection, refer to the appropriate unit print, available from your local BAC Balticare Representative or at www.BaltimoreAircoil.com. Another effect of using a remote sump is that the operating weight of the evaporative unit is reduced (design changes, the omission of the integral spray pump, and/or changes in cold water basin volume can contribute to this deduct).
Example
An FXV-422 will be installed on a system that will also utilize a remote sump tank. The system has been designed with 12 meter of DN 150 mm pipe that will be above the operating level of the remote sump tank. What is the correct volume of the remote sump?
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 11
Solution: From Table 1, the spray water volume for an FXV-422 is 997 liters. From Table 4, the DN 150 mm pipe will contain 18,7 l/s of water per linear meter. The total volume contained in the DN 150 mm pipe is 12 meter x 18,7 liter/meter = 225 liters. The total volume required is: Spray Water Volume (997 liters) + System Piping Volume (225 liters) = Total Volume 1222 liters 1222 liters x 1,05 (safety factor) : 1283 liters required. From the above calculation the minimum volume of the remote sump tank must be 1283 liters.
TR - G 12
Notes:
1. The overflow level is the spray water volume and based on the maximum operating water level in the cold water basin with no net drop leg included in the piping system below the unit outlet. 2. All remote sump unit volumes are based on bottom outlets sized as noted, except those models with an asterisk, which are based on an end outlet sized as noted. 3. Drain connection size is for remote sump applications only. For location of drain connection, please refer to unit certified print or contact your local BAC Balticare representative.
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 13
Filtration Options
Separators
Features
Available in flow rates from 2,5 to 76 l/sec. Automatic purge complete with electrically actuated industrial grade ball valve and adjustable purge timer. Close coupled, end suction centrifugal pump & TEFC motor. Cast iron pre-strainer with removable SST basket. Control Panel - IP65 fibreglass enclosure with motor start/ stop, circuit breakers, door disconnect switch, 3-position pump motor switch, adjustable 24 hours purge timer. Skid - fusion bonded polyester coated carbon steel. Polyester powder coated carbon steel interconnecting piping, includes flow controller and isolation ball valves. Options: package recovery system.
Application
BAC's package separators are designed specifically to remove dirt, sand, silt, precipitates, and suspended solids from process fluids. The solids in suspension are separated using the centrifugal forces and moved in an accumulation chamber. The clean fluid is returned to the process. The system utilises an automatic purge to drain the separated solids. The separator will remove unwanted contaminates resulting in increased system efficiency and decreased operating costs. In conjunction with evaporative cooling equipment it is recommended to provide this equipment with a sump sweeper piping system.
Media Filters
Designed for high pressure open applications - 700 kPa.
Features
Available in flow rates ranging from 1 to 12 l/sec. Positive filtration down to 10 micron (5 micron optional). Fusion bonded epoxy lined /polyester coated carbon steel vessel rated at 700 kPa (optional higher pressure ratings and ASME code stamp available). Industrial grade brass 3-way valves and polyester powder coated carbon steel face piping. Closed coupled, end suction centrifugal pump and TEFC motor with cast iron pre-strainer and SST basket. Skid - fusion bonded polyester coated carbon steel. Automatic control cabinet IP 65 fibreglass enclosure including door disconnects switch, circuit/breaker protection, electric actuator, step-down transformer, 3position pump motor switch, pressure differential switch, adjustable solid state timer and 24 hours backwash clock. Source water back wash.
Application
BAC's filtration systems are designed specifically to handle a wide variety of industrial water filtration applications. The permanent media filters use a silica sand media that easily backwashes for cleaning. The filter provides an excellent method for removing dirt, precipitates and suspended solids. In conjunction with evaporative cooling equipment it is recommended to provide this equipment with a sump sweeper piping system.
Service
Technical field service representatives are available to provide guidance for application, installation and repair.
TR - G 14
Sound reductions shown are expressed as sound pressure data at 15 m from the air intake. Daytime : full fan speed. Night-time : derated to half speed.
Indoor Applications
Directional free field sound data or overall sound power levels are not normally the best way to describe the acoustical behaviour of VX evaporative cooling equipment when installed indoors. In these cases Partial Sound Power levels are the best method to define the sound emission. Partial Sound Power levels represent the sound energy radiated from the sound source over a single directional flat surface (air intake and discharge). Partial Sound Power data for VX models are the result of extensive sound testing using the parallelepiped test methodology and describe the sound radiation for indoor environments.
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 15
1. XA Attenuator Discharge attenuator with vertical baffles Intake attenuator with angled baffles
2. XB Attenuator Discharge attenuator with vertical baffles Intake attenuator with additional baffles and not angled
3. XC Attenuator Double discharge attenuator with vertical baffles. Double intake attenuator with baffles not angled
Approximate distance between baffles is 300 mm Approximate distance between baffles is 120 mm Approximate distance between baffles is 120 mm
Scope of Supply
Intake attenuator with access plenum and access door at both unit ends. Discharge attenuator with access plenum and access door at the back of the unit. Acoustical baffles at both intake and discharge with flex tissue protection and encased in a galvanized steel frame with the Baltibond Corrosion Protection System. Acoustical material that is resistant to water, biological and chemical attack. Acoustically insulated solid bottom panels mounted under the full length of the unit. Lubrication lines extended to the air intake side of the attenuator to facilitate lubrication of the fan shaft bearings. Internal fan screens at the air intake side of the unit to guard the fan and drive system. All steel parts are Z600 galvanized steel with BALTIPLUS Protection.
VL Sound Attenuation
Combination of Low Heigth with Low Sound
The Low Profile Series VL provides optimal solutions for sound sensitive installations requiring low equipment height. Different sound attenuation packages are available to meet specific sound and lay-out requirements. For Horizontal Air Intake, BAC offers two Sound Attenuation alternatives:
HS-Type
VS-Type
Sound Reductions
Arrangement Standard VL unit VL units + HS or VS VL unit + HD Day Base - 17 dB (A) - 21 dB (A) Night - 8 dB (A) - 25 dB (A) - 29 dB (A) Typical Noise Criteria & NC Range Acceptable working conditions in light industrial & commercial areas. NC-45 to NC-55 Large offices, retail shops needing acceptable listening conditions. NC-35 to NC-40 Good listening conditions, residential environment. NC-30 to NC-35
Sound reductions shown are expressed as sound pressure data at 15m from air intake. Daytime: full fan speed. Nighttime: derated to half fan speed
Indoor Applications
Due to its low height, VL evaporative cooling equipment is the preferred choice for indoor applications. In such cases the sound emission and evaluation procedure is significantly different to open installations with free field sound radiation. For indoor applications Partial Sound Power levels are the best method to describe the sound emission. Partial Sound Power levels represent the sound energy radiated by the sound source over a single directional flat surface (air intake/ air discharge). All sound attenuators for Low Profile Series VL products can be applied for indoor use. Partial Sound Power data for VL models are the result of extensive sound testing using the parallelepiped methodology and describe the sound radiation in indoor environments.
Sound Testing VL
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 17 Easy Maintenance
With evaporative cooling equipment ease of maintenance is linked to ease of access. All VL sound attenuators have been designed to provide spacious access to the interior areas and components of the unit requiring maintenance.
1. Discharge attenuator access door : The access door in the discharge attenuator provides easy access to the spray system and discharge attenuation baffles. 2. Pan access door : Circular door for access to the float ball adjustment and strainer 3. Intake attenuator access doors : Large twin access doors are located at both sides at the air intake attenuator. When removed, access is available to the fan motor and fan drive as well as the spray water pump.
TR - G 18 Available Options
All VL sound attenuator options can be supplied with the BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System. Relocation of the spray pump to the pipe connection end of the unit is available for easy access to the spray pump. The sound attenuators can be fitted with mesh screens at the intake and/or discharge. Optional perforated steel sheet is available for additional baffle protection.
Series 3000-D, FXV-D, CXV-D product lines Standard Low Noise Fans
All SERIES 3000-D Cooling Towers, FXV-D and CXV-D coil products as well as Series 1500 and HXI/HXC hybrid products are fitted with highly efficient low noise fans as standard. These fans have a special blade cord width and trailing edge arrangement. Due to their low tip speed extra low sound emissions are achieved.
Baltimore Aircoil
1. Discharge attenuator encloses fan section; 2. Intake Sound Attenuator (at each air inlet side)
Scope of Supply
Standard products have low noise axial fans comprising cast iron hub and multiple aluminium fan blades with adjustable pitch. Fan blades have a special blade cord width and trailing edge arrangement to optimise airflow and minimise noise. Optional "Whisper Quiet" fans on Series 3000D, FXV-D and CXV-D models are constructed of fibreglass reinforced plastic blades of specially shaped aerofoil design. The blades are fixed on a steel, plastic coated, fan hub by aluminium blade supports and fastened through U-bolts for simple field assembly. Optional "Whisper Quiet" fans on Series 1500 (TXV, FXV, CXV) products consist of one piece steel block hub and specially shaped aluminium hinged blades allowing simple field assembly and unique end caps. Factory assembled acoustical discharge enclosure (shipped loose for installation on site) is constructed of Z600 heavy-gauge hot-dip galvanised steel protected with the Baltiplus Corrosion Protection (exterior painting)
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 21
Factory assembled and installed intake attenuator comprising of a Z600 heavy gauge hot-dip galvanised steel protected with the Baltiplus Corrosion Protection (exterior painting). Circular acoustical baffles designed to minimise air pressure drop with acoustical materials resistant to water, biological and chemical attack.
Options
Air discharge screens fitted on the discharge attenuator. Air intake screens fitted on the intake attenuators. Sound attenuation with the Baltibond Corrosion Protection System: All galvanised steel parts, baffles, are protected with the Baltibond Corrosion Protection System.
Acoustical test
TR - G 22
Fundamentals of Sound
Introduction
Sound is an important consideration in the selection of mechanical equipment. The purpose of this article is to present a procedure for evaluating the sound levels created by evaporative cooling equipment to determine if these levels will be acceptable to the neighbors* who live or work near the installation. In addition, sound levels must comply with local code requirements. While most often these levels are found to be acceptable, certain situations may call for sound levels lower than those produced by the equipment. It is then the task of the manufacturer, engineer, and owner to determine the best way to decrease the sound levels for the particular installation. This article presents a means for assessing the impact of the evaporative cooling equipments sound on a neighbor and possible means to reduce that impact should it be a potential problem. The procedure consists of three steps, followed by a fourth step if necessary: 1. Establish the noise criterion for the equipment: i.e., determine the sound levels that will be considered acceptable by the neighbors who will be exposed to them. Also consult local codes for appropriate sound levels. For a general idea of how sound levels produced by a cooling tower compare to sound from other common sound sources, see the graph below.
2. Estimate the sound levels that will be produced by the equipment, taking into account the effects of equipment geometry, the installation, and the distance from the equipment to the neighbor.* 3. Compare the noise criterion with the expected sound levels to determine if the sound levels from the equipment will be acceptable. 4. In the event that the equipment sound levels are excessive for the particular site conditions, a method should be determined to modify the neighbors perception of the sound. There are three ways to change the effects that any undesirable sound has on the receiver of that sound: - Modify the source of the sound - Control the path of the sound - Adjust the receivers expectation or satisfaction, keeping in mind that sound can be very subjective and is highly dependent on perception
Note: *In this article, the term neighbour is used to denote the person or group of persons to be protected against excessive sound levels created by the evaporative cooling equipment. It is intended that this include not only the occupants of other buildings, but also the occupants of the building served by the equipment.
Some ways that sound from BAC equipment can be adjusted for a more favorable impact on the receiver include:
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 23
Modify equipment location or position If possible, simply do not run the equipment at the critical time (at night for residential areas and during the day for office parks) Install a second motor, two-speed motor, or VFD so that the unit can run at lower speeds when the full capacity is not required Use a low sound fan Oversize the equipment and run the fan at lower speed and power level Construct sound barriers (sound walls, etc.) or use existing barriers (trees, other buildings, etc.) when planning the location of the equipment Install sound attenuation (available on the air intake and air discharge of the equipment) The article also includes several appendices to lend assistance in understanding and performing some aspects of a sound analysis. Contact your local BAC Representative with questions on sound analysis or sound issues specific to your installation.
TR - G 24
The reference pressure used in this article is the long-used and accepted value of 0.0002 microbar. Another way to describe the same value, which may be used in other publications, is the value of 20 x 10-6 Pascals (N/m2). Sound Power Level (Lw) in dB the measure of the total acoustic power radiated by a given source and is defined by: Lw = 10Log (W/10-12 )dB, reference 10-12 . The standard reference power used in the BAC literature is 10-12 watt. To eliminate any possible confusion, the reference power should always be quoted, as in a sound power level of 94 dB reference 10-12 watt. Unit a single cell of evaporate cooling equipment.
When sound levels are plotted on a graph, they are most often divided into these eight octave bands. In this way it is possible to observe the variation of a sound level with change in frequency. This variation is important in any situation since humans display a different sensitivity and a different response to low frequency sounds as compared with high frequency sounds. In addition, engineering solutions for low frequency sound issues differ markedly from those for high frequency sound issues.
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 25
Note that the curves of Figure 1 have as their x-axis the eight octave frequency bands; and as their y-axis, sound pressure levels given in decibels (dB) relative to the standard reference pressure of 0.0002 microbar. For convenience, Table 1 lists the sound pressure levels at each octave band center frequency, for each Noise Criterion. Table 1: Octave Band Sound Pressure Levels (dB re 0.0002 microbar) of indoor Noise Criterion (NC) Curves of Figure 1
Octave Band Center Frequency in Hz Noise Criterion 63 NC-15 NC-20 NC-25 NC-30 NC-35 NC-40 NC-45 NC-50 NC-55 NC-60 NC-65 47 51 54 57 60 64 67 71 74 77 80 125 36 40 44 48 52 56 60 64 67 71 75 250 29 33 37 41 45 50 54 58 62 67 71 8500 22 26 31 35 40 45 49 54 58 63 68 1000 17 22 27 31 36 41 46 51 56 61 66 2000 14 19 24 29 34 39 44 49 54 59 64 4000 12 17 22 28 33 38 43 48 53 58 63 8000 11 16 21 27 32 37 42 47 52 57 62
Figure 1 - Noise criterion "NC" Curves. The octave band sound pressure levels associated with the noise criterion conditions of Table 2.
Table 2 is used with the NC curves and lists some typical activities that require indoor background sound levels in range of NC-15 to NC-55. Certain unusual acoustical requirements may not easily fall into one of the Table 2 groups. It may be necessary to apply specific criteria for those special situations or to assign a criterion based in similarity to one of the criterion given in the table. It is emphasized that the NC curves are based on, and should be used only for, indoor activity. The first step in the development of the evaporative cooling equipments noise criterion is to select from Table 2 the particular activity that best describes what the indoor neighbors in the vicinity of the equipment will be doing when the equipment is operating. Where two or more neighbor conditions may be applicable, the one having the lowest NC value should be selected. The corresponding NC values of Figure 1 or Table 1 give the eight octave band sound pressure levels, in decibels, for that selection. The goal is to keep the sound heard by the neighbor, inside his home or building, at or below these sound pressure levels.
TR - G 26
Table 2: Suggested Schedule of Noise Criteria for Indoor Neighbour Activities*
ACTIVITY Sleeping, Resting, Relaxing Homes, apartments, hotels, hospitals, etc. Suburban and rural Urban Excellent Listening Conditions Required Concert Halls, recording studios, etc. Very Good Listening Conditions Required Auditoriums, theaters Large meeting and conference rooms Good Listening Conditions Required Private offices, school classrooms, libraries, small conference rooms, radio and television listening in the home, etc. Fair Listening Conditions Desired Large offices, restaurants, retail shops, and stores, etc. Moderately Fair Listening Conditions Acceptable Bussiness machine areas, lobbies, cafeterias, laboratory work areas, drafting rooms, satisfactory telephone use, etc. Acceptable Working Conditions with Minimum Speech Interference Light to heavy machinery spaces, industrial areas, commercial areas such as garages, kitchens, laundries, etc. NC-45 to NC-55 NC-40 to NC-45 NC-35 to NC-40 NC-30 to NC-35 NC-20 to NC-25 NC-25 to NC-30 NC-15 to NC-20 NC-20 to NC-25 NC-25 to NC-30 SUGGESTED RANGE OF NOISE CRITERIA
Note: * The ASHRAE Guide usually lists a 10 dB range of NC values for each situation leaving it to the option of the user to select the specific NC value for his own need. In the interest of more assuredly achieving satisfactory neighbour conditions, Table 2 listings are the more conservative lower 5 dB range of the ASHRAE value.
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 27
A: No wall; outside conditions B: Any typical wall construction, with open windows covering about 5% of exterior wall area C: Any typical wall construction, with small open-air vents of about 1% of exterior wall area, all windows closed D: Any typical wall construction, with closed but operable windows covering about 10%-20% of exterior wall area E: Sealed glass wall construction, 6 mm thickness over approximately 50% of exterior wall area F: Approximately 100 kg/m2 solid wall construction with no windows and no cracks or openings G: Approximately 250 kg/m2 solid wall construction with no windows and no cracks or openings
TR - G 28
CONDITION 17. 100 to 300 m from continuous medium-density traffic 18. 100 to 300 m from continuous heavy-density traffic 19. 300 to 600 m from intermittent light traffic 20. 300 to 600 m from continuous light traffic 21. 300 to 600 m from continuous medium-density traffic 22. 300 to 600 m from continuous heavy-density traffic 23. 600 to 1200 m from intermittent light traffic 24. 600 to 1200 m from continuous light traffic 25. 600 to 1200 m from continuous medium-density traffic
(Determine the appropriate conditions that seem to best describe the area in question during the time interval that is most critical, i.e., day or night. Then refer to corresponding Curve No. in Figure 2 or Table 5 for average minimum background sound levels to be used in sound analysis. Use lowest Curve No. where several conditions are found to be reasonably appropriate.)
Figure 2 : Approximate average minimum outdoor background sound pressure levels associated with the conditions of table 4.
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 29
Table 5: Octave Band Sound Pressure Levels (in dB) of Outdoor Background Noise Curves of Figure 2
CURVE No. in FIGURE 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 OCTAVE BAND CENTER FREQUENCY In Hz 63 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 125 37 42 47 52 57 62 67 250 32 37 42 47 52 57 62 500 27 32 37 42 47 52 57 1000 22 27 32 37 42 47 52 2000 18 23 28 33 38 43 48 4000 14 19 24 29 34 39 44 8000 12 17 22 27 32 37 42
Example
To summarize this procedure, consider a cooling tower installation located near the edge of a college campus, approximately 91 m from a classroom building. The college is located within a large city, and two main streets pass by one corner of the campus about 450 m from the classroom building. The cooling tower will be used both day and night during warm weather. The classroom must rely on open windows for air circulation. Determine the noise criterion for the cooling tower. The steps for this example are given in the sample Sound Evaluation Work Sheet, included as Appendix D in this article. Step 1 Determine the neighbor activity condition from Table 2. For good listening conditions inside a typical classroom, select NC-30 as the noise criterion. Step 2 In the indicated spaces under Item 2 of the Sound Evaluation Work Sheet, enter the sound pressure levels for the octave frequency bands of the NC-30 curve as taken from Figure 1 or Table 1. Step 3 Determine the wall condition of Table 3 that best describes the exterior wall of the classroom. Wall B can be selected for normally open windows during the summer time. Insert the Wall B values in the Item 3 spaces. Step 4 Add the values of Steps 2 and 3 together and insert the sums in the Item 4 spaces. This is the tentative outdoor noise criterion. Step 5 In the Item 5 spaces, enter either the measured average minimum background sound pressure levels or the estimated background levels obtained from the use of Figure 2 and Tables 4 and 5. In this example, we estimate that the traffic activity is best represented by 305 m - 610 m from continuous heavy-density traffic. This leads to Curve 5 of Figure 2 and Table 5, whose values are then inserted in the Item 5 spaces.
TR - G 30
Step 6 In the Item 6 spaces insert the higher value, in each frequency band, of either the Item 4 or Item 5 values. This is the final noise criterion. In this example, note that the Item 4 values are equal to or higher than the Item 5 values in all bands. Thus, the final noise criterion is based essentially on the classroom noise criterion and the wall condition. However, the outdoor background noise estimate equals the tentative outdoor noise criterion in the 250 and 500 Hz bands. If they had been higher, in this example, those higher values would have been used in setting the final noise criterion in those bands. We will attempt to keep all octave band sound pressure levels of the selected cooling tower equal to, or below, the values of Step 6. Should a sound code exist, this would be an appropriate point in the analysis to check agreement between the code and the Step 6 final outdoor noise criterion. If the criterion developed here is lower than the sound code levels at the specified distance, the sound analysis will yield results that will comply with the code. The remaining steps of this sound evaluation example are explained in later sections of this article as we progress with the entire sound evaluation procedure.
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 31
Octave Frequency Band (Hz) 63 125 250 500 1000 2000 4000 8000
A-B-C scale ratings have been used in some sound ordinances and equipment sound ratings because of their simplicity of statement. They may have value in some sound comparison situations, but such data are of little value in making an engineering evaluation of a sound issue caused by evaporative cooling equipment, because no indication of the frequency content of the sound is apparent. For example, two different types of cooling towers could have the same A scale rating, but one could have most of its energy in the low frequency bands while the other could have its energy concentrated in the high frequency bands. A single number rating will give no indication of this and its use could lead to less than optimal and sometimes costly decisions.
Comparison of Evaporative Cooling Equipment employing a Centrifugal Fan versus an Axial Fan
Based on extensive studies of field data from several cooling tower installations, it has been found that overall sound pressure levels of centrifugal fan cooling towers are about 5 to 7 dB lower than those of axial fan cooling towers for the same cooling capacity even though the axial towers use about half the kW. As a comparison, this means that an axial fan cooling tower would have to be twice as far away from the neighbours as a centrifugal fan tower in order to be just as quiet (6 dB reduction for each doubling of distance, see Table 6). The frequency distribution and the radiation patterns also differ for these two types of units. For any specific comparison of cooling towers, the manufacturers actual measured data should be used.
TR - G 32
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 33
Table 6: Reduction of Sound Pressure Level (in dB) for Distances beyond 50 feet
Octave Band Center Frequency in Hz Distance (m) 63 15 20 25 30 37,5 50 60 75 100 120 150 200 240 300 400 480 600 800 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30 32 34 125 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30 32 34 250 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30 32 34 500 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 25 27 29 31 33 36 1000 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 19 21 23 25 27 30 32 35 38 2000 0 2 4 6 8 10 13 15 17 19 22 24 26 29 32 35 38 42 4000 0 2 4 7 9 11 14 16 18 21 24 27 30 34 38 43 47 53 8000 0 2 4 7 10 12 15 18 21 24 27 31 35 40 46 53 61 70
TR - G 34
Table 7: Interpolation Terms for Obtaining Sound Pressure Levels (in dB) Between 1,5 m and 15 m
If the difference between the 5 ft and 50 ft levels is: Distance et which SPL is desired (m)) 15 13,5 12 10,5 9 7,5 6 4,5 3 1,5 4-6 dB 7-9 dB 10-12 dB 13-15 dB 16-18 dB 19-21 dB* 22-24 dB
Add the following values to the 15 m sound level to obtain sound level at desired distance: 0 0 1 1 2 2 2 3 4 5 0 0 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 8 0 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 8 11 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 8 10 14 0 1 2 3 4 5 7 9 12 17 0 1 2 3 4 6 8 10 14 20 0 1 2 3 5 7 9 12 16 23
* This column of values is based on the "Inverse Square Law" variation with distance from 15 m all the way in to 1,5 m. All other columns represent variations with distances that do not follow the "Inverse Square Law."
Because so many variables are involved, we will not attempt to develop a rigorous procedure for estimating the influence of a reflecting wall. Rather, we caution that if a large reflecting surface is located near the equipment, it should be considered as a potential reflector of sound. If the equipment is oriented such that its loudest side is already facing toward the neighbour, the influence of the reflecting wall can be ignored! However, if this is not the case, these conditions must be met for the reflected sound to be of concern: The area of the reflecting wall is at least three times the area of the side of the equipment that faces that wall The distance from the unit to the reflecting wall is less than half the distance from the equipment to the neighbor If a simple optical ray diagram is drawn from the center of each unit to all parts of the reflecting wall and the reflecting rays are then drawn away from the wall, the neighbor is located within the angular range of the reflected rays (see sketch below) If each of these three conditions is met, then the sound pressure levels at the neighbor may be higher than if the wall were not there.
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 35
In Figures 3 and 4, a few representative reflecting walls are shown for various orientations, and approximate sound pressure level adjustments are suggested for A, B, C, and D directions away from the equipment. These adjustments should be made using the 15 m levels. Figure 3 applies to units having one air intake, while Figure 4 applies to units having two air intakes. As an example, for Case 1, if the neighbor is located off the A side of the unit, apply the A adjustment to the A side 15 m sound pressure level rating of the unit and then correct as necessary to the neighbors distance. If the situation is that of Case 9 and the neighbor is located in the direction D, then the D adjustment would be utilized to arrive at a 15 m sound pressure level for the unit. Figure 3 : For Single Air Inlet Units
Case 1
A. Use Average of A and C Levels, B. Use average of B and C levels, C. Not applicable, D. Use average of D and C levels.
Case 2
A. Not applicable, B. Use greater of B level or average of B and A levels, C. No change to C levels, D. Use greater of D level or average of D and A levels.
Case 3
A. Use greater of A level or average of A and B levels, B. Not applicable, C. No change to C levels, D. Add 2 dB to D levels.
Case 4
A. Use average of A and C levels, B. Not applicable, C. Not applicable, D. Use average of D and C levels.
TR - G 36
Case 5
A. Not applicable, B. Not applicable, C. No change to C levels, D. Use average of A, C, D levels.
Case 6
Four sound levels out the open end of a 3-sided enclosure, add 3 dB to the sound pressure levels of the air intake side of the unit.
Case 7
A. Add 2 dB to A levels, B. Use average of B and C levels, C. Not applicable, D. Use average of C and D levels.
Case 8
A. No change to A levels, B. Not applicable, C. No change to C levels, D. Add 3 dB to D levels.
Case 9
A. Not applicable, B. Not applicable, C. Add 2 dB to C levels, D. Add 3 dB to D levels.
Case 10
For sound levels out the open end of a 3-sided enclosure, add 3 dB to the sound pressure levels of the air intake side(s) of the unit.
These figures and their associated adjustment values are to be used to correct base 15 m sound pressure level ratings in the neighbour direction of the effect of the reflecting surface conditions shown. Build-Up of Close-in Sound Levels Evaporative cooling equipment is sometimes located very close to a building wall, inside a court formed by two or three surrounding walls, or even in a specially provided room or space in the mechanical equipment area inside a building. In these installations, the principal concern may be the sound in the immediate vicinity (within 1,5 m- 3 m) of the unit(s), rather than the sound levels radiated and reflected away to some neighbor location.
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 37
For these situations, we may use Table 7 to determine approximately the sound pressure levels for the close-in distances of interest, and then add an increment to account for the build-up of sound levels. Here also, the geometry of the layout controls the problem and it is not possible to give a general solution that will cover the multitude of possible layouts. As an approximate acknowledgement of this situation, we suggest that the close-in sound pressure levels be increased by 5 dB, recognizing that the range of increase could be as little as 2 or 3 dB (in a fairly open courtyard) and as much as 10 to 15 dB (in a fairly confined mechanical room enclosure). This adjustment should be applied to all eight-octave band readings. Sound Radiation from a Four-Sided Enclosure or "Well" Evaporative cooling equipment is sometimes located inside a four-sided enclosure or well, where all the sound radiates more-or-less vertically out the top of the well and then spills over the sidewalls of the well. A simple generalized solution to this problem is not possible, but a reasonable approximation can be made. While the sidewalls serve as barrier walls against normal sound radiation in horizontal directions, the four-sided enclosure tends to average-out any free-field directional characteristics of the unit and causes an average sound pressure level to be radiated from the top of the well in all directions in which sound is free to radiate per the geometry of the situation. Appendix B provides a procedure for calculating sound pressure levels for a given sound power level, at various distances and with several radiation patterns. In the typical case illustrated, where the sound from the well radiates over a hemisphere, the sound pressure levels of the unit at a 15 m distance would be determined by subtracting 32 dB from the sound power levels of the unit. It should be recognized that this method of sound evaluation is an approximation. Actual sound levels may be somewhat lower in the higher frequency bands, and could be slightly lower in the lower frequency range depending upon the neighbor location relative to the equipment. If the sidewall of the well clearly serves as a barrier wall for the radiated sound, barrier wall attenuation values can be applied to the problem in the same manner as the sound evaluation procedure of this article subsequently permits for the non-well type installation.
Example Continued
Let us now summarize Step 2 in the sound evaluation process, looking at the source of sound and correcting it for distance and path. This will yield equipment sound pressure levels for the same point, which the final noise criterion was calculated in the earlier example. We are now interested in Items 7-11 in the sample Sound Evaluation Work Sheet (see Appendix D) which pertain to the cooling tower sound pressure levels as extrapolated to the 90 m distance. We continue the step-by-step procedure on the Sound Evaluation Work Sheet where we left off earlier. Step 7 Decide on the preferred orientation of the cooling tower at the site. From the BAC Sound Rating Data Sheet, determine the sound pressure levels at the 15 m distance for the side of the cooling tower facing the college classroom. Assume one of the end sides here (the blank-off sides), since they are the quietest. Insert these sound pressure level values in the Item 7 spaces of the Sound Evaluation Work Sheet. Step 8 Insert the distance 90 m in the appropriate space under Item 8 and refer to Table 6 for the distance correction values corresponding to 90 m. Insert these values in eight spaces of Item 8. Step 9 The sound pressure levels at 90 m will be lower than at 15 m, hence subtract the Item 8 values from the Item 7 values and insert the remainder in the Item 9 spaces. These then are the sound pressure levels that will exist just outside the college classroom, 90 m from the cooling tower. Step 10 Had there been a sound increase due to the presence of a reflecting wall that met one of the conditions illustrated by Figures 3 or 4, corrections would be inserted now in the Item 10 spaces. Had this been a close-in problem involving a build-up of sound levels due to some nearby enclosing walls around the tower, +5 dB would have been inserted in the Item 10 spaces. Since neither of these conditions applied in this example, we insert 0 in each of the Item 10 spaces. Step 11 Item 11 is the sum of Items 9 and 10. This is the sound pressure level of the cooling tower at the 90 m distance.
TR - G 38
Judgement Factor
At this point, some remarks should be made on the overall reliability of this approach, and an opportunity should be provided for inserting a judgment factor. In as much as the original criterion selection was based mostly on lower range NC values for the various environments considered, the derivation presented here may be somewhat conservative. Because of this, decisions based on this approach will usually lead to acceptance of the sound from the equipment. As explained throughout the procedure, several approximations are made (such as for the sound reduction of various general types of walls, and the sound estimates of community or traffic background sounds, and others). These approximations may lead to some variability from one installation to the next, although it is believed that a small amount of variability can be accommodated by the procedure without changing the results unreasonably.
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 39
Experience shows that where the criterion is based on sleeping at night, the criterion should not be exceeded, and therefore, the conclusions reached by this procedure should be followed. However, where the criterion is based on somewhat less critical daytime activities, and the background sound frequently ranges considerably above the average minimum conditions used here, then the risk is not too great if the criterion is exceeded by about 5 dB. In such cases the criterion should not be exceeded by more than 5 dB for fear of serious objections. If it is decided to permit the sound to exceed the criterion by as much as 10 dB or more, sound reduction steps should be considered for future addition to the installation, even though they may not be included in the initial installation. In view of the above, if the equipments owner, architect or engineer chooses to follow a conservative approach or even to allow for some excess sound on a particular project (that is, permit the equipments sound to exceed the background sounds slightly and thus be identifiable and possibly disturbing to the neighbors), this opportunity is afforded in Items 14 and 15 of the Sound Evaluation Work Sheet. Step 14 Insert the cooling tower owners Judgment Factor. For a conservative approach insert 0 dB in the Item 14 spaces of the Work Sheet. To purposely allow the cooling tower sound to exceed the acceptable levels slightly, insert 5 dB in the Item 14 spaces. Step 15 The Final Sound Reduction Requirement for the cooling tower is the difference, in each band, obtained by subtracting Item 14 from Item 13. These are the attenuation values in each octave band necessary to reduce the cooling tower sound to an acceptable level. A brief discussion of sound control for evaporative cooling equipment is given in the next section. Step 16 Sound reduction can be accomplished in several ways, and quantitative values for possible sound reduction steps are discussed in the next section. Step 16 of the Sound Evaluation Work Sheet should include the attenuation obtained from the use of two-speed fan motors, Baltiguard drives, VFD, low sound fans, barrier walls, and from any special acoustic treatments to be provided. Other situations that may apply are oversizing the equipment and utilizing strategic layout.
Strategic Positioning
The first and most economical strategy in reducing sound pressure levels from evaporative cooling equipment involves considering the layout of the equipment. Strategic Positioning includes two aspects. First, make sure to position the quietest side of the equipment towards the sound sensitive direction. This option should always be a first consideration with single side air inlet products. Next, take advantage of any existing sound barriers that may aid in muffling the sound from the equipment to the neighbor. For example, if a building or shed exists on the job site, position the equipment so that the structure blocks the direct path between the equipment and the neighbor, thus acting as a sound barrier. Trees and bushes are also good examples of barriers that greatly reduce sound exposure at neighboring properties.
TR - G 40
An 1500-750 rpm fan motor operating at 750 rpm would provide about 60% of full-load capacity on a BAC unit and would give approximately the following octave band dB noise reductions:
Frequency Band - Hz 63 4 125 6 250 8 500 10 1000 8 2000 8 4000 6 8000 4
In as much as these are average dB reductions that can be anticipated for half-speed operation, these figures can apply to both sound power and sound pressure levels. Also, these approximations are sufficiently accurate to be used for both centrifugal and axial fan towers. In addition to running the equipment at a lower speed during noise-critical hours, it is beneficial to investigate whether or not the equipment could be turned off completely during these hours. This would completely negate any sound created by the unit; however, the system and its loads must be researched to understand if this option is feasible. In some cases what people find objectionable is not the steady sound of the equipment, it is the abrupt stopping and starting of the fan system. Properly setting the tower control sequence to avoid excessive cycling of fan motors is important in this regard, as well as to protect the motor from overheating. VFDs solve this issue by allowing for a soft start of the fans, followed by a gentle ramping up and down of the fan speed in line with the load requirement. Simply stated, VFD's allow the fan motor to run at the speed required to meet leaving water temperature requirements rather than running at full speed all the time. Decreasing the motor speed, and therefore the fan rpm, can decrease sound levels significantly. VFD's also minimize harsh sounding on-off cycles by providing a gradual start.
Figure 7 - If applicable, turn towers off at night to eliminate sound Figure 6 - BAC axial fan cooling tower utilizing the Baltiguard drive.
If space and budget allow, it may be beneficial to oversize the equipment and run the larger capacity equipment at a lower fan speed rated for the specific job. As discussed in the previous section, reducing the motor speed reduces the fan speed and because fan speed is directly proportional to sound, reduces sound.
Baltimore Aircoil
Barrier Walls
Barrier walls can be used to provide sound attenuation. In some cases barrier walls may exist due to the architectural treatment of the site, while at other times they are constructed specifically to provide needed sound reduction. Taking the first case, a wall used to shield a unit from view can also act to reduce the sound radiated by the tower, particularly high frequency sound (broadly considered here as the upper four octave frequency bands). However, such barrier walls must cover by line-of-sight the entire sound source as observed from the neighbors position. Louvered, latticed or slotted openings will render negligible the attenuation abilities of a barrier wall. A solid wall of height equal to a unit and located close to it will provide the following approximate attenuation:
FREQUENCY BAND - Hz 63 4 125 5 250 5 500 5 1000 5 2000 6 4000 7 8000 8
When greater attenuation is required, a larger specially constructed barrier wall may be designed and installed. Care must be taken, though, in locating the wall because of the many geometric and material considerations involved. As an example, a barrier wall that (1) extends at least 1 to 1,5 m beyond the line-of-sight in both the horizontal and vertical directions, (2) that is located within 1,5 to 2,5 m of the cooling tower and (3) that is made of a solid impervious material having a surface weight of at least 85 g/m2 will have approximately the following attenuation:
FREQUENCY BAND - Hz 63 5 125 5 250 6 500 8 1000 10 2000 12 4000 14 8000 16
A still larger and heavier barrier wall will provide still greater attenuation. To be most effective, however, a barrier wall must be located as close as possible to the sound source and there must be no reflecting surfaces in the area that can reflect sound around the barrier. Design details of barrier walls and other acoustic treatment such as customengineered plenum chambers and acoustic mufflers are best left to acoustical engineers or consultants and acoustical treatment manufacturers.
Figure 10 - Architectural walls being constructed around Closed Circuit Cooling Towers
TR - G 42 Sound Attenuation
A significant feature of both axial and centrifugal fan equipment is that its noise, if it is a problem at all, can be treated with relatively simple package attenuation. Figure 11 is a photograph of a BAC Series 3000 Cooling Tower (axial fan), with sound attenuation on both the intake and discharge of the unit. The fan intake attenuator is an array of parallel baffles and the discharge treatment is a lined plenum chamber. Lined plenum chambers, to be effective, (1) must be fairly large, (2) should contain a thick absorbent lining, and (3) should be arranged such that the sound path through the plenum includes does not allow line-ofsight. Depending on the degree to which the plenum chamber conforms to these three requirements, its sound reduction may range in the order of 5 to 10 dB for low frequency noise up to 10 to 20 dB for high frequency noise. BAC sound attenuation packages are designed, tested and rated by BAC, hence ensuring single source responsibility. They provide reductions in the horizontal direction up to 25 dB in the mid frequency bands. Many sound attenuation alternatives are available from BAC to optimally and economically meet a large variety of sound requirements. Sound attenuation packages are available for centrifugal and axial fan models. Exact values of the attenuation obtained from these packages are available from your local BAC representative.
Figure 11 - Intake and discharge sound attenuation on a BAC Series 3000 Cooling
Summary
This article provides a simple and direct evaluation method for determining whether or not a given evaporative cooling equipment installation is producing, or will produce, excess sound. It also offers some general information on methods that can be used to reduce the sound. BAC can provide reliable sound level data on its open cooling towers, closed-circuit cooling towers, and evaporative condensers through their representatives. Consult your local BAC Balticare Representative for specific project applications. Acknowledgement: BAC extends its sincere appreciation to Mark E. Schaeffer, P.E. (President of Schaffer Acoustics Inc. of Pacific Palisades, CA) for his contributions to this article.
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 43
Appendix A
The Calculation of Sound Power Level (Lw) from Measured Sound Pressure Levels (Lp)
Sound power is a measure of the total acoustic power radiated by a sound source. Sound power level is the sound power, expressed in decibels, relative to the reference power quantity 10-12 watt. Sound power is not directly measured as such. Instead, it is a calculated quantity and is obtained from the measurement of sound pressure levels at a suitable number of measurement positions. Even in indoor testing with reverberant or semireverberant rooms and a standard reference sound source, sound power level is calculated from sound pressure level measurements. In this discussion, no technical detail is given for the derivation of sound power level; instead, a very simple procedure is provided for establishing the approximate sound power level of evaporative cooling equipment for the case in which the sound pressure level is measured at four horizontal positions (each position at a specific distance from each of the four sides) plus one vertical position above the unit. The measurement positions may be at any distance between 2 and 4 times the units largest dimension, which is usually its length. The measured sound pressure levels must be obtained with accurate, calibrated equipment, and the sound data must be in the conventional eight octave bands of frequency. The measurements should be made under essentially free-field conditions: i.e., outside in an area free of any nearby reflecting surfaces. The unit is assumed to be located on the ground or on a platform reasonably close to ground level. The approximate sound power level in each of the eight octave bands is the sum, by decibel addition, of the individual five sound pressure level readings in each octave band plus a correction term (K) which is a function of the number of measurements positions, the measurement distance and the reference power. In equation form, this can be expressed as
Lw = Lp + K
The decibel summation of a number of sound pressure levels is determined from the material given in Appendix C and the correction terms are given below in Table A for the appropriate conditions. The use of the five measurement positions and the decibel addition of the five readings automatically introduce the directivity characteristics of the unit into the calculated sound power level. No further provision for directivity is required in this simplified method. To illustrate this procedure, suppose we wish to estimate the sound power level (Lw) in one octave band for the case of the five-position measurements 15 m from a cooling tower. Assume the five sound pressure levels measured in the particular frequency band are 56, 53, 59, 53 and 47 dB (re 0.0002 microbar). By the decibel addition method shown in Appendix C we find that the decibel sum of these five sound pressure levels is 62 dB. From Table A we then find that for the 15 m measurement distance, the correction term is 25 dB re 10-12 watt. For this example,
Lw = Lp + K = 62 + 25 = 87 dB
The same procedure could be followed for all octave bands to get the complete Lw of the cooling tower. The procedure given here is for the specific five measurement positions noted and may not be applicable generally to other situations. The procedure is not accurate to less than 1 dB, so fractional values of decibels should not be used or relied upon. Correction term K to be used in converting Sound Pressure Levels (Lp) into Sound Power Level (Lw) for special fiveposition procedure given
Table A
Measurement Distance (to Acoustic Center) (m) 7,5 9 10,5 12 13,5 15 Correction Term K for Lw re 10-12 Watt (dB) 19 20 21 23 24 25
TR - G 44
Appendix B
The Calculation of Average Sound Pressure Level (Lp) for a given Sound Power Level (Lw)
For comparative purposes it may occasionally be necessary to estimate the approximate average sound pressure level radiated by a unit for which only the sound power level is given. There are also some applications that are best appraised by converting sound power back to average sound pressure levels. The procedure outlined in this Appendix will provide this estimate. It is important to realize that the resulting value is an average sound pressure level that theoretically would be radiated the same in all directions from the unit. In practice, the unit probably would not radiate the same levels in all directions; but, when only the sound power level is given it is not possible to know the directivity characteristics of the unit. The average sound pressure level at a desired distance is obtained by subtracting from the sound power level in any given octave frequency band the appropriate correction term (C) from Table B. In equation form, this relationship is expressed as
Lp Avg. = Lw C
As an illustration, suppose we wish to know the average sound pressure at a 15 m distance for a cooling tower that is stated to have a sound power level 87 dB re 10-12 watt. (Note that this is the counterpart of the example given in Appendix A.) From Table B, for a 15 m distance, we see that the correction term is 32 dB.
Lp Avg. = Lw C = 87 32 = 55 dB
By comparing this value with the five levels fed into the illustration in Appendix A, we see that although this is an average value, it actually does not equal any of the levels from the five measured directions. Note again that the average value does not pretend to show the directivity characteristics of the sound source. If two competitive cooling towers are being compared for a particular site condition, a comparison of the sound power level or the average sound pressure level may be a general clue to the relative sound from the two units, but a more careful comparison should take into account the actual sound levels to be radiated in the particular critical direction(s).
Table B
Correction terms C to be used in converting Sound Power Level into average Sound Pressure Level for special fiveposition procedure given.
Measurement Distance (to Acoustic Center) (m) 7,5 9 10,5 12 13,5 15 18,5 Correction Term K for Lw re 10-12 Watt (dB) 26 27 28 30 31 32 33
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 45
Note: The correction term C is based on the sound radiating uniformly over a hemisphere. This would apply for a typical ground level installation or for a unit located on a large roof. If there are conditions such that the sound will radiate over a large angle, say a 3/4 sphere, add 3 dB to the above C. Subtract 3 dB from the above C for a 1/4 sphere radiation.
For distance beyond 30 m calculate the average Lp for 15 m using the method here; then extrapolate to the desired distance using the Lp reduction values of table 6 in section "Effect of Distance beyond 15 m"
Appendix C
Addition of Decibels
Since decibels are logarithmic values it is not proper to add them by normal algebraic addition. For example, 63 dB plus 63 dB does not equal 126 dB but only 66 dB. A very simple, but adequate schedule for adding decibels is as follows:
When two decibel values differ by: 0 or 1 dB 2 or 3 dB 4 to 8 dB 9 dB or more Add the following amount to the higher value 3 dB 2 dB 1 dB 0 dB
When several decibel values are to be added, perform the above operation on any two numbers at a time, the order does not matter. Continue the process until only a single value remains. As an illustration let us add the five sound levels used in the example of Appendix B.
Sometimes, using different orders of adding may yield sums that might differ by 1 dB, but this is not too significant a difference in acoustics. In general, the above simplified summation procedure will yield accurate sums to the nearest 1 dB. This degree of accuracy is considered acceptable in the material given in this article.
TR - G 46
Appendix D
BAC Sound Evaluation Worksheet
Job Name______________________________ Date_____________________________________ Address _______________________________ Engineer ________________________________ Architect ______________________________ BAC Model_________________________________
Items 63 Step : Noise Criterion 1. Determine appropriate "NC" Criterion for neighbour activity from Table 2 2. Insert sound pressure levels (Lp) for selected "NC" Criterion. (Obtain values from Figure 1 or Table 1) 3. Tabulate sound reduction provided by wall construction. (Obtain values from Table 3) 4. Establish tentative outdoor Noise Criterion for the unit. (Item 2 plus Item 3) 5. List average minimum outdoor background sound levels. (measured or estimated from Figure 2 and Tables 4 and 5) 6. Set final outdoor background Noise Criterion. (High value, by octave band, of Items 4 and 5) Step : Sound Levels 7. Enter unit sound pressure level rating at 15 m. 8. Insert distance correction to adjust unit ratings to distance of _ m in direction toward critical neighbour. (For distance greater than 15 m use Table 6; for distances less than 15 m use Table 7) 9. Establish outdoor unit Lp at neighbour location. (Item 7 minus Item 8 for distances greater than 15 m. Item 7 plus Item 8 for distances less than 15 m. 10. Apply reflection adjustment to meet condition existing at unit site. Refer to Figures 3 and 4 for effect of reflecting walls; or add 5 dB for close-in build up of noise; 0 dB if no reflection effects. 11. Tabulate resultant unit Lp at critical neighbour location. (Item 9 plus Item 10) Step : Comparison, Criteria vs Levels 12. Copy Item 6 levels from above. This is the outdoor noise criterion for the critical neighbour. 13. Ascertain tentative sound reduction required for unit. (Item 11 minus Item 12. Insert "0" for negative values) 14. Apply judgement factor. (For conservative approach, use "0" in all bands. To permit unit noise to exceed background levels slightly , insert "5") 15. Tabulate final sound reduction requirement for the job. (Item 13 minus item 14) 16. Indicate estimated or rated attenuation of all sound reduction treatment if used. (Should at least equal Item 15) 125 250 Center Frequency - Hz 500 1000 2000 4000 8000
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 47
Motor Controls
Introduction
The BAC motor control panels, incorporating Variable Frequency Drives (VFD), are specially designed seamlessly with BAC units and are engineered to meet specific application needs related to evaporative cooling equipment. BAC motor controls offer : Single Source Responsibility: BAC has designed the controls taking into consideration the exact specifications of the fan motor, and providing you with a single source solution. Indoor / Outdoor Applications: BAC offers enclosures with location flexibility; whether in a mechanical equipment room or outdoors next to the equipment.
Keypad Setting
Industrial Grade Components: While satisfying the industrys demands for a top performance variable frequency drive, the BAC motor controls are hailed as a truly environmentally friendly drive. The careful selection of the latest technology industrial grade components provide full motor protection for the evaporative cooling tower. Easy Installation: The BAC motor control is a compact, minimum maintenance reliable AC3 drive, allowing ease of installation due to the pre-engineered concept. Energy Savings: Evaporative water-cooled systems, whether for comfort cooling or process applications, offer substantial year-round system energy savings compared to air-cooled alternatives. Proper system control is crucial to fully utilising this advantage and operating your system at peak efficiency under all combinations of atmospheric and load conditions. BACs technical expertise in this field can show you how saving energy can also save you water when using BAC motor controls for a truly green solution.
Construction Details
Epoxy painted steel cabinet - IP 54 insulation class - Fan cooled with independent thermostat - Anti-condensation heaters - Rain shield for cold/warm weather protection 3-Pole Main Disconnect Switch - Suitable for AC3 operation - Lockable operator handle in OFF position - NO / NC contacts for auxiliary control panel Variable Frequency Drive (VFD) - Including EMC filters according EN50081 and EN50082 - Removable keypad with rotary knob - Ready, run and fault indicators - Programmable buttons & lights - Monitors motor speed, actual temperature or set point water temperature. - CE compliance to EN 61800 & EN 20178 - RS 485 communications BAC-TPU-01 Controller - Used as temperature controller / signal converter - Sensor input 0 10 Volt BAC Type OT-EMM Sensing Elements - PT 100 element - 0 10 Volt output Manual 3 Pole Bypass Switch - Automatic VDF or manual control switch Manual Star-Delta Starter - Bypass operator for manual control of fan motor
TR - G 48
Typical VFD Arrangement Standard VFD includes an enclosure, 24VDC power supply, control power transformer, main circuit breaker, disconnect switch with lockable operator handle, manual bypass, cooling fan and a detachable, programmable VFD keypad.
Circuit Breaker Protection, which allows for quick reset, is standard on all BAC VFDs. The circuit breaker is mechanically linked to the rotary disconnect switch mounted on the front of the panel. User Interface Keypad controls auto modes. temperature, and fault codes. The multi-monitor display shows fan speed, set point, measured
Engineering Specifications
Equipment controls (optional) Variable Frequency Drive(s): A variable frequency drive (VFD) shall be provided for each tower. The supplier of the VFD shall be the manufacturer of the evaporative cooling equipment. The VFD shall have a manual bypass, a removable keypad, and a circuit breaker disconnect. Fuse protection will not be accepted. VFD shall be provided in an IP 54 enclosure. The heavy-duty, non-fusible safety disconnect switch shall be provided by the manufacturer of the evaporative cooling equipment. Switch shall be single-throw, 3-pole design. Switch shall have triple padlocking capability and a clear visible On/Off handle A temperature sensor shall be provided with the enclosed controls and a temperature controller shall be provided with the enclosed VFD. Option: A vibration cut-out switch input shall be provided
Note: For availability of the BAC motor controls on a specific product line, contact your local BAC Balticare representative.
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 49
Plume Abatement
Evaporative Cooling & Plume
Air enters at condition A. Air picks up heat and water in the evaporative fluid cooler ( discharge condition B ). Ambient air serves as heat sink for the discharge air ( line AB ). Intersection of saturation line leads to visible plume. Large intersection area : more plume, small intersection area : less plume.
Note: Plume is the condensation of water vapour and is harmless to the environment.
Large surface area plume abatement coils are installed in the air discharge of the evaporative coil products and piped in series with the wet coil. To be effective they must have low air and fluid side pressure drops. This results in:
TR - G 50
Significant extension of dry operation capacity. Effective increase of discharge air temperature to reduce / eliminate plume during wet operation. Additional sensible heat transfer during wet operation which saves water and treatment costs. Plume abatement coil sizing and performance prediction require a thorough evaluation of thermodynamic and airside behaviour as well as an understanding of climate condition influences. BAC can provide properly sized plume abatement coils and accurate performance data.
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 51
Formulas
Fan Laws
The fan laws can be used to approximately predict the performance of equipment with a different fan speed: Flow 2 = Flow 1 (kW2/kW1)1/3
Formulas
Range = Entering Temperature Leaving Temperature Approach = Leaving Temperature Wet Bulb Temperature Heat Rejected: Heat Rejection (kW) = Flow (l/s) x range (C) x 4,186 Temperature conversions: Fahrenheit to Celsius : Temp (C) = 0.5556 5temp (F) 32 Celsius to Fahrenheit : Temp (F) = 1.8 Temp (C) + 32 Basic Electrical: E=IxR E = Voltage (Volts), I= current (amps), R = resistance (Ohm)
TR - G 52
Replacement Parts
BAC parts are the Perfect Fit for your cooling tower. These parts are specifically designed, engineered and manufactured to work in a cooling tower environment. They are the right parts, at competitive pricing levels, and BAC offers the best deliveries in the industry. BAC stocks most common repair and retrofit parts in our Central Parts Distribution Center and can ship other parts, often overnight, from any of three manufacturing facilities strategically located in Europe. Even with this fast delivery capability, it is still recommended that certain essential, emergency repair parts be maintained in your local inventory, to minimize any potential downtime.
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 53
Application Guidelines
Introduction
The satisfactory performance of evaporative cooling equipment is dependent on correct selection and proper attention to overall system design, installation, water care and maintenance. The purpose of this document is to highlight the major points, which should be considered when designing a system with BAC evaporative cooling equipment.
Equipment Configurations
BAC evaporative cooling equipment is available in following configurations:
Cooling Towers Counterflow Crossflow Combined Flow VXT, VTL, RCT, IMT Series 3000D, FXT, TXV FXV, HXI CXV, HXC Closed Circuit Cooling Towers VXI, VFL Evaporative Condensers VXC, VXC-C, VCL
Thermal Duty
The selection of a particular model is based on a thermal duty and the wet bulb temperature. Thermal ratings are based on the wet bulb temperature of the air entering the equipment and do not take into account any recirculation of warm and humid discharge air, which may occur under certain weather and wind conditions. Verification of ratings assumes a test according to a recognised test standard and the application of tolerances as recorded during the test and applied to the test results.
Operating Conditions
Cooling Towers Counterflow Design pressure std. coil (bar) Design pressure high press. coil (kPa) Spray pressure, max. at inlet (kPa) fill spacing std(mm) (1) Inlet temperature, max. (C) Inlet temperature CPVC. max. (C) Inlet temperature, PP, max. (C) Outlet temperature, min. (C) Make up pressure mechanical valve (kPa) (2) NA NA 50 14 55 65 80 5 100-500 Crossflow NA NA NA 19 50 58 NA 5 100-500 Evaporative. Closed Circuit Cooling Towers Counterflow 10 NA 14 NA 80 NA NA 10 100-500 Combined Flow 10 NA 14 19 60 NA NA 10 100-500 Evaporative . Condensers Counterflow 22 28 14 NA 120 NA NA -20 100-500 Combined Flow 22 28 14 19 120 NA NA -20 100-500
(1) BACount (PVC or CPVC) fill has spacing of 14 mm and is used on all counterflow cooling towers except IMT and RCT. For these product lines fill spacing std. options are 12 mm or 19 mm. Other options are available upon request. PP fill spacings are 12 mm for VXT and VTL and 12 mm or 19 mm for IMT or RCT. (2) It must be ensured that adequate make up water supply is available for proper operation of the equipment within the supply pressure range suitable for the make up valve. Alternative valve selections are available for such cases.
TR - G 54
Water Quality
Evaporative cooling is accomplished by the evaporation of a small portion of water. As water evaporates, the dissolved solids originally present in the water remain in the system. The concentration of dissolved solids increases rapidly and can reach unacceptable levels. In addition, airborne impurities and biological contaminants are often introduced into the recirculating water, since the evaporative cooler is washing the air. If impurities and contaminants are not effectively controlled, they can cause scaling, corrosion, sludge or biological fouling, which reduce heat transfer efficiency and increase system operating costs. For optimal heat transfer efficiency and maximum equipment life, the quality of the make-up and recirculating water should be maintained within the limitations listed below.
Make-Up Water
Make-up water to the evaporative cooler should be between 30 and 70 ppm hardness as CaCO3. Where use of a softener is necessary to achieve this, the supply to the evaporative cooler should not be totally softened, but blended with the incoming unsoftened water to achieve the minimum hardness between 30 and 70 ppm as Ca CO3. Maintaining a minimum hardness in the make-up water offsets the corrosive properties of totally softened water and reduces the reliance on corrosion inhibitors to protect the system.
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 55
Baltiplus Protection pH Hardness as (CaCO3) Alkaline as (CaCO3) Total Dissolved Solids Chlorides Sulfates Conductivity Chlorination (as free chlorine): continuous 7.0 to 9.0 30 to 500 mg/l 500 mg/l max. 1000 mg/l max. 125 mg/l max. 125 mg/l max. 1200 S/m 1 mg / l max.
Chlorination (as free chlorine): batch dosing for cleaning & disinfec- 5-15 mg / l max. for 6 hours max. tion
BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection System pH Hardness as (CaCO3) Alkaline as (CaCO3) Total Dissolved Solids Chlorides Sulfates Conductivity Chlorination (as free chlorine): continuous 6.5 to 9.0 30 to 500 mg/l 500 mg/l max. 1500 mg/l max. 250 mg/l max. 250 mg/l max. 1800 S/m 2 mg / l max.
Chlorination (as free chlorine): batch dosing for cleaning & disinfec- 5-15 mg / l max. for 6 hours max. tion
Table 9: Circulated Water Quality Guidelines for Baltibond Corrosion Protection System
FRP pH Hardness as (CaCO3) Alkaline as (CaCO3) Total Dissolved Solids Chlorides Sulfates Conductivity Chlorination (as free chlorine): continuous 6.5 to 9.0 30 to 500 mg/l 500 mg/l max. 1500 mg/l max. 250 mg/l max. 250 mg/l max. 1800 S/m 2 mg / l max.
Chlorination (as free chlorine): batch dosing for cleaning & disinfec- 5-15 mg / l max. for 6 hours max. tion
TR - G 56
SST AISI 304 pH Hardness as (CaCO3) Alkaline as (CaCO3) Total Dissolved Solids Chlorides Sulfates Conductivity Chlorination (as free chlorine): continuous Chlorination (as free chlorine): batch dosing for cleaning & disinfection 6.5 to 9.0 50 to 500 mg/l 500 mg/l max. 1500 mg/l max. 250 mg/l max. 250 mg/l max. 2500 S/m 2 mg / l max.
SST AISI 316 6.5 to 9.0 50 to 500 mg/l 500 mg/l max. 1500 mg/l max. 500 mg/l max. 500 mg/l max. 2500 S/m 2 mg / l max.
Blow Down
To prevent an excessive build-up of impurities in the recirculating water, a small amount of water must be bled from the recirculating water. In many localities, this constant bleed and replacement with fresh make-up water will keep the concentration of impurities in the system at an acceptable level. The Bleed Rate will depend on the Cycles of Concentration required to maintain recirculating water quality and the Evaporation Rate. After the Cycles of Concentration has been determined, the Bleed Rate can be calculated using the following equation: B = E / (N 1) Where B = Bleed Rate in l/s; E = Evaporation Rate in l/s; N = Number of Cycles of Concentration. methods:
The Evaporation Rate is approximately 1,8 litres per 1000 kcal of heat rejection. The Evaporation Rate is approximately 1,8 litres per 4180 kJ. Evaporation Rate = Water Flow Rate (I/s) x Range (C) x 0,0018 Evaporation Rate = Total Heat Rejection kW / 2322 = l/s
Examples :
Method n 2: At a flow rate of 10 I/s and a cooling range of 10 C the evaporation rate is 0.18 l/s (10 l/s x 10 C x 0,0018 = 0,18 I/s) Method n 4: Duty calculates to 418kW, therefore the evaporation rate is 0.18 l/s (418 / 2322 = 0.18 l/s)
Note: The calculation method described above should not be used to determine the water consumption of evaporative cooling equipment. Next to heat load and water quality the water consumption depends on climatic conditions, the capacity control strategy and the equipment configuration. Water consumption calculations are therefore complex and therefore should not be based on the maximum evaporation rate, which occurs at dry ambient conditions. The calculation method here is only suitable for the purpose of sizing a proper blow down.
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 57 Water Treatment
The water treatment guidelines below should be followed: 1. Water treatment chemicals or non-chemical systems need to be compatible with the materials of construction used in the cooling system including the evaporative cooling equipment itself. 2. Water treatment chemicals should be added to the recirculating water by an automatic feed system on a continuously metered basis. This will prevent localised high concentrations of chemicals, which may cause corrosion. Preferably the water treatment chemicals should be fed into the cooling system at the discharge of the recirculation pump. The chemicals should not be fed in concentrated form, nor batch fed directly into the cold water sump of the evaporative cooling equipment. 3. Acid water treatment is not recommended. Acid treatment can be considered for open cooling towers furnished with the BALTIBOND Corrosion Protection or constructed from stainless steel, provided the requirements specified above are followed. 4. A competent water treatment company should be consulted for the specific water treatment programme to be applied. Next to the supply of dosing and control equipment and chemicals, the programme should include regular monthly monitoring of the circulating and make up water quality.
Location
Each cooling tower, evaporative cooler or condenser should be located and positioned to prevent the introduction of the discharge air and the associated drift, which may contain contaminants, such as Legionella, into the ventilation systems or open windows of buildings. To yield full thermal performance, equipment location must be chosen in a way that there is unimpeded supply of air to the entire air intake surface. In addition access to all maintenance and inspection points must be safeguarded. Located in enclosures or close to adjoining building walls, the top of the equipment must be level with or higher than the top of the adjacent walls in order to reduce the possibility of recirculating warm and humid discharge air back to the air intake(s). To accomplish this, in some cases the equipment needs to be installed elevated or equipped with discharge hoods or ductwork. In case of elevated locations (more than 300 mm above surface), it is necessary to equip VX equipment with a solid bottom panel, to provide protection from moving parts and ensure that the air is drawn horizontally into the cooling tower and not from the bottom (bottom air entry can be considered but requires reduction of nominal fan speed to avoid fan motor overload). For indoor locations with forced draught centrifugal fan equipment it is common practice to apply ductwork to air entry and discharge. Such ductwork must be designed for even air distribution and minimum pressure drop and access doors must be foreseen to allow access to the interior of the duct and from there to the equipment itself. In some cases the equipment room may be used as an intake plenum, in which case only discharge ductwork is needed. In such cases measures need be taken to prevent erratic air distribution when switching fans and/or cells, for example by the sue of positive closure discharge dampers.
TR - G 58
Piping
General
Piping should be sized and installed in accordance with rules of good practice. Dead legs and stagnant water conditions in the piping should be avoided. If more than one inlet connection is required, balancing valves should be installed to properly balance the flow to each inlet. Depending on the design of the hydraulic circuit, it may also be necessary to install balancing valves at the suction connections of the towers. The use of shut off valves is dictated by the necessity to (automatically or manually) isolate cells or towers for capacity control or servicing. If the equipment is installed on vibration rails, compensators must be installed in the connecting piping.
Evaporative Condensers
Refer to BAC Evaporative Condenser Engineering Manual. For installations with high pressure float valves, ensure that liquid piping from condenser outlet to valve(s) is sized for low refrigerant velocity (0.5 m/s) so that valve operation is not disturbed by flash gas and that an equalising line is properly installed. For systems with thermosyphon oil cooling ensure adequate equalising and sufficient height difference between condenser(s) and receiver.
Capacity Control
General
Most cooling systems are subject to substantial changes in heat load and ambient temperature conditions during the operating season. The capacity of evaporative cooling equipment varies greatly as the wet bulb temperature changes. To prevent freezing inside the equipment at subfreezing ambient conditions and/or when a reasonably constant temperature of the cooling water is desired, some form of capacity control is required. The preferred control method is to reduce the airflow through the equipment to adapt to heat load and ambient conditions. It is not recommended to modulate the water (fluid) flow for capacity control reasons. Regardless the type of capacity control chosen, it is necessary to start the circulating pump first and the fan motor(s) thereafter. At the same time prolonged operation of circulating pump(s) only without fan(s) running should be avoided during subfreezing conditions.
Fan Cycling
Fan cycling is the simplest method of capacity control, suitable for multiple cell installations. The number of control steps available for fan cycling is generally determined by the number of fan motors, however on certain models two fan motors must be cycled simultaneously to prevent erratic air distribution. Consult your BAC Balticare Representative for more details. The more steps for fan cycling are available the better the control of the cooling water temperature is. Rapid onoff cycling can cause the fan motor to overheat. It is recommended that controls be set to allow a maximum of 6 on-off starts per hour.
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 59 Multi-Speed Drives
The number of steps available for fan cycling can be increased by using multi-speed drives. These can either be accomplished by the installation of multi-speed motors (Dahlander/Two speed separate windings) or the BALTIGUARD Drive system. At half of the nominal fan speed (Dahlander/two speed, separate windings) the nominal capacity of the tower will be appr. 60%; at 2/3 of nominal fan speed (BALTIGUARD) the nominal capacity of the tower will be appr. 70%. When switching from high to low speed a time interval of min. 15 s must be foreseen, before the low speed drive can be activated to allow the fan(s) to slow down.
Winter Safety
General
Unless the system is shut down and drained during winter, measures must be taken to protect the system from freezing during the winter during operation and standstill. Freeze protection during operation is achieved by selecting an adequate method of capacity control. For reasonably constant loads and cooling water or condensing temperatures above 15C step control is usually adequate. For variable loads, in particular when combined with free cooling modulating controls are recommended. When the equipment is shut down in freezing weather the sump water must be protected. This can be accomplished by the installation of electrical sump heaters. The standard electric heaters are sized to maintain +4C sump water when the ambient temperature drops to 18C. All sump heaters have six power terminals and one earth terminal. Heaters with six terminals can be wired in Star for 400 Volt; 3 phase supply; or in Delta for 230 Volt, 3 phase supply. All heaters can alternatively be used with a 230 Volt single-phase supply, if the terminals are wired in parallel. Sump heaters need to be sized to maintain a sump water temperature of 4C at an applicable ambient temperature (for example: - 18C). They are installed together with a heater thermostat and a low level cut out switch to prevent heater operation, when the sump is drained. Draining the sump water into a separate tank installed in an area protected from freezing, is an alternative to auxiliary heating of the integral sump. Remote sump sizing must include the water draining from external piping, the tower water distribution system, water suspended in the fill pack or coil and sump as well as water needed to prevent vortexing inside the remote sump. In addition to the sump all exposed water piping, pumps and make up lines, including mechanical or electrical valves that do not drain at shutdown should be traced with electrical heater tape and insulated.
TR - G 60
1. Maintain the recommended minimum flow (refer to BAC product engineering data) through the coil(s) at all times. 2. Maintain a heat load on the circulating fluid, so that the temperature of the fluid leaving the cooler will not fall below 10C. (refer to "Engineering Data" for heat loss data) Draining of the coil(s) is not recommended as a normal method of freeze protection unless the coil(s) are constructed from stainless steel or are of the cleanable type. For standard hot dip galvanised coils draining is acceptable as an emergency method of freeze protection. For this purpose an automatic drain valve and air vent needs to be installed to drain the coil(s) if flow stops or the fluid temperature drops below 10C when the ambient temperature is below freezing.
Sound
BAC provides sound data as sound pressure levels in 5 directions, in 1,5 m and 15 m from the equipment as well as overall sound power levels. Data are available for equipment with and without sound attenuation and should be the base of any acoustical specification and guarantee for outdoor locations. For indoor locations it is preferable to specify partial sound power levels for the air intake and discharge areas. For sound pressure specifications relating to indoor locations, consult the BAC Balticare Representative.
Maintenance
Regular maintenance in accordance with the appropriate BAC Operating and Maintenance instructions and with prevailing local regulations and Codes is essential for the efficient and safe operation of a cooling tower, evaporative cooler or condenser. A programme of regular maintenance and inspections needs to be set up, executed and documented. For proper execution of maintenance and inspections and depending on site conditions ladders, safety cages, stairways, access platforms with handrails and toe-boards must be installed as appropriate for the safety and convenience of authorised service and maintenance personnel.
Safety
For safe operation of unshielded equipment exposed to wind speeds above 120 km/h installed at a height above 30 m from the ground, contact your local BAC Balticare Representative. For safe operation of equipment installed in moderate and high hazard areas contact your local BAC Balticare representative.
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 61
Glossary
Air-Conditioning: The control of the temperature, humidity, cleanliness (quality) and movement of air in a confined space. Airflow: The distribution or movement of air through a space; generally measured in cubic feet per minute (cfm). Air Handling Unit: The central component of an HVAC system that distributes conditioned air to a variety of destinations. Algae: Small, usually aquatic plants which require light to grow. Ambient: The surrounding atmosphere. Ambient Air Temperature: The surrounding air temperature, such as the outdoor air temperature around a building. Approach: The difference between the leaving water temperature and the ambient wet-bulb temperature. ARI: Air-Conditioning and Refrigeration Institute. ASHRAE: American Society of Heating, Refrigeration and Air Conditioning Engineers. Biocide: A chemical capable of killing living microorganisms. Biological Contaminants: Living organisms or agents derived from those organisms (e.g., viruses, bacteria, fungi, and mammal and bird antigens) that can be inhaled and can cause many types of health effects including allergicreactions, respiratory disorders, hypersensitivity diseases, and infectious diseases. Also referred to as "microbiologicals" or "microbials. Bleed: Water deliberately removed from evaporative cooling equipment to control the concentration of dissolved solids in the system. BTU (British Thermal Unit): The amount of heat required to raise or lower the temperature of one pound of water one degree Fahrenheit. BTUH (British Thermal Unit Per Hour): Establishes a time reference to BTU input or output. A BTUH is how many BTUs are used per hour. Bypass Connection: An inlet connection provided in the cold water basin of a unit that allows recirculating water to bypass the heat transfer media when system pumps are running but evaporative cooling is not required. Capacity: The output or producing ability of a piece of equipment. Evaporative cooling capacity is normally referred to in BTUHs; the capacity at a standard set of conditions is often referred to as "tons of cooling." Carryover: Excessive drift. Casing: The exterior panels of an evaporative cooling unit. Cell: The smallest subdivision of a unit that can operate independently; often multiple cells are used together to form one unit of a greater capacity. Celsius (C): A temperature scale based on the freezing (0 degrees) and boiling (100 degrees) points of water. Also known as Centigrade. Conversion to Fahrenheit: F = 1.8(C) + 32 CFM (Cubic Feet per Minute): A standard measurement of airflow that indicates how many cubic feet of air pass by a stationary point in one minute. Charge: The amount of refrigerant placed in a refrigeration unit. Chiller: A device that produces chilled water to provide cooling for HVAC and industrial applications. Circulating Water: See Reirculating Water. Cogeneration: Simultaneous production of two or more forms of useable energy from a single fuel source, e.g., heat energy and electrical or mechanical power, in the same facility. Coil: A tube, often including fins, through which gas or liquid is passed, exchanging thermal energy with air or water surrounding it for heating or cooling purposes. Cold Water Basin: The collection pan that houses the cold water processed by the evaporative cooling unit. Combined Flow: The use of both a coil and wet deck surface for heat transfer in a closed circuit cooling tower or evaporative condeser. Combined flow designs reduce evaporation in the coil section. Comfort Cooling: The process of treating air to control its temperature to meet the comfort requirements of the occupants of a conditioned space.
TR - G 62
Commercial: The commercial sector is generally defined as non-manufacturing business establishments; this classification includes hotels, restaurants, office buildings, retail stores, educational institutions, etc. Commissioning: The start-up of a building that includes testing and adjusting HVAC, electrical, plumbing, and other systems to assure proper functioning and adherence to design criteria. Commissioning also includes the instruction of operating personnel in the use of the building systems. Compressor: The pump of a refrigerating mechanism that draws a low-pressure gas on the cooling side of the refrigerant cycle and compresses the gas into the high-pressure side of the cycle. The compressor maintains adequate pressure to cause refrigerant to flow in sufficient quantities to meet the cooling requirements of the system. Conduction: The transfer of heat through a solid material. The transfer of heat energy through a material (solid, liquid or gas) by the motion of adjacent atoms and molecules without gross displacement of the particles. Contactor: A switch used to make or break an electrical circuit. Convection: The movement of heat by airflow. Cooling Tower: Any device in which atmospheric air and water are distributed together over a heat transfer medium in order to lower the temperature of the water through evaporative cooling. Corrosion Inhibitors: Chemicals designed to prevent or slow down the waterside corrosion of metals. Counterflow: The flow of air is in the opposite direction of the flow of water. CRN: Canadian Registration Number. This registration is sometimes required on coils shipping into Canada. Crossflow: The flow of air is at a right angle to the direction of the flow of water. CTI: The Cooling Technology Institute (CTI) is an organization comprised of evaporative cooling equipment owners and operators, equipment manufacturers and component suppliers, and water treatment specialists, which advocates and promotes the use of environmentally responsible Evaporative Heat Transfer Systems for the benefit of the public through education, research, standards development, government relations, and technical information exchange. Current: A flow of electrons in an electrical conductor. The strength or rate of flow is generally measured in amperes. Damper: A series of movable plates that can be opened or closed to control the flow of air through a space. Decibel (dB): A decibel describes the relative loudness of a sound. The dimensionless unit of measurement used in noise control. Logarithmically expresses the ratio of sound level to a reference level (0.0002 microbar). Defrost Cycle: The process of removing ice or frost buildup from a piece of equipment during the winter months. Delta (or Delta T or T): A difference in temperature. Often used in the context of the difference between the entering water temperature and the leaving water temperature of a cooling tower or closed circuit cooling tower. Demand (Utility): The rate at which electricity or natural gas is delivered to or by a system, part of a system, or piece of equipment at a given instant or averaged over any designated period of time. Electricity demand is typically expressed in kilowatts. Demand Billing: The electric capacity requirement for which a large user pays. It may be based on the customer's peak demand during the contract year, on a previous maximum or on an agreed minimum. Measured in kilowatts. Demand Charge: The sum to be paid by a large electricity consumer for its peak usage level. Design Conditions: A set of conditions specific to the local climate and expected building usage, used to calculate the cooling load for a building. Dewpoint: The temperature at which air becomes saturated with water and begins to condense, forming a dew. Drift: The water aerosol carried out of an evaporative cooling unit by the discharge air. Drift eliminator: A component of most evaporative cooling units that is designed to remove water droplets from the air passing through it. Dry-Bulb Temperature (DB): The temperature measured by a standard thermometer. A measure of the sensible temperature of air. Efficiency: The ratio of the output to the input of any system. Electric Resistance Heater: A device that produces heat through electric resistance. Energy: Broadly defined, energy is the capability of doing work. In the electric power industry, energy is more narrowly defined as electricity supplied over time, generally expressed in kilowatts.
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 63
Energy Management System: A control system designed to regulate the energy consumption of a building by controlling the operation of energy consuming systems, such as the heating, ventilation and air conditioning (HVAC), lighting and water heating systems. Entering Water Temperature (EWT): The temperature of the fluid as it returns to the evaporative cooling equipment from the system heat source. Enthalpy: A thermodynamic function of a system, equivalent to the sum of the internal energy of the system plus the product of its volume multiplied by the pressure exerted on it by its surroundings. Equalizer Connection: A connection in the cold water basin of a unit that allows piping (the piping is called an equalizer line) to be run from that unit to the basin of another unit; equalizer lines serve to correct any difference in water levels that may develop during operation. Evaporative Cooling: Cooling accomplished through the exchange of latent heat in the form of evaporation. External Pulldown Volume: The volume of water in any external piping and heat exchangers that will drain back to the unit when the pump is shut down, which is equal to the total pulldown volume minus the water suspended in the unit and its distribution system. External Static Pressure: The pressure imposed on cooling equipment by external sources such as ductwork and sound attenuation. Fahrenheit (F): A temperature scale in which the boiling point of water is 212 degrees and its freezing point is 32 degrees at normal atmospheric pressure. Conversion to Celsius: C = (F 32)/1.8 Fan, Axial: An air moving device consisting of impeller blades oriented around a central shaft, usually with an aerodynamic inlet housing; axial fans typically move large volumes of air at low pressures as compared to centrifugal fans for the same fan horsepower. Fan, Centrifugal: An air moving device consisting of impeller blades radially oriented parallel to a central shaft, bound with a rim and hub; centrifugal fans typically move smaller volumes of air than axial fans but at a higher pressure for the same fan horsepower. Fan Coil Unit: A terminal unit that delivers conditioned air directly to the occupied space. Fan Deck: The finished surface adjacent to a horizontally mounted axial fan, sometimes used as a working surface to perform maintenance when the proper safety precautions are taken (handrails, ladder, etc.). Fiberglass Reinforced Polyester (FRP): A non-corrosive composite material comprised of a plastic resin matrix, glass fiber reinforcement and other additives. Fill: See Wet Deck. Filtration: The process of separating solids from a liquid by means of a filter media through which only the liquid passes. Flume Box: A short channel that runs between two cooling towers, allowing water to flow from one cold water basin to another; a flume box serves to correct any difference in water levels that may develop during operation and generally has a greater capacity of water flow than an equalizer line. Forced Draft: Refers to the location of the fan(s) on evaporative cooling equipment. On forced draft equipment, the fans are located at the air inlets to force or push air through the unit. Fouling: Organic growth or other deposits on heat transfer surfaces causing loss of efficiency. Frequency: The number of cycles that an alternating current moves through in each second. Standard electric utility frequency in the United States is 60 cycles per second (60 Hertz). Full Load Amps (FLA): The current draw of a motor under full load. GPM: Measure of liquid flow rate (Gallons Per Minute). Typically based on U.S. gallons, sometimes clarified as USGPM. Heat Exchanger: A device for the transfer of heat energy from the source to the conveying medium. Heat Pump: A device that is capable of both heating and cooling space, depending on user comfort requirements. Heat pumps are generally individually controlled and therefore a heat pump in one room may be heating, while a heat pump in an adjacent room may be cooling. Heat Transfer: Moving heat from one location to another. Hertz (Hz): A unit of electromagnetic wave frequency that is equal to one cycle per second. Hot Water Basin: The collection pan that houses the hot water in an evaporative cooling unit with a gravity distribution system. Humidity: The amount of moisture in the air. HVAC: Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning.
TR - G 64
Induced Draft: Refers to the location of the fan(s) on evaporative cooling equipment. On induced draft equipment, the fans are located on the air discharge side of the equipment to induce air through the unit. Industrial: The industrial sector is generally defined as manufacturing, construction, mining, agriculture, fishing, and forestry establishments (Standard Industrial Classification [SIC] codes 01-39). Interference: The reintroduction of warm discharge air from one evaporative cooling unit into the air inlet of an adjacent unit. To avoid interference, layout guidelines provided by equipment manufacturers should be closely followed. Inverter: See Variable Frequency Drive. ISO 9001: 2000: A comprehensive, internationally recognized standard which is concerned with all aspects of quality management in the design, engineering and manufacturing of a product. Latent Heat: Heat that causes a change in state when added or removed, but does not cause a change in temperature. For example, heat that evaporates a substance from a liquid to a vapor but does not increase its temperature. Leaving Water Temperature (LWT): The temperature of the fluid as it leaves the evaporative cooling equipment to return to the system heat source. Legionella: A genus of bacteria; most species of this genus are capable of causing disease in humans. LD, Legionnaires Disease, is a pneumonia like disease caused by one genus of Legionella Life-Cycle Cost: The amount of money required to own, operate and maintain a piece of equipment over its useful life. Load: The demand for services or performance made on a machine or system, i.e. amount of heat rejection required by the evaporative cooling equipment Louver: A series of sloping vanes that allow the entrance of air but prevent the escape of water droplets. Make-Up Water: Water added to the recirculating water to compensate for losses from evaporation and bleed. NEMA: National Electrical Manufacturing Association. Nozzle: A device used for regulating and directing the flow of a fluid. Parts Per Million (PPM): A unit which represents a comparison of mass to mass, volume to volume, mass to volume, etc.; commonly used to represent the concentration of dissolved solids in the recirculating water of evaporative cooling equipment. Plenum: The open area of a crossflow evaporative cooling unit through which air is pulled before being discharged to the atmosphere. Plume: Saturated discharge air that forms a visible cloud over evaporative cooling equipment under certain temperature and humidity conditions. Polyvinyl Chloride (PVC): A polymer of vinyl chloride often used for a heat transfer media surface (film) and piping on factory-assembled evaporative cooling equipment. Power: The rate at which energy is transferred. Electricity for use as energy is also referred to as power. Preventive Maintenance: Regular maintenance implemented to reduce the possibility of sudden or unexpected equipment failures. Pulldown: Water that collects in the cold water basin of a unit when the system pumps shut off. Pump, Spray: A water moving device on a closed circuit cooling tower or evaporative condenser for transporting the spray water from the basin to the water distribution system in order to wet the heat transfer surface. Pump, System: A flow moving device for transporting the fluid to be cooled (water in a cooling tower; water, glycol, or other fluid in the case of a closed circuit cooling tower) to the tower and back to the system in a continuous loop. Range: The difference between the entering water temperature and leaving water temperature of an evaporative cooling unit. See also Delta. Recirculating Water: The water being circulated over the coil or fill in an evaporative cooling unit. Recirculation: Situation that occurs when the warm discharge air flows back into the air inlets of the evaporative cooling equipment. To avoid recirculation, layout guidelines provided by equipment manufacturers should be closely followed. Reclaiming: Processing or returning used refrigerant to the manufacturer or processor for disposal or reuse. Refrigerant: A chemical that condenses from a vapor to liquid and, in the process, decreases in temperature. Refrigerant Charge: The amount of refrigerant in a system. Retrofit: Broad term that applies to any change after the original purchase, such as adding equipment or accessories to an existing installation.
Baltimore Aircoil
TR - G 65
Saturation Temperature: Also referred to as the boiling point or the condensing temperature. This is the temperature at which a refrigerant will change state from a liquid to a vapor or vice versa. Scale: The accumulation of solids from the minerals contained in water, most often referred to as hardness deposits, i.e. calcium and magnesium. Scale Inhibitor: Chemical added to water to inhibit formation of scale. Sensible Heat: Heat that causes a change in temperature when added or removed, but does not cause a change in state. Separator: A device which uses centrifugal force to separate particles from a suspension; used to remove sediment from evaporative cooling systems. Setpoint: The temperature to which a thermostat is set to result in a desired heated space temperature. Sound Attenuator: Component used on the air inlet or air discharge of an evaporative cooling unit to reduce airborne noise. Specific Heat: In English units, the quantity of heat, in BTU, needed to raise the temperature of one pound of material one degree Fahrenheit. Strainer: A filter used to remove large, suspended solids from a liquid. Subcooled Liquid: Liquid refrigerant that is cooled below its saturation temperature. Suction Connection: The outlet connection through which leaving water is pumped back to the chiller. Sump: The cold water basin of the evaporative cooling equipment. Superheated Vapor: Refrigerant vapor that is heated above its saturation temperature. Thermal (Energy) Storage: A technology that lowers the amount of electricity needed for comfort conditioning during utility peak load periods. A buildings thermal energy storage system might, for example, use off-peak power to make ice at night, then use the ice for cooling during the day. Thermostat: A temperature control device that consists of a series of sensors and relays that monitor and control the functions of a heating and cooling system. Total Pulldown Volume: The sum of the water suspended within the unit and its distribution system during operation, plus the water in any external piping and heat exchangers draining back to the unit when the pump is shut down. Valve: Any device used to control the flow of a fluid through piping. Variable Frequency Drive (VFD): An electronic device that controls the speed of a motor by controlling the frequency of the voltage supplied to that motor. Also known as an inverter. Wet-Bulb Temperature (WB): The temperature at which water, by evaporating into air, can bring the air to saturation at the same temperature. Wet Deck: A heat transfer surface where air and water interface; also known as fill.
Baltimore Aircoil International N.V., 2005 All rights reserved by Baltimore Aircoil International N.V. No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored or transmitted in any form or by any means whether graphic, electronic or mechanical; including photocopying, recording or any other information storage system, without the prior written permission from Baltimore Aircoil International N.V. This edition of the EU - Product and Application Handbook was published in Belgium by Baltimore Aircoil International N.V. Industriepark, Zone A, B-2220 Heist-op-den-Berg Baltimore Aircoil International N.V. has used all reasonable efforts to ensure the data and information contained in this book are as accurate and up to date as possible at the time of publication. However, they make no representation that it is absolutely accurate or complete. Errors and omissions can occasionally occur. Baltimore Aircoil International N.V. does not accept responsibility, and expressly disclaim any liability to any party, for any loss or damage, financial or otherwise, caused by any errors or omissions in this edition of the EU - Product and Application Handbook, whether they result from negligence or any other cause.
Baltimore Aircoil
Baltimore Aircoil International N.V., Industriepark, B-2220 Heist-op-den-Berg, Belgium e-mail: info-bac@baltimoreaircoil.be - Web: www.BaltimoreAircoil.com
Baltimore Aircoil
Baltimore Aircoil International N.V., Industriepark, B-2220 Heist-op-den-Berg, Belgium e-mail: info-bac@baltimoreaircoil.be - Web: www.BaltimoreAircoil.com